Você está na página 1de 268

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Honlion

C. J.

CLAY

and SOX,

CAMBEIDGE UNIVERSITY TRESS WAREHOUSE, AVE


:^rARIA

LANE.

CAMBRIDGE:

I>i:i(;ilToN.
r.

lil'.l.l..

.\M> co.

LEIPZIG:

A.

liKocKllArs.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA
A STUDY
IN

THE lIISToUV
OF

GREEK ALGEBRA

BY
T. L.

-ClJUilM

HEATH,

B.A.

SCHOLAR OF TRINITY

COI.LKCiK, CAMHRIlxiK.

EDITED FOR THE SYNDJC&^^^^XH^ UNIVEPiSITY -^-V3 ^-'-- 3^"\S>.

PliESS.

((UHIVEP.'ITY
QTambriligc

AT THE UNIVERSITY
1885

PKK.SS.

[All Ei'jhts A'.^.Tc;./.]

CTambritigr
rniNTF.ri

dy

c.

j.

clay, m.a. and sox,

AT THK rXIVERSITY PRKSS.

PREFACE.
The
the

scope of the
title

prosont book

is

sufficiently indicatod

Ity

and

the

Table of

Contents.
definitions"
to

In

the

chapter on
suggestions
to

" Dioijhantos'

notation
I

and

several

are made, which


origin

believe

be new, with regard

the

and

significance of the symbols

employed by Diophantos.

few words

may be
is

necessary to explain the purp(.se of the

Appendix.

This

the result of the compression of a large


to

book into a very small space, and claims


pendent value apart from the rest of
tended,
first,

have no indeIt
is

my

work.

in-

as a convenient

place of reference for mathe-

maticians

who may,
feel

after reading the account of Diophantos'

methods,

a desire to see them in actual operation, and,


exhibit

secondly, to

the several instances of that variety of


is

peculiar devices which


characteristics of the

one of the most prominent of the


algebraist, but

Greek

which cannot
in

l)o

brought under general rules and tabulated


as the processes described in
is

the

same way

Chapter V.

a necessary part of the whole, in that there

The Appendix, then, is much in


;

Diophantos which could not be introduced elsewhere


not,

it

must

however, be considered as in any sense an alternative to

the rest of the

book: indeed, owing


could

to

its

extremely conitself,
I

densed form,

hardly hope

that,

by

it

would
merely
of

even be comprehensible to the mathematician.

will

add that
H. D.

have twice carefully worked out the

.;<.lution

VI

PREFACE.
tlic

every problem from


lieve that

proof-sheets, so that I hope and

be-

no mistakes

will

be found to have escaped me.


details

It

would be mere tautology to enter into further

here.

One remark, however,


profess
to,

as to

what the work does

not,

and does not

include

may

not be out of place.

No

treatment of Diophantos could be complete without a


text.

thorough revision of the


inspected one MS. of

I have, however, only cursorily

my

author, that in the Bodleian Library,

which unfortunately contains no more than a small part of


the
first

of the six Books.


I regret that I

The
this

best Mss, are in Paris and

Rome, and

have had as yet no opportunity of would be a serious drawback

consulting them.

Though
text,

were I editing the


exposition
of

no

collation of MSS. could afifect

my

Diophantos' methods, or the solutions of his


it is

problems, to any appreciable extent; and, further,

more

than doubtful, in view of the unsatisfactory results of the


collation of three

of the MSS,

by three

different scholars in

the case of one, and that the most important, of the few obscure passages which need to be cleared up, whether the text
in these places could ever be certainly settled.
I should

be ungrateful indeed

if I

did not gladly embrace

this opportunity of

acknowledging the encouragement which

I have received from

Mr

J.

W,

L. Glaisher, Fellow

and Tutor

of Trinity College, to whose prospective interest in the

work
was

before

it

was begun, and unvarying kindness while

it

proceeding, I can

now

thankfully look back as having been

in a great degree the "


finally, I

moving cause

"

of the whole.

And,

wish to thank the Syndics of the University Press

for their liberality in

undertaking to publish the volume.


T. L.

HEATH.

11 May, 1885.

LIST

OF BOOKS OH

PAl'KKS

KKAD

()I{

KKKKlMtKI)

'K

>.

SO FAR AS THEY CON'CERN OK AUK ISKFIL

TO THE SUBJECT.

1.

Bookg

directlif

upon Dinphautois.

Xylander,

Diopliaiiti

Alexambini Reruni Arithmetit-arum Libri sex

Item Liber de Numcri.s Polygonis. Opus incoiupiirabile Latino redditum et Commeutariis explanatum Biusileae, 1575. Bachet, Diophanti Alexandrini Arithmeticoioim Libri sex, et de niuueri.s
multaugulis liber
unus.
uiiu.s.

Lutetiae Parisiorimi, 1G21.


libri sex, et

Diophanti AJexandi-ini Ai-ithmeticorum


lis liber

Cum

de uumeris multaugucommeutariis C. G. Bacheti V.C. et oWruaSenatoris Tolcsani.


Tolosae, 1G70.

tionibus D. P. de

Fermat

ScHULZ, Diophantus von Alexandria arithmetische Aufgaben nebst desseu


Schrift liber die Polygon-zahlen.

Aus dem
iiber

Griecbi-scheu iibersetzt
Berlin, 18-22. die

und mit Anmerkungeu


PoSELGER,

begleitet.

Diophantus von Uebersetzt, mit Zusiitzen. Crivelli, Elementi di Fisica


P.

Alexandrien

Polygon-Zahlen.
Leipzig, 1810.

ed

Problemi aritlmietici

di

Diofanto

Alessandrino analiticamente dimostrati.

In Venczia, 1744.

Glimstedt, Forsta Boken af Diophanti Arithmetica algebraisk OcfvcrLund, 1855. sattning. Stevin and Girard, " Translation " in Les Oeuvres mathematiques de

Simon

Stevin.

Leyde, 1684.

2.

M'orha indirectly fluridati)i<j Diftj'lnmtitg.

BoMBELLi, L' Algebra diuisa in tre Libri F'ermat, Opera Varia mathematica. Brassinne, Precis des Oeuvres mathematicpies de metique de Diophante.
CossALi, Origine, traspoi-to in
Storia critica

Bologna, 1579.
Tolixsai', H;7l>.

P. Fcrnuit et

de

I'Aritljl''*-'>3-

P'""is
in e-ssa dell'

Italia, prinii progre.s.si

Algebni

Nesselmanx, Die Algebra der Griechcn. John Kersey, Elements of Algebra.

Parnm, 17U7. Berlin, IM2.


London, 1674.
Ox.iiittC, 161)5

Walms, Algebra

(in

Opera Mathematica.

9
>"''

Saundek.son, N., Elements of Algebra.

Vlll

LIST OF AUTIlulUTIKS.

3.

Buuks

ic/tich iiifiitivii

or

(/ice

infurmation about Dio^laiiUof,


of mathematics.

including

historiiis

CuLEUHOOKE, AlgeVira with Arithmetic and ^Mensuration from the Sanscrit London, 1817. of Brahmaguptii and Bhiiscara.
SriDAs, Lexicon
(ed.

G. Bernhardy).

Ilalis et Brunsvigae, 1853.

Fabricii.s, Bibliotheca Graeca (ed. Harless).

AuCLEARAJ, History of the Dynasties


Ch. Th.
v.

(tr.

Pococke).

Oxon. 16C3.

Murr, Memorabilia Bibliothecarum publicarum Norimbergen-

Norimbergae, 1786. sium et Universitatis Altdorfinae. DoPPELMAYR, Historische Nachricht von den Xiirnbergischen Mathema(Nliruberg, 1730.) ticis und Kiinstlern.
Vos.siis,

De

universae mathesius natiira et coustitutione

Amstelaedami, 16G0.

Hkilbronneh, Historia matheseos universae. MuNTLCLA, Histoire des Math(5matiques.


IviAEUEL, Matheniatisches "\Vorterl)uch.

Lipsiae, 1742.
Paris,

An

7.

Leipzig, 1830.
Giittingen, 1796.

Kaestner, Geschiclite der Matheniatik.

Paris, 1810. BussuT, Histoire G(5uerale des Mathematiques. Hankel, Zur Geschichte der Mathematik in Altertlium und Mittelalter.

Leipzig, 1874.

Cantor, Vorlesungen Uber Geschichte der Mathematik, Band L


Leipzig, 1880.

Dr Heinrich Slter, Gesch.


Jame.s

d.

:^Lathematischen Wisseuschaften,

Zurich, 1873.

Gow,

short History of Greek Mathematics.

Camb. Univ.

Press, 1884.

4.

Papers or Pamphlets read in connection with Diophantos.


Beitriige zur

Poselger,

Unbestimmten Analysis.
les

I..

RoDET, L'Algebre d'Al-Kharizmi et


{Journal
AHiatitjite,

(Berlin xihhandhmgen, 1832.'i methodes indienne et grecque.

Janvier, 1878.)

WoEPCKE, Extrait du Faklni,

traitc^ d'Algebrc par Abou Bekr ^[ohammed ben Alhayan Alkarkhi, precede d'un memoiresurralgebre indeterminet; chez los Arabes. Paris, 1853

WoEi'CKE, Mathematiques chez

les
1.

Orientaux.

Journal Asiatique, Fdvrier-Mars, 1855. 2. Journal Asiatique, Avril, 1855.


{Bulletin des iSciences

I'.

Tanxehv, "A
Mat/ufm.
ct

<iuelque epocpie vivait Dioi)hante /"

Astronom. 1879.)

I'.

Tax.nery, L'Arithm(5ti(iue dans Pajtpus

lIusEN, Tiie Algel>ra of


1Ii:ii>er<;,

.Mohammed ben Musa.

{Bordeaux Memoirs, 1880.) London, 1831.


llauniae, 1879.

Quacstiones Archimedeae.

CONTENTS.
CHAPTER
I.

HISTORICAL INTRODUCTION'.
1.

Diophantos'

name and

particulars of his

life

....

PAGES
i

2.

His date.
() {b)

Different views

Internal evidence considered

4_S
8

External evidence

IG

3.

Results of the preceding investigation

1617

CHAPTER
;

II.

THEIR TITLES AND GENERAL THE WORKS OF DIOPHANTOS CONTENTS; THE PORTIONS WHICH SURVIVE.
1.

Titles

no

real evidence that 13


title

books of

Aritliiiietics

ever existed IS

corresponding to the

23
"iC,

No

from Arabia. Corruption must have taken place before 11th cent, and probably before 950 A.D
portion of the Arithmetics
is lost? The contents of the The Polygonal Numbers and Porism.i may have

trace of lost books to be restored

23

Poiisms lost before 10th cent. a.d.


2.

2<)

What

lost books.

formed part of the complete ArithmcticK.


theory

Objections to this

Other views
Conclusion

of the contents of thf lost

Books

....
),s.

2(> 3.">
3J

37
37

CHAPTER
THE WlllTEKS UPON
1. 2.
3.

III.

JlolMIA.\ T

(heck
Arabian

38-39
39

12

European gencially

42

5('>

CONTENTS.

CHAPTER
\OT.\TI(N
1.
2.
3.

IV.
(F

AND DEFINITIONS

DlOPH.\NTOS.
VAC.KS
,57

Introduction

Sign for the unknown quantity discubsed Notation for powers of the unknown
Objection that Diophantos loses generality by the want of more algebraic symbols answered

57

67
69

G7 09

i.

5.

Other questions of notation operations, fractions, dc. General remarks on the historical development of algebraic
:

6976
7680 8082

notation
6.

three stages exhibited


.
.

Ou

the influence of Diophantos' notation on his work

CHAPTER

V.

diophantos' METHODS OF SOLUTION.


1.
General remarks.
Criticism of the positions of Hankcl and

Ncsselmann
Diophantos' treatment of equations
(A)

.....

88114

Determinate equations of different degrees.


(1)

(2)

Pure equations of different degrees, i.e. equations con taining only one power of tlie unknown Mixed quadratics
Cubic equation

88-

(3)
(li)

.......
first

Indeterminate equations.
'..

Indeterminate equations of the


(1)

and second

degrees.

Single equation (second degree)


1.

2.

Those which can always be rationally solved Those which can be rationally solved only under certain conditions

(2)

Double equations.
1.

First general

method

(first

degree)
.

2.
II,

Second method (first degree) Double equation of the second

degrei

Indeterminate equations of liigher degrees.


(1)

Single ecjuations
,,

(first class)

(second class)
.

(2)

Double equations

3.

Summary

of the prerediiiji incestiijntioii

SI.

Transition

Mitiiod of limits

..... ....
.

Method

of appro.\imation to limits

CONTKNTS.

CHAPTER
1.

VI.
PAOEH
121
I2.'i

The PonsHis
('/)

of Diophantos

2.

Other theorems assumed or implied


(h)
(c)

12.> 132

Numbers Numbers Numbers

as the
as the

as the

sum sum sum

of two squares
of three squares

127 1:<0
l:{0

l:{l

of four squares

131 1H2

CHAPTER

VII.

HOW FAR WAS DIOPHANTOS


1.
2. 3.
Preliminary

ORIGINAL?

Diophantos' algebra not derived from Arabia


Reference to Hypsikles

....
.
.

133134 134135
13.")

130
138

4.
5.
6.

The evidence

of his language

13G 138

Wallis' theory of Greek Algebra

Comparison of Diophantos with his Greek predecessors


Discussion in this connection of the Cattle-prohlem
.

139142
142

7.
.

147

CHAPTER

VIII.

DIOPHANTOS AND THE EARLY ARABIAN ALGEBRAISTS.


1. 2. 3. 4.
5.

Preliminary

14S

Comparison of Diophantos with Diophantos and Abu'1-Wafa

Mohammed

ibn Musfi

149- -155

155
155- -156

An anonymous Arabic ms. Abu Ja'far Mohammed ibn


Alkarkhi

Alhusain
156-

156

G.

APPENDIX.

EREATUM.
On
p. 78, last line

but one of note, for " Targalia" read "Tartaglia"

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
CHAPTER

I.

Historical Introduction.

The doubts about l^iophantos begin, as has been 1. remarked by Cossali^ with his very name. It cannot be positively decided whether his name was Diophanfos or Diophan^es.
The preponderance, however,
of authority
is

in favour of the

view that he was called Diophantos.

The title of the work which has come down to us under (1) name gives us no clue. It is Aiocpdvrov 'A\^avBpQ}<i 'AptOfj,rjTLKwv ^i/SXia ly. Now Atocjjdvrov may be the Genitive of
his

either Ai6(f)avTo<i or A,io^dvrr]<;.


title

We

learn liowever from this

that he lived at Alexandria,

(2)

In Suidas under the

article "TiraTia the


is

name

occurs
;

in

the Accusative and in old editions

given as Aio<f)dvTr}v

but Bachet'^ in the Preface to his edition of Diophantos assures Besides this, us that two excellent Paris MSS. have Aio^avrov.
Suidas has a separate article
over Fabricius
At6(})avTo<i, ovofia Kvpiov.

More-

mentions several persons of the same name It is Ai6<f)avTo<;, but the name /lio(f)dvTr]<i nowhere occurs. on this ground probable that the correct form is AiotpavTo^. We may compare it with "EK<f)avTo<;, but we cannot go so far
is

as to say, with Bachet, that Aio<f)dvT'r]^

not Greek

for

we

have the analogous forms


1

'lepot^dvrrjt;, o-vK0(f)dvTr]<;.
coniincia la divcisitii tni gli scrittori " (p. 61). male habori, <j Ato-

"Su
'-Ubi

la

desinenza del

nome

moueudus

es imprimis, in editis Suidae libris

in (pavT-qv, ut ex duobus probatissimis codicibus manu exaratis (lui extant Bibliotheca Regia, depraehendi, qui veram exhibcut Icctionem d% Aw^ayrof."

H. D.

2
(3)

DIOPIIAXTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
In
the

only quotation
(fl.

from Diophantos which we

know
(4)

Tlioon of Alexandria

3G5

390

A.D.)

speaks of him

as At6<f)avTo<i.

On

the other hand Abu'lfaraj, the Arabian historian,

History of the Dynasties, is thought to be an authority for the form Diophanfcs, and certainly in his Latin translation of the
in his

two passages

in

which D.
vowel

is

mentioned by Abu'lfaraj, Pococke


first

writes Diophantes.
in the original the

But, while in the


is

of the

two passages

doubtful, in the second the


Abu'lfaraj
is

name

is

certainly Diophantos.
for the
(5)

Hence

really an authority

form Diophantos.

Of more modern
Aio(f)dvT7]<;.

writers,

Rafael

Bombelli

in

his

Algebra, published 1572, writes in Italian "Diofanie" corre-

sponding to
Diophan^ws.

But Joannes Regiomontanus, Joachim


all

Camerarius, James Peletarius, Xylander and Bachet

write

Diophanios was the Far more perplexing than the doubt as to his name is the question of the time at which he lived. As no certainty can even now be said to have been reached on this point, it will be necessary to enumerate the indications which
safely conclude, then, that

We may

name

of our author.

bear on the question.


only facts which are

Before proceeding to consider in order


it

the internal and external evidence,

will

be well to give the

known

of his personal history, and which

can be gathered from an arithmetical epigram upon Diophantos.

This epigram, the probable date of which


follows

it

will
its

be necessary to
is

consider later along with the question of


:

authorship,

as

Ovt6<; tol ^t6(f>avToi>

e'^et

rd(f)o<;,

/jiiya

Oavfia,

Kal

T</)09 K Te^i/779 fierpa

^10 to

\i<yL.

"Ektt]v Kovpi^eiv ^toTou ^eo? cutraae


AoyBeKUTrj
Tfj
8'

fioipijv,

S"

iTriOeU firjXa Tropev '^(Xodetv.


i'jyfraTO

ap'

e'</)'

e^BofuiTT} to yafirjXiov

<f>iyyo<;,

E/c 8e ydficov TrifMirrcp TralS' iirev^vaev eret.

At ai r7]\vyTov BetXov Te09,

VjfXLav irarpo^,

Tov
Iler'^o?

8e
3'

Kal

7;

Kpvepo^ fierpov eXoov ^iotov.


Trapijyopecov eviavTOL<i
eTreprja-e /3iOV.

av

iriavpecro'L
ao(piT)

Tj]8e TToaov

repfx

HISTORICAL IXTUODUCTIOX.

The

solution of this

at Avhich Diophautos died.

epigram-problem gives 84 as the age His boyhood lasted 14 years, his


33/;

beard grew at 21, he married at

a son was born to him

5 years later and died at the age of 42,

when

his father

was

80 years

old.

Diophanto.s'

own death

followed 4 years later

at the age of 84. Diophantos having lived to so great an age, an approximate date is all that we can expect to find for the production of his works, as we have no means of judging at what time of life he would be likely to write his

Aiithmetics.

The most important statements upon the date of 2. Diophantos which we possess are the following
(1)

Abu'lfaraj,

whom

Cossali calls "the courageous compiler

of a universal history from

Adam

to the 13th century," in his

History of the Dynasties before mentioned, places Diophantos, without giving any reason, under the Emperor Julian (3G1

368
It
is

A.D.).

This

is

the view which has been ordinarily held.

that of Montucla.

(2)

We

find in the preface to Rafael Bombclli's Algebra,

published 1572, a dogmatic statement that Diophantos lived

under Antoninus Pius (138

161

A.D.).

This view too has

met with considerable


Billy,

favour, being adopted

by Jacobus de

Blancanus, Vossius, Heilbronner, and others.


identifies the

we may mention Bachet's conjecture, Diophantos of the Arithmetics with an astrologer of the same name, who is ridiculed in an epigram attributed to Lucilius whence Bachet concludes that he lived about the time of Nero (5468) (not under Tiberius,
Besides these views

which

The three views Nesselmann supposes Bachet to say). here mentioned will be discussed later in detail, as they are all worthy of consideration. The same cannot be said of a
as

number
later

of other theories on the subject, of which I will quote

only one as an example.

Simon Stevin*
algebraist

places

Diophantos
ibn

than

the

Arabian

Mohammed

Miisa

Les Oeuvrcs Mathcin. de Sim. Stevin, augm. par Alh. Girard, Loyden, 1634, h, Diophant, il semblc iiu'cn son temps los inventions de Mahomet ayent seulement tsto cognues, commc bo poult colligcr de sea six premiers
1

"Quant

livres."

12

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Al-Kliarizmi

who

lived in the first half of the 9th century, the

absurdity of which view will appear.

We

must now consider

in detail the

(a)

Internal evidence of the date of Diophantos.

(1)

It

would be natural to hope to


is

find,

under this head,

references to the works of earlier or contemporary


ticians.

mathemafragment

Unfortunately there

only one such reference traceIt occurs in the

able in Diophantos' extant writings.

upon Polygonal Numbers, and is a reference to a definition given by a certain Hypsikies\ Thus, if we knew the date of Hypsikles, it would enable us to fix with certainty an upper It is limit, before which Diophantos could not have lived.
particularly unfortunate that

we cannot determine

accurately

what time Hypsikles himself lived. Now to Hypsikles is attributed the work on Regular Solids which forms Books In the XIV. and xv, of the Greek text of Euclid's Elements. introduction to this work the author relates'^ that his father
at

knew a

treatise of Apollonius only in


it

an incorrect form, whereas

he himself afterwards found


his time.

correctly

book of ApoUonios, which was

easily accessible

worked out in another anywhere in


Hypsikles'

From

this

we may with justice conclude that

father was an elder contemporary of ApoUonios, and

died before the corrected version of

must have ApoUonios' treatise was


is

given to the world.


friend

Hypsikles' work itself

dedicated to a

of his father's, Protarchos by name.


it

Now

ApoUonios

died about 200 B.C.; hence


'

follows that Hypsikles' treatise

Polyg. Numbers, prop.

8.

"Kal iirtdelxOri t6 waph. 'typiKkeX iv


'^

8p(p Xeyd/J-evov.^'

<Tvvairob(ixOivTo% oZv koI tov 'T^iacX^ouj 8pov, k.t.X."

'
'

"Kal

TTOTf SteXoOfTfj (sc. Basileides of

Tyre and Hypsikles' father) rb

virb

AwoWuviov
TT)v

ypa<p^u wepi
<j<paipav

ttjs

(TvyKplaems roO SwStKaiSpov Kal tov

tlKoffa^dpov tlov

(U
fMT]
Tjj/

avTj]v

iyypa<{>onivuv, rlva \oyov ix^i vpbs dWijXa, fSo^af raOra


aCrrol

dpOQi ytypaipivai rbv 'ArroWwi/iof.


iKoveiv TOV naTpos.

di

ravra SiaKaddpavres
i"r6
'

fypa\j/av

wj

^yCo Si vartpov irtpUtreaov iTlpi^ /3t/JA/v


ijyiwi (?) irepl tov

AiroWuvlov
(oiKf

iKbfhotxivtfi, Kal

TTtpUxovTi anobuiiu
iirl

i/iroKfifj^vov.
'

Kal fieydXtji

i\J/vxaywy^Or)v
KOiff,

Ty

irpofiXi^fxaTos ^T-qati.

Tb

fj.iv

viro

AwoWwi'lov iKbodh

OKOirdv.

Kal

yap

irtpKpiptrai, k. t. X."

HISTORICAL INTRODUCTION.

on Regular Solids was probably written about 180 B.C. It was clearly a youthful productiou. Besides this we have another work of Hypsikles, of astronomical content, entitled in Greek dva^opLK6<i. Now in this treatise we find for the first time the division of the circumference of a circle into 360 degrees, which Autolykos, an astronomer a short time anterior to Euclid, was not acquainted with, nor, apparently, Eratosthenes who died about 194 B.C. On the other hand Hypsikles used no trigonometrical methods these latter are to some extent employed by the astronomer Hipparchos, who made observations at Rhodes between the years 101 and 126. Thus the discovery
:

of trigonometrical

methods about 150 agrees well with the

conclusion arrived at on other grounds, that Hypsikles flourished

about 180

B.C.

We

must

not,

however, omit to notice that Nesselmann,

an authority always to be mentioned with respect, takes an


entirely different view.

He

concludes that we

may

with a

fair

approach to certainty place Hypsikles about the year 200 of our


but upon insufficient grounds. Of the two arguments used by Nesselmann in support of his view one is grounded upon the identification of an Isidores whom Hypsikles mentions' as his instructor with the Isidores of an article in Suidas:
era,

'lo-tSwpo? ^tXocro0O9 09
eiirep rt?

e^Ckocro^ae

fiev

vtto TOt? dS\<f)oi<;,

dWo<i, iv fiaOrjfiaaLv:

and, further, upon a conjecture


called

of Fabricius

about

it.

Assuming that the two persons

two places are identical we have still to determine his date. The question to be answered is, what is the reference in viro roh dBX(j)oi<; ? Now Fabricius makes a conjecture, which seems hazardous, that the dBe\(f)ot are the brothers M. Aurelius Antoninus and L. Aurelius Verus, who were joint-Emperors from 160 to 169 A.D. This date being
Isidoros in the

assigned

to

Isidoros, it
A. d.

would follow that Hypsikles should

be placed about

200.

In the second place Nesselmann observes that according to

Diophantos Hypsikles

is

ing polygonal numbers which


'

the discoverer of a proposition respectwe find in a rather less perfect

Eucl. XV.

5.

"77 5^ evpejii, u$'l<xl5wpos 6 Ti/x^Tepos vip-nyqaaTo fi^yat 5i6dcK-

fiXos,

^x"

'0" 'poVoi/ TovTov,"

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
;

from this he form in Nikomachos and Theon of Smyrna argues that Hypsikles must have been later than both these mathematicians, adducing as further evidence that Theon (who
is

much given
lived

to quoting) does not quote him.


A.D., this

Doubtless, as

Theon

under Hadrian, about 130


but
it
is

would give a

date for Hypsikles which would agree with that drawn from
Fabricius' conjecture
;

not possible to regard either


if it w^ere

piece of evidence as in any

way trustworthy, even

not contradicted by the evidence before adduced on the other


side.

fore

say then with certainty that Hypsikles, and therea fortiori Diophantos, cannot have written before 180 B.C!. The only other name mentioned in Diophantos' writings (2) This is that of a contemporary to whom they are dedicated. name, however, is Dionysios, which is of so common occurrence that we cannot derive any help from it whatever. Diophantos' work is so UTiique among the Greek trea(3)
tises

We may

which we possess,

tliat

he cannot be said to recal the style

or subject-matter of

any other author, except, indeed, in the fragment on Polygonal Numbers ; and even there the reference
to Hypsikles
is

the only indication

we can

lay hold

of.

which forms the last question of the 5th book of Diophantos, has been used in a way which is rather
Tiie epigram-problem,

means of determining the date of the Arithmetics, by M. Paul Tannery \ The enunciation of this problem, which
curious, as a
is

different from all the rest in that (a)


(6)
it

it is

in the

form of an

epigram,

introduces numbers in the concrete, as applied

to things, instead of abstract

numbers (with which alone


is

all

the other problems of Diophantos are concerned),

doubtless

borrowed by him from some other source. It is a question about wine of two different qualities at the price respectively of

8 and 5 drachmae the


inferior quality as
it

%o{;9. It appears also that it was wine of was mixed by some one as drink for his Now M. Tannery argues (a) tliat the numbers 8 and servants. 5 were not hit upon to suit the metre, for, as these are the only

numbers which occur


*

in the epigram,

and both are found

in

lUilh'tin (ten Sciences mathnnntiqiiis et astronomif/ucs, 1879, p. 201.

HISTORICAL INTRODrCTION.
the same
fiov<i,

compounds 6KTa8pd^^f^ov<: and irein-eSpdxsome other numerals would serve the purposes of metre
line in the
(b)

Neither were they taken in view of the solunumber of ;^6e? which it was required to find are found to contain fractions. Hence (c) the basis on which the author composed his problem must have
equally well,
tion of the problem, for each

been the price of wines at the time.


it is

Now, says M. Tannery*, evident that the prices mentioned for wines of poor quality
But wine was not dear until after tlie time Therefore the composer of the epi^-am, and
also, is later

are famine prices.


of the Antonines.

hence Diophantos

than the period of the Antonines.


does no more than give

This argument, even


us a later date than

if it is correct,

we

before arrived at as the upper limit.

Nor can M. Tannery

consistently assert that this determination


;

necessarily brings us at all near to the date of Diophantos

for

in another place he maintains that Diophantos was no original

genius, but a learned mathematician

problems previously known

thus,

if

so

who made a much had

collection of

already been

done

in the

domain which

is

represented for us exclusively by

Diophantos, the composer of the epigram in question

have lived a considerable time before Diojihantos.

It

may well may be

mentioned here,

also,

that one of the examples which M. Tanto,

nery quotes as an evidence that problems similar

and even

more

difficult than,

those of Diophantos were in vogue before

his time, is the

commonly
problem
is

called

famous Problem of the Cattle, which has been by the name of Archimedes and this very fatal to the theory that arithmetical epigrams must
;

These considerations, however, ftict. though proving M. Tannery to be inconsistent, do not necessarily preclude the possibility that the inference he draws from
necessarily be founded on

the epigram-problem solved by Diophantos


date of the Cattle-problem itself
later
is

is correct, for (a)

the

not known, and

may be

even than Diophantos, (6) it does not follow that, if M. Tannery's conclusion cannot be proved to be necessarily right, it must therefore be wrong.
1

choisis en vue de la solution:

"II est d'ailleurs facile de se rendre comptc que ccs prix n'ont pas 6t6 on doit done supposcr qu'ils sent rt-els. Or ce
los

sent evideininent, pour

vius de basse quality, do prix de famine."

DIOPHAXTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

On
we

the vexed question as to

how

far

Diophantos was original

shall

have to speak

later.

Wo
(b)

pass

now

to a consideration of the

External evidence as

to

the date of Diophantos.

(1

We

have

first to

consider the testimony of a passage of


of by writers on the ques-

Suidas, which has been

made much

tion of Diophantos, to an extent entirely disproportionate to its


intrinsic importance.

As however

it

does not bear solely upon


it

the question of date, but upon another question also,

cannot

be here passed over.


'TTTartaV

The passage

in question is Suidas' article

The words which concern us apparently

stood in

the earliest texts thus, eypay^rev vTro/xvrj/jLa et? Aiocfxivrrjv

Tov darpovofiiKov. Kavova et<? to. KOiVLKa' ^AiroWcovlov viro/jiVTjfia. With respect to the reading A.io(f)dvr'}]v, we have already remarked that Bachet asserts that two good Paris MSS.
have
TOV
A.i6(f>avTov.

The words

as found in the text cannot be right.

Aiocfjdvrrjv

da-TpovofiiKov

should

(if

the punctuation were

right)

be

Aio(f>dvTr)v TOV d(TTpov6^ov, the

former not being Greek.

Ku.ster's

conjecture

'^

is

that

we should read
et?
to,

vTrofivrjfia
^

ek

Aio(f)dvTov da-TpovofjLLKov Kavova'


vTToiJ.vnp.a.

KwviKa

AttoWojvlov

If this is right the

Diophantos here mentioned must

have been an astronomer.


is

In that case the person in question


for

not our Diophantos at

all,

we have no ground whatever


It
is

to

imagine that he occupied himself with Astronomy.


tain that he was

cer-

famous only as an arithmetician.


life

of Jerusalem in his

some
'

one's skill in

Thus John John of Damascus^ in speaking of Arithmetic compares him to Pythagoras and
of
'

tiraTla

rj

O^wvos tov TtufUTpov Ovyarrip tov A\f^avSp^wi <pi\oa6^ov xal

avTr]

<f)iK6(To<poi,

KoX

woWoh

yvwpifioi'

yvvr] 'IcridiJopov tov <t>i.\oao<pov


\io<p(xvTr)v

iJKnaafv

iirl

t^s

PaaiXdai 'ApKailoV (ypayptv vir6fu/r)na th Ta KuviKa' AiroWwvlov v-ir6fj.injfia.


'

tov dtXTpovopuKov.

Kaxoi'a

eh

' 3

Suidae Lexicon, Cantabiigiac, 1705. Chapter


xi.

of the Life as Kiven in Sancti patris

iiostri

Joannis Damasceni,

Monaclii, et rreshyteri Ilierusulymitani, Opera omnia quae exstant ft ejus nomine

circumferuntur.

Tonms primus.

Parisiis, 1712.
t}

'AvaXoyla^ di'ApidfxrjTiKii ovtu^

i^rfaKr/Kacif ti'^uwr, wi

UvOayopai

Ai6(pavToi,

HISTORICAL INTRODUCTION.
Diophantos, as representing that science.
the same name,

f)

However, Baclict

has proposed to identify our Diophantos with an astrologer of

who

is

ridiculed in an epigram' supposed to he

written by Lucilius.

Now

the ridicule of the epigram would

be clearly out of place as applied to the subject of the epigram mentioned above, even supposing that Lucilius' ridiculous
hero
is

not a fictitious personage, as

it

is

not unreasonable to

suppose.

Bachet's reading of the passage


t6i>
fia'^.

is vTro/ivrjfia

eh

Aio^afToz/,
vTro^vr,-

darpovofiLKOv Kavova, etf ra koovlku

AttoWcoviov
it

He

then proceeds to remark that


as well as

shows that Hypatia

wrote a Canon Astronomicus, so that she evidently was versed


in

Astronomy

Geometry

(as

shown by the Commenthat she was

tary on Apollonios), two of the three important branches of

Mathematics.

It

is

likely then, argues Bachet,

acquainted with the third. Arithmetic, and wrote a commentary

on the AritJtmetics of Diophantos.

But

in the first place

we

know
it

of no astronomical

work

after that of Claudius Ptolemy,

and from the way in which 6 da-rpovo^iLKO'; Kavwv is mentioned would be necessary to suppose that it had been universally known, and was still in common use at the time of Suidas, and yet was never mentioned by any one else whom we knjULUUi
inexplicable hypothesis.

'

'ISipixoyivt)

Tov larpov 6 affrpoXoyoi Ai6<f>ai'T(X

Eln-e /xovovi ^wfjs ivvia pLrjvas ^X^'"-

KcLKeivos ycXdaai,

Ti
(TV

/jl(v

KpSvos

ivvia. /xrjvwy,

^qal, \^yL,

voef Ta/xa 5i
Tjxj/aro'

ci'inofxa.

aoc

Elwe Kal ^KTslvas fwvov

Kal AiO(pain-os

'AWov

dve\iri^u)v, avrbs

awf (TKapKrev.
turn in
niccli-

"Ludit non innenustus poeta turn

in

Diopbantum AstroloRum,

cum Hermogenera, quem


attactu

et alibi saepe false

admodum

perstringit, qniVl solo

non aegros modo, sed et ben(^ valentes, velut pestifero sidere afflntoa Itaque nisi Diopbantum nostrum Astrologiae iieritum fuissc negemus, nil prohibet, quo minus eum aetate Lucillij extitisse dicanius."
repente necaret.

Bacbet,
-

Ad

Urtorrm.

From

tbis reading

it

is

clear that Bachet did not rest his view of the

identity of our Diophantos with the astrologer

upon the

i)as8age of Suidas.

M. Tannery

is

therefore mistaken in supposing this to be the case, "Bachet,

ayant lu dans Suidas qu'Hy^mtia avait commentu le notre auteur..."; that is precisely what Bacbet did rmt read

Canon astronomique d
there.

10

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Next, the expression ek Aio^avrov has been objected to by as not being Greek. He maintains that the Greeks
its

Nesselmann

never speak of a book by the name of

author, and therefore


if

we ought
to

to

have Atocfxivrov dpidfiijTiKa,

the reference were

M. Tannery, however, defends the use of the expression, on the ground that similar M. Tannery, ones are common enough in Byzantine Greek.
Diophantos of the Arithmetics.
accordingly, to avoid the difficulties which

we have mentioned,

supposes some words to have dropped out after ^lo^avrov, and


thinks that
Kavova.
et9

we should read

et? At6<f)avTov . . .rov aa-rpovofiiKov

ra KwviKa WiroWcoviov virofivrjixa, suggesting that before tov acrrpovoiiiKov Kavova we might supply et? and understand TlroXe^iaiov.
It will

be seen that

it is

impossible to lay any stress upon

this passage of Suidas.

We

cannot even make sure from this


it

that Hypatia wrote a

commentary upon Diophantos, though

has been very generally asserted by historians of mathematics

even by Cossali, who in speaking of the which the text of Diophantos has fallen remarks that Hypatia was the most fortunate of the commenas an

undoubted
state

fact,

corrupt

into

tators
(2)

who have
I

ever addressed themselves to his writings.


facts we know of Diowe only knew the exact date of the author of

have already mentioned the epigram which in the


If

form of a problem gives us the only


phantos'
this
life.

epigram, our difficulties would be


to Metrodoros,

much

lessened.

It is

commonly assigned

but even then we are not

sure whether Metrodoros of Skepsis or Metrodoros of Byzan-

tium is meant. It is now generally supposed that the latter was the author and of him we know that he was a grammarian and arithmetician who lived in the reign of Constantine
;

the Great.
(8)

It

is

satisfactory in the midst of so


to

much
in a

uncertainty to

find a

most certain reference

Diophantos

work by Theon

of Alexandria, the fatherof Hypatia,


for the date,

which gives us a loiuer limit more approximate than we could possibly have

derived ironx the article of Suidas.


Diopiiantos was
'

The
Book

ftict

that
;

Theon quoted
"

first

noted by Peter Ramus*


i,

Diophantus,

Schold Mathnntitirii,

p. Su.

HISTORICAL INTRODUCTION.
cujus sex libros,

\\

cum tamcn author

graecos

habemus de

ipso tredccim poUiceatur, arithmcticis admirandac subtilitatis artcm


:

quae vulgo Algebra arabico nomine appellatur cum (citatur enim a Theone) antiquitas artis appareat. Scripserat et Diophantus harmonica." This quotation was known to Montucla, who however draws an absurd conchision from it* which is repeated by Klucrel in his
coniplexis,

tamen ex authore hoc antique

Worterbuchl

The words
(f)r](riv

of

Theon which
rf]<;

refer to Diopliantos
(iixeraderov
elSo'i
ova-T]<:

are koI Ai6(})avT6<i

on,

fxovdSo'i

Kal earcoay]^ Trcivrore, to 7roWa7rXaaia^u/j,evov

eV

avTTjf

avTo TO ei8o9 earat.

We

have only to remark that these words

are identically those of Diophantos' sixth definition, as given in

Bachet's text, with the sole difference that iravTore stands in the place of the equivalent dei, in order to see that the refer-

ence

is

certain
is

beyond the

possibility of a doubt.

The name

of

again mentioned by Theon a few lines further on. Here then we undoubtedly have a lower limit to the time of

Diophantos

Diophantos, supplied by the date of Theon uf Alexandria, and one which must obviously be more approximate than we could have arrived at from any information about his daughter

Hypatia, however trustworthy. Theou's date, fortunately, we can

determine with accuracy.

Suidas^

tells

us that he was conI.

temporary with Pappos and lived in the reign of Theodosius

The statement that he was contemporary with Pappos


"Theon
une autre ouvrage de

is

almost

cite

cet analyste, oil

il

ctoit question dc la

pratique de I'arithm^tique.

Je soupv'onnerois que c'etoit la qu'il expliquoit plus


il

au long

les regies

de sa nouvelle arithnietique, sur quoi

ue

s'ctoit

pas assez

^tendu au commencement de ses questions."

Montucla,
d. reinen

Apparently translated word for word in Eosenthal's EncyclopUdie

Mathem.
I.

iii.

195.

177, under Arithmetik:

"Diophantus hab ausser seincm grossen


iiber die praktiscbe

arith-

metischen Werke aucb ein das aber verloren ist."

Werk

Arithmetik gescbriebcn,
in the 5th

To begin

with,

Montucla quotes the passage as occurring

Book of

Theon's Commentary, instead of the first. The work of Diophantos which Theon quotes is not another work, but is identically the Arithmeticn vihich wo
possess.
^

Qiuv 6

iK Tov ^lovjelov, Alyvirrioi,

(pi\6(TO<f>oi,

Ji'yxP^^ ^^ UdTririft ri^

<pi\oc6^

Kal avrc^ 'AXe^avdper irOyxavov di an<por{poi

iirl

Qfodoaiov fiaffi\^ws tov Tfxff^vri-

poV iypafe

'MaOTj/xariKd,

'

ApiO/xrjTtKo, k. t. \.


DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

12

certainly incorrect .and


for

due to a confusion on the part of Suidas, Pappos probably flourished under Diocletian (a. D, 284 305) but the date of a certain Commentary of Theon has been
;

definitely determined' as the year

372

A. D.

and he undoubtedly
I.

flourished, as Suidas says, in the reign of

Theodosius

(379

395

A. D.).

The next authority who must be mentioned is the (4) Arabian historian Abu'lfaraj, who places Diophantos without remark under the emperor Julian. This statement is important in that it gives the date which has been the most generally acThe passage in Abu'lfaraj comes after an enumeration cepted. of distinguished men who lived in the reign of Julian, and is
thus translated by Pococke
A. B.
:

"Ex

iis

Diophantes, cuius liber

quem Algebram
a
difiicult

vocat Celebris est."

It is

question to decide

allowed to Abu'lfaraj's dogmatic statement.


rities

how much weight is to be Some great authoto be valueless.

have unequivocally pronounced


it

it

Cossali

attributes

by Abu'lfaraj of our author with another Diophantos, a rhetorician, who is mentioned in another article'^ of Suidas as having been contemporary with the emto a confusion

peror Julian (361

363); and assumes that Abu'lfaraj made the


Abu'lfaraj's translator, Pococke, to the effect

statement solely on the authority of Suidas, and confused two Cossali remarks at the same time persons of the same name.

upon a statement of
that the

Arabian historian did not know Greek and Latin.

Colebrooke too' {Algebra of the Hindus) takes the same view. Ncnv it certainly seems curious that Cossali should remark upon
Abu'lfaraj's ignorance of

Greek and yet suppose that he made a


;

statement merely upon the authority of Suidas and the quesWe tion suggests itself: had Abu'lfaraj no other authority?
1

"On

the date of Pappus," Ac., by


xxviii. 403.

Hermann

Usener, Neues Rheinisches

Museum, 1873, Bd.


*

Ai^dvios, (TO(piaTr)i AvTioxf'y. twv ivl toO 'lovXiavov toO

Uapa^aTov

xp<5'w'.

Kal

fJi^XP^

Qeo5offlov tov vpea^vripov, '^aayaviov Trarpoj, fiadrjrr]^ Aio(pdin-ov.

* Note M. p. LXiii. "The Armenian Abu'lfaraj places the Algebraist Diophantus under the emperor Julian. Ihit it may be (luestioned whether he ha8 any authority for that date, besides the mention by Greek authors of a learned person of ihc name, the instructor of Libanius, who was contemporary with tht^t

pmperor,"

HISTORICAL INTR()incTR)X.

l.S

was remarked by Schulz, admit that he must have had for he gives yet another statement about Diophaiitos, which certainly comes from another source, that his work was
certainly, as
;

must

translated

into

Arabic, or

commented upon, by Mohanuiicd


to

Abu'1-Wafa. There would seem however

be but one possibility

which would make Abu'lfaraj's statement trustworthy. Is it possible that the two persons, whom he is supposed to have
confused, are identical

nius

distinguished
?

mathematician
contrary,

Is it a sufficient objection that Liba? himself chiefly as a rhetor and not as a In fact, in the absence of any evidence to the

why should
also

the arithmetician Diophantos not have


?

been a rhetorician

This question has given occasion to

some jests on the compatibility of the two accomplishments. M. Tannery, for example, quotes Fermat, who was " Conseiller de Toulouse " and Nesselmann mentions Aristotle, arriving finally at the conclusion that the two may be identical, and so,
;

while Abu'lfaraj's statement has nothing against


great deal in
its

it,

it

has a

favour.

But M. Tannery thinks he has made

the identification impossible by finding Suidas' authority, namely

Eunapios in the Lives of the Sophists, who mentions this other Diophantos as an Arabian, not an Alexandrian, and professing Certainly if this supposition is correct, we cannot at Athens \
identify the

ment

of Abu'lfaraj.

two persons, and therefore cannot trust the stateThere is a further consideration that the

reign of Julian (361

363) could
and
(2) the

certainly only have been the

end of Diophantos' life, as we see by comparing Theon's date, above mentioned, to whom Diophantos is certainly anterior; he may indeed have been much earlier, because (1) Theon
quotes him as a
classic,

absence of quotations before

Theon does not

necessarily

contemporary, for of

show that the two were nearly previous writers to Theon who would have
?

been likely to quote Diophantos


(5)

In the preface to

his Algebra, published

A.D.

1572,

Rafael Bombclli gives the bare statement that Diophantos lived


^

"II uous donne ce Diophante, qu'il a connu et dont

il

ne

fait d'ailleure

pas grand cas,

comme

nO,

non pas

a,

Alexandrie, ainsi que

le

matht-maticien,

mais en Arable Athenes."

(AiocpavTos 6

'Apd^ios), et, d'autre part,

conime prolessant A

14

DIOPIIANTOH OF ALEXANDRIA.

in the reign of Antoninus Pins', giving no proof or evidence of


it.

From

the demonstrated incorrectness of certain other state-

ments of Bombelli concerning Diophantos we may infer that we ought not hastily to give credence to this on the other hand it is scarcely conceivable that he would have made the assertion without any ground whatever. The question accordingly arises, whether we can find any statement by an earlier writer, which might have been the origin of Bombelli 's assertion. M. Tannery thinks he has found the authority while engaged in another
;

research into the evidence on which Peter

Ramus

ascribes to

Diophantos a treatise on Harmonics '^ an assertion repeated by


Gessner and Fabricius^.
conjectures

As

cannot follow M. Tannery in his


I will give the

for

they are nothing better, but are rather con-

jectures of the wildest kind,

substance of his

remarks without much comment, to be taken


worth.

for

what they are


no reason to
6 <yepo)v,

According to M. Tannery Ramus' source of information


;

was a Greek manuscript on music

this there is

doubt; and in the edition of Antiquae musicae auctores by

Meibomius we

read, in the treatise

by Bacchios

that

there were five definitions of rhjjthm, attributed to Phaidros,

Aristoxenos, Nikomachos, Ae6(f)avT0<; and Didymos.

Now

the
is,

name

Aed<^ai/T09

is

not Greek; the form Aea)(f)avTo<; however

but M. Tannery argues that a confusion between Aeo and Atw is much less likely than a confusion between Aco and Aio. (I may be
allowed to remark here that I cannot agree with this view.

Of course
that
to
I

and

are extremely likely to be confounded, but

should have been at the same tmie changed into


probable.

seems

me anything but

Besides, this involves two changes,

whereas the change of Ae into Aeo involves only one variation.


This latter change then
1

is

the smaller one, and

why should

it

"Qucsti

aniii passati, csscndosi ritrouato

una opera greca

di qucsta dis-

ciplina nclla

libraria di Nostra Siguore in Vaticano, coniposta


il

da un certo

Diofantc Alessandrino Autor Greco,


[I I

quale

fh a tempo

di Antonin Pio..."
in the British

quote from the edition published in 1579, which

is

Museum.

et alii memorant, iuteUige de harmonicis numcris, uou dc scripto quoJam musici argumeuti," though what is meant by "harmonic numbers," as Nessclmann remarks, is not quite clear.
=*

have not seen the original edition of 1572.] 2 "Scripserat et Diophantus harmonica." "Harmonica Diophanti, quae (icsiwrus


HISTORICAL INTRODUCTION'.
be
less likely

lo

than the other


likely of the

?
;

I confess that it for the long


is

far the

more

two

seems to mc hy ami short vowx-ls o,


fact
il

M must have been closely associated, as


that in ancient inscriptions^
indiscriminately,

proved by the

we

find

written for both

and

and in others

used for both sounds.)


writers.

Tlicii,

according to M. Tannery,
Ai6(f)avTo<;,

Ramus

probably took the name

for

Admitting that the identification with the arithmetician Diophantos is hypothetical enough, M. Tannery goes on to say that it is confirmed

and was followed by other

by finding the name of Nikomachos next to Ae6(f)avTo<i, and by observing that Euclid and Ptolemy also were writers on music, which formed part of the fiadrjixara. Now in enumerations of
this sort the chronological order is generally followed,

and the

dates of

many
"

authors have been decided on grounds no more

(It is an obvious remark to make to M. two wrongs do not make a right " it does not follow that, because other dates have been decided on insufficient grounds, we should determine Diophantos' date in the same manner wKfiught rather to take warning by such unsatisfactory determinations. But to proceed with M. Tannery's remarks) In the present case we know that Aristoxenos was a disciple of Aristotle, and that Nikomachos was posterior to Thrasyllos who

certain than this.

Tannery that

lived in the reign of Tiberius.


logical order for

Thus we can prove the chrono-

two of the five names. Again, Nikomachos must be anterior to his commentator Apuleius who was contemporary with Ptolemy, and Ptolemy speaks in his Harmonics of a tetrachord due to a neo-Pythagorean Didymos. Of Phaidros we know nothing. Hence if we admit that the names are given in chronological order, and remember that Diophantos lived to be 84 years of age, we might say that, coming between Nikomachos and Didymos, he lived in the reign of Antoninus Pius, as Bombelli states, i.e. 138 IGl A.D. M. Tannery, however, is conscious of certain objections to

this theory of Diophantos' date.

This determination would, he


'^epoiv

says,
'

have great weight


mean, of course,

if

Bacchios 6

had been an author

inscrr. later

time one sign was necessarily used for both

than the introduction of Q, before which Further, I lay no strcBH letters.

upon

this fact except as

an

illustration.

16

DIOPHANTOS OV ALEXANDRIA.
of"

sufficiently near in point

time to Diophantos and the rest in


Unfortuoately, however,

order to
that

know

their respective ages.

is far

He

is

from certain, Bacchios' own date being very doubtful. generally supposed to have lived in the time of Constantine
;

the Great

this

is

however questioned by M. Tannery who


to

thinks that the epigram given by Meibomius, in which Bacchios


is

associated with a certain Dionysios, refers

Constantine

who belongs to the sixth century. Next, grave doubts may be raised concerning the determination by
Porphyrogenetes,
of

means of the supposed chronological order; for the definitions rhythm given by Nikomachos and Diophantos (?) are very
of that of
avvd<TC<i'
:

nearly alike, that of Diophantos being apparently a development

Nikomachos kutu 8e NiKOfia^ov, '^povcou evTUKTO'i Kara 8e Ai6(f)avTov (?), -^povcov avvdeai<; kut dvaXo'^iav The similarity of the two re Kol (TVfifierplav irpo'i eavTov<;. definitions might itself account for their juxta-position, which might then after all be an inversion of chronological order. By Again the age of Didymos must be fixed differently. " Didymos " is meant the son of Herakleides Ponticus, grammarian and musician, whom Suidas places in the reign of Nero. Thus, if we assume Bacchios' order to be chronological, we must place Diophantos in the reign of Claudius, and Nikomachos in
that of Caligula.

3.

Results of the preceding investigation.

I have now reviewed all the evidence we have respecting the time at which Diophantos lived and wrote, and the conclusions

arrived
rities

at,

on the basis of this evidence, by the greatest authoIt

upon the subject. be called in any sense


sufficient to

must be admitted the


;

result cannot

satisfactory

indeed the data arc not


issue.

determine indisputably the question at

The

latest determination of Diophantos' date is that of

M. Tannery, and there has been no theory propounded which seems on the whole preferable to his, though oven it cannot be said to have been positively established it has, however, the merit that, if it
;

cannot be proved,

it

cannot be impugned

as therefore it

seems

HISTORICAL INTROnrcTION.
open
to

17
it

no objection,

it

would seem best

to accept

provisionally,

as the least uusatistactory theory.

be not improbably right in placing Diophantos in the second half of the third century of our era, making him thus a contemporary of
shall therefore

We

Pappos, and anterior by a century to Theon of Alexandria and


his

daughter Hypatia,

period

One thing is quite certain: that Diophantos lived in a when the Greek mathematicians of great original power had been succeeded by a number of learned commentators, who
confined their investigations within the limits already reached,

without attempting to further the development of the science.

To

this general rule there are

two most striking exceptions,

in

different

Diophantos and Pappos. These two mathematicians, who would have been an ornament

branches of mathematics,

to

when

any age, were destined by fate to live and labour at a time their work could not check the decay of mathematical

learning.

There is scarcely a passage in any Greek writer where either of the two is so much as mentioned. The neglect of their works by their countrymen and contemporaries can be
explained only by the fact that they were not appreciated or

understood. The reason why Diophantos was the earliest of the Greek mathematicians to be forgotten is also probably the reason why he was the last to be re-discovered after the Revival of Learning. The oblivion, in fact, into which his writings and

methods
there
is

fell

understood.
so

is due to the circumstance that they were not That being so, we are able to understand why much obscurity concerning his personality and the

time at which he

lived.

Indeed, Avhen

we

consider
little

how

little

he was understood, and in consequence how


can only congratulate ourselves that so
survived to the present day.

esteemed,

we

much

of his

work has

CHAPTER
;

II.

THE WORKS OF DIOPHANTOS THEIR TITLES AND GENERAL CONTENTS; THE PORTIONS OF THEM WHICH SURVIVE.

1.

We
(1)

know
titles.

of three works of Diophantos,

which bear

the following

Wpi6fxr]TtKci}v /Si/SXia ly.


Trep]

(2)
(3)

TToXvyoovcov apidfioov.

TropiafMara.

With respect to tlie first title we may observe that the meaning of "dpid/jbrjTiKa' is slightly different from that assigned The ancients drew a marked to it by more ancient writers. distinction between dpidfiijTiKT] and \ 0740- rt/c?;, both of which were concerned with numbers. Thus Plato in Gorgias 451 B*
states that dpidfirjrtKy']
is

concerned with the abstract properties

of numbers, odd even, and so on, whereas

the same odd and even, but in relation


also gives us definitions of the
dpidfxrjTLKij

to

XoytaTCKij deals with Geminos one anotlier.


According to him
of numbers, while

two terms.

deals with

abstract properties

XoyiariKi] gives solutions of problems about concrete numbers.

From Geminos we

see that enunciations were in ancient times

concrete in such problems.


'

But

in Diophantos the calculations


eariv
rj

tIs

fjie

fpoiTo..!'(l

SwAcpares, tL^

dptOfirjTiKr]

t^x*''?>

cI'toim'
/xe

S**

avTip, tSairep

<ri>

dpri, 6ti
tL
;

twv 5id \6you


Av, 6ti
5'

tis t6

Kvpoi ixovauv.

Kal et

iwavip-

ono Twf
(Kdrepa
ilvoiix
iTfpl tI
rj
;

TTipl

etiroifi'

twv vtpl rb Apribv tc koI


5^

irtpiTTov

Ti^yx'**'^'

^"'aai>T7)

'

av fpoiTO, Trjv
trdv

XoyiariKriv rlva

Sj dp KoKds rix^riv 'H


&\\a KaOdwep

&v 6ti Kal


etiToifJ.^
T}

iarl tCiv \6yifi t6


o\ iv rc^

Kvpovp-ivuv.

Kal el IwavipoiTo

hv wainp

StJ^v <iv-f^pa.<^6iXivoi, Sri ra fikv


TO avTO

dpiOixrjTiKTi

XoyuTTiKT] ^X"'

""fpi

yap

icTL, to re dpTiov Kal to irepiTToV


ttuis

diatpitid Sk

ToaovTov, oti Kal


7]

tt/jos

aina Kal

Trpos

aX\i)\a

?x** irXridovi iiriffKOirei

TO TTCpiTTOV Kal TO df>Tl0V

XoyKTTlKrj.

(.tOnjlUg,

451

B,C.

HIS WORKS.

10

take an abstract form, so that the distinction between XoyiaTiKij

and
the

apidfjiriTLKr]

is

lost.

We

thus have W.pid/xr}TiKd given as

work, whereas in earlier times the term could only properly have been applied to his treatise on Polygonal
title of his

Numbers.
metic
is

not without

This broader use by Diophantos of the term arithits importance.


this preliminary

Having made
have been
lost,

remark

it is

next necessary to

observe that of these works which

we have mentioned some The Arithmetics


But
which
all

while probably the form of parts of others has

suffered considerably

by the ravages of time.

should, according to the title and a distinct statement in the

introduction to

it,

contain thirteen Books.

the

six

known

MSS.^ contain only six

books, with the sole variation

that in the Vatican MS. 200 the

same
seveii.

text,

in the rest

forms six books,

is

divided into

Not only do the


work
;

MSS.

practically agree in the external division of the

they

agree also in an equally remarkable manner

them which have up

to the present

been collated

at

least all of

in the lacunae
is

and the mistakes which occur

in the text.

So much

this

the case that Bachet, the sole editor of the Greek text of

Diophantos, asserts his belief that they are


original ^
^

all

copied from one

This can, however, scarcely be said to be established,

The
13.

six mss. are

Vatican mss.

No. 191, xiii. c, cbarta bombycina. No. 200, XIV. c, charta pergamena. No. 304, XV. c, charta.

4.
5.
6.

MS. in Nat. Library at Paris, that used by Bachet for his text.
MS. in Palatine Library, collated for Bachet by Claudius Salmasius.

Xylander's ms. which belonged to Andreas Dudicius.

Colebrooke considers that 5 and 6 are probably identical.


-

"Etenim neque codex Eegius,


is

neque

cuius ope banc editionem adornavimus; quern prae manibus habuit Xilander; neque Palatinus, vt doctissimo
;

neque Vaticanus, quern vir suniniua lacobus Sirmondus mihi ex parte transcribendum curauit, quicquam amplius continent, quam sex hosce Arithmcticorum libros, et tractatum de iiumeris
viro ClauLlio Salmasio refcrente accepimus

multangulis imperfectum.

Sed

et tarn

infeUcitcr

consentiunt, vt ab vno fonte manasse et ab

hi omnes eodem exemplari

codices inter ae
dcscriptos fuisso
esse, veris-

non dubitem.
It will

Itaque

parum

auxilij

ab his subministratum nobis

simu allirmare possum,"

Epintola ad Lectorem.

be seen that the learned Bachet spells here, as everywhere, Xylander's


giving
it

name wrongly,

as Xilander.

20
for

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Bachet had no knowledge of two of the three Vatican MSS. and had only a few readings of the third, furnished to him by
Jacobus Sirmondus.
It is possible therefore that the collation

of the two remaining mss. in the Vatican

might even now lead

to important results respecting the settling of the text.

The

evidence of the existence in earlier times of

all

the thirteen

it absolutely incorrect. Bachet Regiomontanus asserts that he saw the thirteen books somewhere, and that Cardinal Perron, who had recently died, had often told him that he possessed a MS.

books
says
*

is

very doubtful, some of

that Joannes

containing the thirteen books complete, but, having lent


to a fellow-citizen,

it

who died

before returning

covered

it.

Respecting this latter


sufficient
it

had never reMS. mentioned by Bachet


it,

we have not
as to

data to lead us to a definite conclusion

whether

really corresponded to the title, or, like the

MSS.

which we knoAv, only announced thirteen books.


it is

If

it

really corresponded to the title,

remarkable how

(in

the

words of Nesselmann) every possible unfortunate circumstance and even the " pestis " mentioned by Bachet seem to have
conspired to rob
works.
posterity of at
least

a part of Diophantos'

Respecting the statement that Regiomontanus asserts that

he saw a MS. containing the thirteen books, it is clear that Xylander states in two it is founded on a misunderstanding. passages of his preface " that he found that Regiomontanus
1

"loannes tamen Regiomontanus tredecini Diophanti


asseverat,
et

libros

se

alicubi

vidisse

illustrissimus

Cardinalis

Perronius,

quern

nupei-

ex-

tinctum niagno Christianae

et literariae

Rcipublicae detrimeuto, conquerimur,

mihi saepe testatus


qui in

est, se

codicem manuscriptum habuisse, qui tredeeim Dio-

phanti libros integros contineret, quern cilm Gulielmo Gosselino conciui suo,

Diophantum Commentaiia meditabatur, perhumauiter more suo exhipauUo post accidit, ut Gossclinus peste correptus iuteriret, et Diophanti codex codem fato nobis criperetur. Cum enim prccibus meis motus Cardinalis amplissimus, nullisque sumptibus pai-cens, apud heredes Gosselini codicem ilium diligenter exquiri mandassct, et quouis pretio redimi, nusquam repertus
buisset,

est."
*

Ad

lectorcm.

"Inueni deinde tanquam exstantis in bibliothecis Italicis, sibique uisi mentionem a Regiomontano (cuius etiam nominis memoriam ueneror) factam."
Xylander, Epistola nuncupatoria.

"Sane tredeeim

libri

Arithmeticae Diophanti ab

aliis

perhibentur exstare in
Ibid.

bibliotheca Vaticana; quos

Regiomontanus

illo

uiderit."

HIS WORKS.

21

mentioned a MS. of Diophantos which he liad seen in an Italian library; and that others said that the thirteen books were
extant in the Vatican Library,
"

Now

as regards the latter statement,


;

which Regiomontanus saw." Xylander was obviously

wrongly informed
the thirteen books.

for

not one of the Vatican Mss. contains

It is necessary therefore to inquire to

what

passage or passages in Regiomontanus' writings Xylander

refers.

Nesselmann

finds only one place

which can be meant, an Oratio

habita Patavii in praelectione Alfragani^ in which Regiomon-

tanus remarks that


into

" no one has yet translated from the Greek Latin the thirteen books of Diophantosl" Upon this

Nesselmann observes
it

even if Regiomontanus saw a MS., had the thirteen books, except on the title-page and the remarks which Regiomontanus makes upon the contents show that he had not studied them thoroughly but it is not usually easy to see, by a superficial examination,
that,
it

does not follow that


;

into
is

how many

sections a Ms.

is

divided.

However,- this passage

mention of Diophantos by a European writer; the date of the Speech was probably about 1462. The only other passage, which Nesselmann was acquaintinteresting as being the
first

ed with and might have formed some foundation for Xylatider's


conclusion,
is

one in which Regiomontamis

(in

the same Oratio)

describes a journey which he

made

to

Italy for the purpose

of learning Greek, with the particular (though not exclusive)


1

Printed in the work

Eudimenta astronomica

Alfrarfani.

"Item Albaet

tegnius astronomus peritissimus de


propriis turn

motu

stellarum, ex observationibus turn

Ptolemaei, omnia

cum

demonstrationibus Geometricis
in

Addi-

tionibus Joannis de Eegiomonte.

Item Oratio introductoria

omnen scientias

praelegeret.

Mathematicas Joannis de Reijiomonte, Patavii habita, cum Alfraganum pnblice Ejusdem utilissima introductio in elementa Euclidis. Item Epis-

Omnia tola Philippi Melanthonis nuncupatoria, ad Senatum Noribergensem. jam recens prelis publicata. Norimbergae anno 1537. 4to." - The passage is: "Diofanti autem tredecim libros subtilissimos nemo osqnehac ex Graecis Latinos
videlicet rei et census,
It
fecit,

in quibus flos ipse totius Arithmeticae latet, are

quam

hodie vocant Algebram Arabico nomine."

does not follow from this, as Vossius maintains, that Kegiomontanus supcensus," which

posed Dioph. to be the inventor of algebra.

The "ars
equations,
is

rei et

is
;

not found in our Dioph.

and even supposing that


is

the solution of determinate quadratic it was given in

the MS. which liegiomontanus saw, this


special mention.

not a point which would

des4.r^o

22

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

object of turning into Latin certain Greek mathematical works\

But Diopliantos
of Cossali

is

not mentioned by name, and Nesselmann

it is a mere conjecture on the part and Xylander, that among tlie Greek writers mentioned and that we have in this passage Diophantos was included no ground for thinking, on the authority of these passages, that Regiomontanus saw the thirteen books in a complete form.

accordingly thinks that

to have known of a passage which is later than the Oration at Padua, and shows to my mind most clearly that Regiomontanus never saw the complete work. It is in a letter to Joannes de Blanchinis^ in which Regiomontanus states that he found at Venice " Diofantus," a Greek arithmetician who had not yet been

But Nesselmann does not seem


in another place,

translated into Latin


several powers
all
'^

that in the

proemium he defined the


whether he followed out

up

to the sixth, but

the combinations of these Regiomontanus does not

know

for not more than six books are found, though in the proemium he promises thirteen. If this book, a wonderful and difficult luork, could be found entire, I should like to translate it into Latin, for the knowledge of Greek I have lately acquired would
suffice

for thisV' &c.

The date

of this occurrence

is

stated

After the death of his teacher, Georg von Peurbach, he tells us he went

to

Eome

&c. with

orbitam

viri clarissimi sectarer?

Duce itaquo

igitur rehquum crat nisi ut tuum pro viribus exequerer? patrono communi Romam profectus more meo Uteris exerceor, ubi

Cardinal Bessaiion.

"Quid
felix

coeptum

scripta plurima

Graecorum clarissimorum ad literas suas disceudas me invitant, quo Latinitas in studiis praesertim Mathematicis locupletior redderetur." Peurbach died 8 April, llGl, so that tlie journey must have taken place between 1-lGl and 1171, when he permanently took up his residence at NiimDuring
Given on
this time

berg.

delivered the Oration), Venice,


2

he visited in order Eome, Ferrara, Padua (where he Rome (a second time) and Vienna.
v.

p.

135 of Ch. Th.

Murr's Memorabilia, Norimbergae, 1786, and

partly in Doppelmayr, Ilistorischc Nachricht von der Kiirnbergischen Mathe-

uml Kiimtlcrn, p. 5. Note y (Niiruberg, 1730). The whole passage is " Hoc dico dominationi uestrae me reperisse nunc uenetiis Diofantum aritlimeticum graecum nondum in latinum traductura. Hie in prohemio diiliniendo terminos huius artis ascendit ad cubum cubi, primura cnim uocat uumcrum, quern numeri uocant rem, secundum uocat potentiam, ubi uumeri dieunt censum, deinde cubum, deinde potentiam poteutiae, uocant numerum censum Ncscio tamen si oumes comde ceusu, item cubum de ccusu ct taudom cubi.
vuiticis
3

"

HIS WORKS.
in a note to be 1463.

2li

to the statement that

Here then we have a distinct contradicti-.u Regiomontanus speaks of having si-eu tliir-

teen books

so that Xylander's conchisions

No conclusion
letter to

must be abandoned. can be arrived at from the passage in F'ermat's

Digby (15 August 1G57) in which he says: The nanu' of this author (Diophantos) " me donne I'occasion de vous faire

me faire de recouvrer quelque manuscrit de c^t Autheur, qui contienne tous les treize livres, et de m'en faire part, s'il vous pent tomber en main."
souvenir de la promesse, qu'il vous a pleu

This

is

clearly

no evidence that a complete Diophantos existed

at the time.

Bombelli (1572) states the number of books to be seven\ showing that the MS. he used was Vatican No. 200.

To go
II. in

farther back

still

in time,

Maximus Planudcs, who

lived in the time of the Byzantine

the

first

the two

first

Emperors Andronicus I. and half of the 14th century, and wrote Scholia to books of the Arithmetics, given in Latin in

Xylander's translation of Diophantos,

knew

the work in the

same form

in

which we have

it,

so far as the first

two books
are due

are concerned.

From

these facts Nesselmann concludes that


it,

the corruptions and lacunae in the text, as we have

to a period anterior to the 14th or even the 13th century.

There are yet other means by which lost portions of Diophanmight have been preserved, though not found in the original text as it has come down to us. We owe the recovery of some
tos

Greek mathematical works to the finding of Arabic translations


of them, as for inststnce parts of Apollonios.
binationes

Now we know

horum proseeutus
in

nunc apud me sunt,

non enim reperiuntur nisi 6 eius libri qui prohemio autem pollicetur se scripturum tredecim. Si
fuerit.

liber hie qui reuera pulcerrimus est et diflicilimus, integer inueniretur [Doppel-

mayr, inueHi'atur] curarem


literae graecae

quas in

obsecro

si

apud uestros

eum latiuum facere, ad hoc enim sufficereut mihi domo domini mei reuerendissimi didici. Curate et uos usquam inueniri possit liber ille integer, sunt enim in
periti,

urbe uestra non nulli graecarum litterarum


tuae facuitatis libros huiusmodi occurrere.

quibus solent inter caetoros


si

Interim tamen,

suadebitis. Hex

dictos libros traducere in latinum occipiam, quatenus latinitas hoc

nouo

et

pretiosissimo
1

munere non

careat.
il

"Egli

e io, per arrichire

mondo

di cosi fatta opera, ci dessimo

i\

tradurlo

e cinque libri {delU settc che sotio) tradutti

ue abbiamo."

Bombelli, pref. to

Algebra.

24

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

that Diophantos was translated into Arabic, or at least studied and commented upon in Arabia. Why then should we not

be as fortunate in respect of Diophantos as with others ? In the second part of a work by Alkarkhi called the Fakhrl^ (an algebraic treatise) is a collection of problems in determinate and indeterminate analysis which not only indicate that their author had deeply studied Diophantos, but are, many of them, directly taken from the Arithmetics with the
change, occasionally, of some of the constants.
tions of Alkarkhi to
his Notice sur
le

The

obliga-

Diophantos are discussed by Wopcke in Fakhrl. In a marginal note to his MS. is a


iv.

remark attributing the problems of section


III.

and of section

in part to Diophantos^.

Now

section IV. begins with pro-

last 14 of Diophantos' Second Book, and ends with an exact reproduction of Book ill. Intervening between these two parts are twenty-five problems which are not found in our Diophantos. We might suppose then that we have

blems corresponding to the

here a lost Book of our author, and


so struck

Wopcke

says that he was


dis-

by the gloss

in the MS, that

he hoped he had

covered such a Book, but afterwards abandoned the idea for the
reasons
:

(1)

That the
first

first

twelve of the problems depend upon

equations of the

or second degree which lead, with

two

exceptions, to irrational results, whereas such were not allowed

by Diophantos.

(2)

The
;

thirteen other problems which are

indeterminate problems of the second degree are, some of them,


quite unlike Diophantos
others have remarks upon methods

employed, and references to the author's commentaries, which

we should not expect


Diophantos.
It

to find if the

problems were taken from

does not seem possible, then, to identify any part of


I

The book which

traits d' Algl'bre


1)52,

par Abou liekr

have made use of on this subject is: "Extrait dn Fakhrl, Mohammed ben Alhavan Alkarkhi (mauuscrit
la bibliothequc

supplement arabe de

Imperiale) pr^ced6 d'un m<?moire sur

I'Algebre ind<5termiiiee chez les Arabes, par F. Woepckc, Paris, 1858."


2

Wopcke's translation

of this gloss is: "J'ai vu en cet endroit


:

une glose de
de DioAli

I'dcriture d'Ibn Alsir&dj

en ces termes

Je dis, les probli'mes de cette section et

une partie de ceux de


phante, suivunt I'ordre.
Alsiiiulj Alkclaueci."

la section pr^c(5dente, scut pris

dans

les livres

Ceci fut 6crit par

Ahmed

IJen Abi 13eqr

Ben

Ben

HIS WORKS.

2.'>

lost.

the Fakhrl as having formed a part of Diophantos' work now Thus it seems probable to suppose that the form in which

the present.
of Dioph.

Alkarkhi found and studied Diophantos was not different from This view is very strongly supported by the followII.

ing evidence.

19

Bachet has already noticed tliat the solution is really only another solution of ii. 18, and
its

does not agree with

own
40)

enunciation.

Now

in

the Faklu^l
as

we have a problem
Dioph.
It
is
II.

(iv.

with
is

the

same enunciation

19,

but a solution which

not in Diophantos' manner.

remarkable to find
is

this followed
ii.

which

the same as Dioph.

by a problem (iv, 41) 20 (choice of constants always

It is then sufficiently probable that il. 19 and 20 followed each other in the redaction of Diophantos known to Alkarkhi and the fact that he gives a non-Diophantine

excepted).

solution of

19 would show that he had observed that the enunciation and solution did not correspond, and therefore set himself to work out a solution of his own. In view of this
II.

evidence

we may probably assume


its

that Diophantos' work had

already taken

present mutilated form

when

it

came

into

the hands of the author of the Fakhrl.

This work was written

by Abu Bekr

Mohammed

ibu

Alhasan Alkarkhi near the


;

beginning of the 11th century of our era


the 11th century.

so that the cor-

ruption of the text of Diophantos must have taken place before

There
last,

is

yet another Arabic work even earlier than this


lost,

apparently

the discovery of which would be of the


It
is

greatest historical interest and importance.

a work upon

Diophantos, consisting of a translation or a commentary by Mo-

hammed
is

Abu'1-Wafa, already mentioned incidentally.


discovery of his work
entire

doubtful whether the

enable us to restore any of the lost parts of Diophantos.


is

But it would There

of evidence

no evidence to lead us to suppose so, but there is a piece noted by Wopcke* which may possibly lead to

an opposite conclusion.

Abu'1-Wafa does not

satisfactorily deal

with the possible division of any number whatever into four Now the theorem of the possibility of such divi.siou squares.
Journal Asiatique.

Ciuqui^me

s^rie,

Tome

v. p.

231.

2b
is

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

assumed by Diophantos in several places, notably in iv. 31. have then two alternatives. Either (1) the theorem was not distinctly enunciated by Diophantos at all, or (2) It was

We

enunciated in a proposition of a lost Book.

In either case

Abu'1-Wafa cannot have seen the statement of the theorem ia Diophantos, and, if the latter alternative is right, we have an

argument

in favour of the
it is

view that the work had already been,

mutilated before

reached the hands of Abu'1-Wafa.

Now
of

Abu'l-Wafa's date

328388

of the Hegira, or

940988

our Era.
It

would seem, therefore, clear that the parts of Diophantos'


lacunae and
imperfections in the text had

Arithmetics which are lost were lost at an early date, and


that the present
their origin in all probability before the 10th century.
It

may be

said also with the

same amount

of probability

that the Porisms were lost before the 10th century a.d.

We

have perhaps an indication of this in the title of another work of Abu'1-Wafa, of which Wopcke's translation is " Demonstrations des thdoremes employes par
et de ceux

Diophante dans son ouvrage,

employes par (Aboul-Wafa) lui-meme dans son comIt is not possible to conclude with certainty from mentaire." the title of this work what its contents may have been. Are
the
"

theorems

"

those which Diophantos assumes, referring for

proofs of position
;

them
and,

to his

Porisms
which

This seems a not unlikely supit

if it is

correct,

would follow that the proofs


no longer in existence in
lost.

of these propositions,

Diophantos must have himself

given, in fact, the Porisms, were

the time of Abu'I-Wafa, or at least were lor him as good as


It

of

must be admitted then that we have no historical evidence the existence at any time subsequent to Diophantos himself

of the Porisms.

Of the
fragment.
It
is

treatise

It breaks

on Polygonal Numhers we possess only a off' in the middle of the 8th proposition.

not however probable that

much

is

wanting; practically

the treatise seems to be nearly complete. 2. The next (juestion which naturally suggests itself

is

As we have apparently six books only of the Arithmetics out of thirteen, where may we suppose the lost matter to have been

HIS WORKS.

27

at tlie beginning, micUHe, or This question can only be decided when we have come to a conclusion about the probable contents of the lost p<jrtion.
it

placed in the treatise?

Was

end?

been dogmatically asserted by many who have often without reading him at all, or reading him enough to enable them to form a judgment on the
It has, however,

written upon Diophantos

subject

that the Books, which

we

have, are the Jirst 9ix and

that the loss has been at the end; and such have accordingly

afterwards proceeded.
in

wondered what could have been the subject to which Diophantos To this view, which has no ground save
the

bare assertions of incompetent or negligent writers,


strongly.

Nesselmann opposes himself very


the contrary,

He
the

maintains on
sixth

with

much

reason,

that

in

Book

Diophantos' resources are at an end.

If one reads carefully

the last four Books, from the third to the sixth, the conclusion

upon one that Diophantos moves in a rigidly defined and limited circle of methods and artifices, that any attempts which he makes to free himself are futile. But this fact can
forces itself
onl}^

be adequately appreciated after a perusal of his entire


It

work.

may, however, be further added that the sixth Book


it is

forms a natural conclusion to the whole, in that


of exemplifications of

made up

methods explained and used


subject
is

in the pre-

ceding Books.

The

the

finding of

right-angled

triangles in rational numbers, such that the sides satisfy given

conditions, Arithmetic being applied to

Geometry

in the geosaid

metrical

notion

of the

right-angled

triangle.

As was

above,

we have now

to consider Avhat the contents of the lost

first

Books of the Arithmetics may have been. Clearly we must inquire what is actually wanting which we should have expected to find there, either as promised by the author
himself in his

own work,

or as necessary for the elucidation or

completion of the whole.

We

must therefore

briefly indicate

the general contents of the work as

we have

it.

The

first

equations of the
1

book contains problems leading to determinate first degree'; the remainder of the work being

of the rash way in which even good writers speak of Dioinstance here a remark of Viucenzo Riccati, who says: "De problematibus determiuatis quae rcsulutis aequatiouibus dignoscuutur, nilill

As a specimen
I

phantos,

may

28

DIOPH.\^TOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

a collection of problems which, with scarcely an exception, lead


to indeterminate equations of the second degree, beginning with

simpler cases and advancing step by step to more complicated


questions.

These indeterminate or semideterminate problems


collection.

form the main feature of the

Now

it is

a great step

from determinate equations of the first degree to semideterminate and indeterminate problems of the second; and we must
recognise that there
is

here an enormous gap in the exposition.

ought surely to find here (1) determinate equations of the second degree and (2) indeterminate equations of the first.

We

With regard
writer's plan;

to

(2), it is

quite true that


itself

we have no
is

definite

statement in the work


probable supposition.
quadratic equations,

that they formed part of the

but that they were discussed here

an extremely
determinate

With
on the

regard
other

to

(1)

or

hand,

we

have

certain

evidence from the writer's

own

words, that the solution of the


it

adfected or complete quadratic was given in the treatise as


originally stood
;

for,

in the first place, in

Diophantos promises a
(def.

discussion of

them

the introductory definitions


for

11)

where he gives rules

the reduction of equations of the


secondly, he uses his

second degree to their simplest forms;

method

for their solution in

the later Books, in some cases


it out,

simply giving the result of the solution without working

in others giving the irrational part of the root in order to find

an approximate value in integers, without writing down the


actual root\

We
(!);

find

examples of pure quadratic equations


duntaxat de eo problematum semidetenninatorum

oninino Diophantus

agit

genere, quae respiciimt quadrata, aut cubos

numerorum, quae problemata ut


Pref. to ana-

resolvantur, (juantitates radicales de industria sunt vitandae."


litiche istituzioni.
^

These being tbe indications in the work


die

itself,

what are we

to think of a

recent writer of a History of Mathematics,

who

says: "Hieraus

und aus dem


Theorie dcr

Umstand, dass Diophant nirgends


nicht gekannt,
zugctlieilt,"

von ihm versprochene


gibt, schloss

Auflosung der quadratiscben Gleichungen

man,

und bat desshalb den Arabern stets den Ruhm and goes on to say that "nevertheless Nesselmann after a thorough study of the work is convinced that D. knew the solution of the quadratic"? It is almost impossible to imagine that these remarks are serious. The writer is Dr Heinricli Suter, (Jcschichte d. Mathetmitischen WissemchaJ'ten. Zweite
Autliigf.

habe dieselbe dieser ErtinJuug


er

Ziiricb, 1873.

HIS Wol^KS.

29

first Book a fact which shows that Diophantos regarded them as in reality simple equations, taking, as he does, the positive value of the root only. Indeed it would seem that

even in the

Diophantos adopted as his ground


quantity contained in
it,

for the classification of these

equations, not the index of the highest power of the

unknown

but the number of terms left in it when it is reduced to its simplest form. His words are': "If the same powers of the unknown occur on both sides but with different coefficients we must take like from like until we have one single expression equal to another.
sides, or

If there are on both


coefficients,

on either

side,

terms with negative

the

defects

must be added on both

sides, until there are the

powers on both sides with positive


take like from like as before.
single

coefficients,

same when we must


if

We

must contrive always,

possible, to reduce our equations so that they

may
left

contain one
will
to

term equated to one other.

But afterwards we
equal

explain to you also hoiu, luhen two terms are


-

a
5^

Diophantos' actual words (which I have trauslated


d-rrb

freely) are:

MtrA

Tavra eav
5^ dirb

irpo^Xr^^iaTos tlvos -yh-qrai virap^ii eldeffi rots


fiepuiv,

avroh

jurj

ofioTrXTjBfj

eKar^puv twv

deriaa

a.<paipe'it> to.

ofxoia dir6

twu

6/xoiwv, ?a)S &v ^'ds(!)

elSoj pI eidei tjov

-yiv-qTaf
etSr),

eav de ttws if OTror^pu} ivvirapxTJ^^), ^ ^v dfKporipois


irpoaBelvaL
to,

iveWei^f/r] (?)
fxipeaii',

rivk
Slp

de-qaei

Xeivovra

etOT)

if

dfjLcpor^poii

roh

ews

eKarepij)

tQv

fxepQiv

rd

ei5r]

ivvirdpxovra. y^vrjTai.
tCiv fxepQ)V

Kal TraXi;' a'^e-

Xelv

Ta

6p.oi.a

diro

rwc onoiuf, ?ws &v

eKarepij)

if eTooi KaTa\(i<p6rj.

ne(pCKoTex''''i)<^6w

S^

tovto eu rats vvoffrdaecn twv irpordaiwv, lav eVS^^'n'ot. ?wi


vcrrepov 5^ aoi del^o/xev Kal

hv if eldos
ivi

vl etdei tffov KaraKucpdrj.

nUk dvo ddwv tcuv


it

KaraXeKpO^vTUV to toiovtov XvcTai.


I give

Bachet's text exactly, marking those places where

seems obviously

WTong.

KCLTaXeL^drj

should of course be KaTaXeicpO^.

It is worth observing that L. Kodet, in Journal Asiatique, Janvier, 1878, on "L'Algebre d'Al-Ivliarizmi et les muthodes indienne et grecque," quotes this His passage, not from Bachet's text, but from the MS. which Bachet used.

readings show the following variations


Bachet.
yiv7)Tai
yevq(TTaL
[??

L. Rodet.

How

about the construc-

tion with idv ?]


virap^is

Tiva

icra

ivbs el8os
ivtXXeixpri

if elSos

iv

X(L\l/ei.

doubt the latter word very much, compounded as the verb is with the
[I

prep, iu twice repeated.]

so
third, such

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
a question
is solved."

That

is

to say, "reduce

when
I

possible the quadratic to one of the forms


will give later

x = a,

or x^

= b.

x^ax=
as

b."

a method of solution of the complete equation Now this promised solution of the complete
is

quadratic equation

nowhere to be found in the Arithmetics in the second and following Books We have to decide, there are obvious cases of its employment. then, where it might naturally have come; and the answer is that the suitable place is between the first and second Books. But besides the entire loss of an essential portion of Diophautos' work there is much confusion in the text even of that

we have them, though

portion which remains.

Thus

clearly

problems

6,

7,

18,

19 of

the second Book, which contain determinate problems of the

Again, as already redegree, belong in reality to Book I, marked above, the problem enunciated in ii. 19 is not solved at all, but the solution attached to it is a mere " dXKco^" of ii. 18. Moreover, problems 1 5 of Book il. recall problems already solved in i. Thus il. l = l. 34: ii. 2 = 1. 37: ii. 3 is similar The problem i. 29 seems to I. 33 II. 4 = I. 35 li. 5 = I. 36. In the second Book a also out of place in its present position. new type of problem is taken up at il. 20, and examples of it
first

are continued through the third Book.

marked division between Books ii. and ill. in modern notation, the last two problems
of
III.

There is no sign of a In fact, expressed of li. and the first

are the solutions of the following sets of equations


35.

II.

x''+[x

+ y + z) = a^
-ir

y^+{x + y + z)=h'' :^ + [x y z) = c"


-\-

II.

36.

x^{x + y-\-z)= ay--{x + y + z) = lA


z"

-{x+y + z)=c-

III. 1.

+ y + z) -.!' = a" {x + y + z)~y' = U' {x + y + z)-2' = c'


(x

These
therefore

follow
it

perfectly

naturally

upon each other;

and

is

quite likely that our division between the two

; ;

HIS WORKS.

31
tlie

Books was not the original one. rence of more definite divisions
coupled with the variation
six
in

In fact
in
tlie

frequent occur-

middle of the Books, the Vatican Ms. which divides our

Books into seven, seems to show that the work may have been divided into even a larger number of Books originally. Besides the displacements of problems which have probably taken place there are many single problems which have been much corrupted, notably the fifth Book, which has, as Nesselmann expresses it\ been "treated by Mother Time in a very stepmotherly fashion". It is probable, for instance, that between V. 21 and 22 three problems have been lost. In several other
cases the solutions are confused or incomplete.

How

the im-

perfections of the text were introduced into


jecture.

it

we can

only conto the

Nesselmann thinks they cannot be due merely

carelessness of a copyist, but are rather due, at least in part, to

the ignorance and inexpertness of one

who wished

to

improve

upon the

original.

The

view,

which was put

forward

by

Bachet, that our six Books are a redaction or selection

made

from the complete thirteen by a later hand, seems certainly


untenable.

The

treatise

on Polygonal Numbers

'

is

in its subject related


is

to the Arithmetics, but the


different.

mode

of treatment

completely

an analytical work, but a synthetic one the author enunciates propositions and then gives their proofs X. of in fact the treatise is quite in the manner of Books vil. Euclid's elements, the method of representing numbers by
It is not

geometrical lines being used, which Cossali has called linear


Arithmetic.

This method of representation

is

only once used in


v. 13,

the Arithmetics proper, namely in the proposition


it is

where

and y have to be so determined that aj + 2, ?/ + 6 are both squares, we have to divide the number 9 into two squares of which one must be > 2 and < 3. From the use of this linear method in this one case in the Anthmetics, and commonly in the treatise on Polygonal Numbers,
used to prove that
if
a;

+ 7/=l,

and

a;

we
1

see that even in the time of Diophantos the geometrical

representation of
"Namentlich

numbers was thought


dicser Hinsicht daa fuufte
p. 2GB.

to

have the advantage


stiefmutterlich von dcr

ist in

Buch

Mutter Zeit behandelt woiden."

3.2

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
It

need scarcely be remarked how opposed modern ones, our tendency being the reverse, viz., to the representation of lines by numbers. The treatise on Polygonal Numbers is often, and probably rightly, held to be one of the thirteen original Books of the Arithmetics. There is absolutely no reason to doubt its genuineness which
of greater clearness.
this

Greek method

is

to our

remark would have been unnecessary but


Bossut to the
les six

for

a statement by
arithmetiques,

effect: "II avoit dcrit treize livres d'


(?)

premiers
si,

sont arrives jusqu'a nous

tons les autres

sont perdus,

ndanmoins, un septieme, qu'on trouve dans

quelques(!) editions de Diophante, n'estpas de lui"; upon which

Reimer has made a note " This Book on Polygonal Numbers is an independent work and cannot possibly belong to the Collection
:

of Diophantos' Arithmetics^"

This statement

is

totally un-

founded.
that
it is

With
Books
;

respect to Bossut's

almost certain that

own remark, we have seen the Books we possess are not the
all

first six

again, the treatise on Polygonal Numbei's does


of the editions of Diophantos
is

not only occur in some, but in

from Xylander to Schulz

and, lastly, Bossut

the only person

who has

ever questioned

its

genuineness.

We mentioned above the Porisms of Diophantos. Our knowledge of them is derived from his own words in three places in the Arithmetics he refers to them in the words exo/j-ev
;

iv

Tot<?

iropiaixacnv

the places are V.

3, 5, 19.

The

references

made

to

them

are for proofs of propositions in the Theory of


in these problems as

Numbers, which he assumes


sitions

known.

It

is

probable therefore that the Porisms were a collection of propo-

concerning the properties of certain numbers, their

divisibility into a certain


is

number

of squares,

and

so

on

and

it

reasonable to suppose that from

them he takes

also the

many

other propositions which he assumes, either explicitly enunciating


I

them, or implicitly taking them


to

for granted.

May we

not then

reasonably suppose the Porisms to have formed an introduction


the

indeterminate

and semi-determinate analysis of the

second degree which forms the main subject of the

A 7'ithmetics?

And may we
'

not assume this introduction to have formed an

"Dieses Buch de numeris multanguUn ist cine fiir sich bestehendc Schrift und gehort keinesweges in die Sammluug der Arithmeticorum Diophant'e."

Ills

WORKS.
?

3?

integral part,

now

lost,

of the original thirteen books

If this

supposition

is

correct the Po7'isms also

must have intervened be-

tween Books I. and ll., where we have already said that probably Diophantos treated of indeterminate problems of the first
degree and of the solution of the complete quadratic.

The

method
gonal

of the

Ponsms was

iVwrnfters,
;

probably synthetic, like the Polynot (like the six Books of the Anthmetics)

analytical

to include all three treatises

however forms no sufficient reason for refusing under the single title of thirteen Books of Arithmetics. These suppositions would account easily
this

for the contents of

the lost Books

they would

also,

with the

additional evidence of the division of our text of the Arithmetics


into seven books

by the Vatican

MS.,

show that the

lost portion

probably does not bear such a large proportion to the whole as

after

might be imagined. This view is adopted by Colebrooke \ and him by Nesselmann, who, in support of his hypothesis
that the Arithmetics, the Porisms and the treatise on Polygonal

title of dptd/jLTjTLKa,

Numbers formed only one complete work under the general points out the very significant fact that we never find mention of more than one work of Diophantos, and
seem
to

that the very use of the Plural Neuter term, dpid/xrjTiKa, would

imply that

it

was a

collection of different treatises on

arithmetical subjects and of different content.


ever, does not

Nesselmann, how-

seem

to

have noticed an objection previously urged

Algebra of the Hindus, Note M. p. lxi. "In truth the division of manuscript books is very uncertain: and it is by no means improbable that the remains of Diophantus, as we possess tlicni, may be less incomplete and constitute a larger portion of the thirteen books announced by him (Def. 11) than is commonly reckoned. His treatise on polygon
^

numbers, which
as
it

is surmised to be one (and that the last of the thirteen), follows, seems, the six (or seven) books in the exemi)lar8 of the work, as if the

preceding portion were complete.


essentially different

It is itself imperfect:

but the manner

is

from that of the foregoing books: and the solution

of

problems by equations is no longer the object, but rather the demonstration of propositions. There appears no gi-ouud, beyond bare surmise, to presume, that the author, in the rest of the tracts relative to numbers which fulfilled
his promise of

thirteen books, resumed the Algebraic


is at

manner: or
a single

in

short,

that the Algebraic part of his performance


extant,

all

mutilated in the copies


imperfect

which are considered to be

all

transcripts of

exemplar."

H. D.

34

DIOPllANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

against the theory that the three treatises formed only one work,

by Schulz, to the effect that Diophantos expressly says that his work treats of arithmetical problems^. This statement itself does not seem to me to be quite accurate, and I cannot think
that
it

is

at all a valid objection to Nesselmann's view.

The

passage to which Schulz refers must evidently be the opening

words of the dedication by the author to Dionysios. Diophantos begins thus: "Knowing that you are anxious to become acquainted with the solution [or
'

discovery,' eupecri?] of

problems
the pre-

in numbers, I set myself to systematise the method, beginning

from the foundations on which the science

is

built,

liminary determination of the nature and properties in numbers^."

Now

these "foundations"

may

surely well

mean more than

is

given in the eleven definitions with which the treatise begins,

and why should not the "properties of numbers" refer to the But there is Porisms and the treatise on Polygonal Numbers another passage which might seem to countenance Schulz's objection, where (Def. 11) Diophantos says "let us now proceed to the propositions'... which we will deal with in thirteen Books\"
.?

The word used here


(TrporaaL^;),

is

not problem

{Trpo/SXTj/xa)

but proposition

although Bachet translates both words by the same


" quaestio," inaccurately.

Latin word

Now

the word irporaaL^;


:

does not only apply to the analytical solution of a problem


applies equally to the synthetic method.

it

word here might very well


1

Thus the use of the imply that the work was to contain
(pref. xxi.):

Schulz remarks on the Porisms

"Es

ist

daher nicht uuwahr-

Bcheinlich dass diese Porismeu eine eigene Schrift uuseres Diophautus wareu,

welche vorziiglich die Zusammensetzung dcr Zahlen aus gew-issen Bestaudtheilen zu ihrem Gegeustando hattc.

Kunnte

man

diesc Schrift gar als eine

Bestandtheil

des

grossen

in

dreizehn

Biichern

abgefassten arithmetischen

Werkes anseheu,

so wiire es sehr erkliirbar, dass gerade dieser Theil, der den

blossen Liebhaber weniger anzog, verloren ging.


driickiich sagt, sein

Da indess Diophantus ausWerk behandele arithmetische Probleme, so hat weuigstens die letztere Annahme nur einen geringen Grad von Wahrscheinhchkeit." * Diophantos' own words are: Tiju tvptcnv twv iv roh apid/ioTs Trpo^XijfidTuiv,
TifU(l)TaT^ fiOL AiovOffie, -yivilKTKtiiv ae cnrovdalus
iweipdOrji', dp^ofKifOS
d(f>'

^xovra naOuv, opyavwcrai r^c /j^dodov


0e(jif\lii)v,

uv avviarrjKe rd Trpaynara

vTroaTTJffai Trjv iv tois

dptOfioh
*

tpvffiv

T Kal Swaniv. rds irpordans x^RV'^'^t^^"'


'^'''

vvv 5^

iirl

T^s irpay/xareiai avrQv kv TpiffKaldfKa fii^Xlois yiyivripiivr)s.

HIS WORKS.

;i5

not only problems, but propositions on numbers, i.e. miglit include the Po7'isms and Polygonal Numbers as a part of the complete Arithmetics. These objections which I have made
to Schulz's

argument

are, I think,

objection to the view adopted by


Schulz's

enough to show that his Nesselmaun has no weight.


Books of

own view
is

as to the contents of the missing

Diophantos

that they contained

new methods

of solution in

addition to those used in Books

I. to vi., and that accordingly the lost portion came at the end of the existing six Books. In

particular he thinks that Diophantos extended in the lost Books

the method of solution by means of what he calls a doubleequation {Bi7r\r] laorr]^ or in one word
hi,Tr\ola6rr}<;).

By means
it

of this double-equation Diophantos shows of the

how

to find a value

unknown, which

will

make two

expressions containing

(linear or quadratic) simultaneously squares.

Schulz accordingly

thinks that he went on in the lost Books to show


three such expressions simultaneously squares,
triple-equation.
i.e.

how

to

make

advanced to a
find

This view, however, seems to have nothing to

recommend

it,

inasmuch
is

as, in

the

first place,

we nowhere

the slightest hint in the extant Books of anything different or

more advanced which

to

come

and, secondly, Diophantos'

system and ideas seem so self-contained, and his methods to

move always in the same certain that we come in our


There
is

well-defined circle that


six

it

seems

Books

to the limits of his art.

lost Books,

yet another view of the probable contents of the which must be mentioned, though we cannot believe that it is the riglit one. It is that of Bombelli, given by Cossali, to the effect that in the lost Books Diophantos went on to solve determinate equations of the third and fourth degree; Bombelli's reason for supposing this is that Diophantos gives so many

problems the object of which


a suitable value of the

is

to

make
;

the

sum

of a square

and any other number to be again a square number by finding


first

square

these methods, argues

Bombelli, of Diophantos must have been given for the reason


that the author intended to use

them

for the solution of the

equation x*-\-px
1

= q^.

Now

Bombelli had occupied himself


1'

Cossali's

words are

(p. 75,

76):..."non tralascier<i di notarc


diil

opinionc, di

cui fu teutato Bombelli, chc nclli soi libri cioe

tempo, di tutto

distrufe'gitore,

32

36

DIOPHAXTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
his

much, almost during

whole

life,

with the then new methods

of solution of equations of the third

and fourth degree

and, for

the solution of the latter, the usual method of his time led to

the making an expression of the form

Ax^+ Bx + C
unknown

a.

square,

where the
in

coefficients

involved

a second
it

quantity.

Nesselmann accordingly thinks


Diophantos'
entirely

is

no matter

for surprise that

independent investigations Bombelli

should have seen, or fancied he saw, his own favourite idea.

This solution of the equation of the fourth degree presupposes that of the cubic with the second term wanting hence Bombelli
;

would naturally, in accordance with his view, imagine Diophantos It is possible also that to have given the solution of this cubic. he may have been influenced by the actual occurrence in the extant Books [vi. 19] of a cubic equation, namely the equation
x^

solution

+ x = 4x^ + 4, a; = 4,

of

which Diophantos at once writes down the


It
is

without explanation.

obvious, however,
is

that no conclusion can be drawn from this, which

a very

easy particular case, and which Diophantos probably solved^ by

simply dividing out by the factor x^+l.


objections to Bombelli's view.
(1)

There are strong

Diophantos himself states

(Def. XI.) that the solution of the problems is the object in itself

of the work.

(2)

If

he used the method to lead up to the


In support of the view
is
it

solution of equations of higher degrees, he certainly has not gone


to

work the shortest way.

has been

asked "What, on any other assumption,


in

the object of defining


?

Def

ll.

all

powers of the unknown quantity up to the sixth


egli

rapitici, si

avanzasse

a sciogliere

1'

equazionc

x*+px-q,

parendogli, die

nei libri riinastici, con proporsi di trovar via via numeri quadrati,

cammini una

strada a qucU' intento.

Egli e di fatto procedendo sn queste tracce di Diofanto,

che Vieta deprime

1'

esposta equazione di giado quarto ad una di secondo.


si

Siccome

pen"!*

cio
il

non

effettua che

mediante una cubica mancante

di

secondo

termine; cosi

pcnsiero sorto in auimo a Bombelli iniporterebbc, che Diofanto


scioglimento di quella equazione di quarto

nei libri perduti costituito avesse la regola di sciogliere questa sorta di equa-

zione cubicbe prima

d' innoltrarsi alio

grado."
'

This

is

certainly a simpler explanation than Bachet's,


ar*
:

who

derives the

solution from the proportion

.x-=x
:

1.

Therefore

x' + x x^ + x
.r''-)-.r

x- + l

=
it

.r

1.
:

Therefore

4x^

+i=x

i.

But the equation being

4j-'-'

+ 4,

follows that

x-i.

HIS WORKS.

37

Surely Diophantos must have meant to use them."


to

The answer
but

which

is

that he has occasion to use

them

in the work,

reduces

all

the equations which contain these higher powers by

his regular

and uniform method of

analysis.
is

In conclusion, I

may

repeat that the most probable view

that adopted by Nesselmann, that the works which

we know

under the three titles formed part of one arithmetical work, which was, according to the author's own words, to consist of
thirteen Books.
is

The proportion
it

of the lost parts to


to be. to

tlie

whole
for

probably less than

form the part,

might be supposed the loss of which is most


it
is

The Ponsnis

be regretted,

from the references to them


propositions in the Theory of

clear

that they contained


for

Numbers most wonderful

the

time.

CHAPTER

III.

THE WRITERS UPON DIOPHANTOS.


1. In this chapter I purpose to give a sketch of what has been done directly, and (where it is of sufficient importance) indirectly, for Dioph antes, enumerating and describing briefly (so far as possible) the works which have been written on the
subject.

We

turn

first,

men

and we find

that, if

of Hypatia," spoken of

written anything at

all

own countrycommentary above, there is only one Greek, who has on Diophantos, namely the monk Maxinaturally, to Diophantos'

we except the doubtful

"

mus

Planudes, to
I.

whom
in

are attributed the scholia attached to


MSS.,

Books
is

and

ii.

some

which are printed in Latin

in

Xylander's translation of Diophantos.


the
first

The date

of these scholia
all

half of the 14th century, and they represent

that

we know
men.

to

have been done

for

Diophantos by his own country-

would have been, had he lived a the Greeks was still active, what an enormous impression his work would then have created, we may judge by comparing the effect which it had with that of a far less important work, that of Nikomachos.
different his fate
little earlier,

How

when the

scientific spirit of

Considering then that up to the time of Maximus Planudes nothing was written about Diophantos (beyond a single quotation by Theon of Alexandria, before mentioned, and an occa-

mention of the name) by any Greek, one is simply astounded at finding in Bossut's history a remark like the following " L'auteur a eu parmi les anciens une foule d'intersional
:

prfetes

(!),

dont

les

ouvrages sont
le

la

plupart

(!)

perdus.

Nous

regrettons,

dans ce nombre,
(sic)."

Hipathia

Comment

is

commentaire de la cdlebre With respect to unnecessary.

THK WRITKHS UPON DK H'HANTc )S.


the work of

:][)

Maximus Planudes
two Books, the

itself,

he has only commented

upon the
tary,

first

least

important and most olomen-

nor can his scholia be said to have any importance. Bachet speaks contemptuously of them\ and even the modest Xylander has but a low opinion of their value^

2.

have, in

first

mentioning Maximus Planudes, defor the greater con-

parted a

little

from chronological order,


first

venience of giving

the Greek writers upon Diophantos.

Diophantos had found


the respect
it

But long before the time of Maximus Planudes, the work of its way to Arabia, and there met with
deserved.

Unfortunately the actual works writall lost,

ten in Arabia directly upon Diophantos are

or at

lea.st

have not been discovered up to the present time. So far therefore as these are concerned we have to be contented with the
notices on the subject

by Arabian

historians or bibliographers.

It is therefore necessary to collect

from the

earliest

and best

sources possible the scattered remarks about Diophantos and

The earliest and therefore presumably the best and most trustworthy authority on the subject of Diophantos in Arabia is the Kifab Alfihrist of al-Nadim', the date of which The passages in this work which is as early as circa 990 a,d.
his works.
refer to
(a)
I

Diophantos are
p.

=
1

t;

269, "Diophantos [the last vowel, however, being in one codex, in the rest undetermined] the Greek of

Bachet says:

tiones edi

"Porro Graeci Sclioliastae non curauimus, vt quae nullius

in duos priores libros adnotasint

momenti, easque proinde

Guilielmus Xilander(!) censura sua meritd perstrinxerit, si cut tamen oleum operamque perderc a(le7) leue est, vt miras GraecuU huius ineptias peruidcre
cupiat, adeat Xilandrum."
-

bats
fuit,

Xylander says the Scholia are attributed to Maximus Planudes, and comthe view that they might be Hjiiatia's thus: "Sed profecto si ea tanta quantam Suidas et alij perhibent, istae annotationes cam autorcm non
liberfe dixi suis locis."

apnoscunt, de quibus quid senserim, raeo more

Kpistola

Nuncupatoria.
3

This work has been edited by

Fliigel, 1871.

The author himself


18.55,

dates

it
it

987,

and Wcipcke (Journal Asiatique, F^vrier-Mars,

p. 2.56) states that

was finished at that date. This is, however, not correct, for in his preface shows that the work contains references to events which are certainly cir<-a later than <)87, so that it seems best to say simply that the date is
Fliigel

990

A.I).

40
Alexandria.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

He

wrote Kitab Sina'at al-jabr,"

i.e.

"the book of
is

the art of algebra."


(h)

p. 283,

Among

the works of Abii'1-Wafa

mentioned

"An

interpretation' (tafsir) of the

book

of

Diophantos about

algebra."
(c)

On
is

Wafa

the same page the title of another work of Abu'lgiven as " Demonstrations of the theorems employed

by Diophantos in his work, and of those employed by (Abu'lWafa) himself in his commentary " (the word is as before
tafsir).

{d)

p.

295,

On Kosta
is

ibn

Luka

of Ba'lbek it

is

mentioned

that one of his books

tafsir

on three-and-a-half divisions

(Makalat) of the book of Diophantos on " questions of numbers."

We have thus in the Fihrist mentions of three separate works upon Diophantos, which must accordingly have been written previously to the year 990 of our era. Concerning Abu'1-Wafa the evidence of his having studied and commented upon Diophantos is conclusive, not only because his other works which have survived show unmistakeable signs of the influence
of Diophantos, but because the proximity of date of the Fihrist
to that of

Abu'1-Wafa makes all mistake impossible. As I have was written circa 990 A.D. and the date of Abu'1-Wafa is 328388 a.h. or 940998 A.D. He was a native of Buzjan, a small town between Herat and Nishapur in Khorasan, and was evidently, from what is known of his works one of the most celebrated astronomers and geometers of his time^. Of later notices on this subject we may mention those
said the Fihrist
'

There

is

little

doubt as to the exact meaning of tafsir

whether
may

it

means

a translation or a commentary.
gesis of the

Koran
ibn

The word how much it means


al-Khruizml.
a

is

usually applied to the literal exe-

in the present case

perhaps be

ascertainable from the fact that Abu'1-Wafa also wrote a tafsir of the Algebra of

Mohammed

Musa

It certainly,

according to the usual sense,

mere translation e.g. at p. 249 al-Nadim clearly distinguishes translators of Aristotle from the mufassirln or makers of tafsir, i.e.

means a commentary not

commentators. For this information


Smith.
-

am

indebted to the kindness of Professor Robertson

Wcipcke, Journal Asiatiqne, Ft'vrier-Mars, 1855, p. 244


full

foil.

Abu'l-Wafa's

name

is

Mohammed

ibn

Mohammed

ibn

Yahya ibn Ismail

ibn Al'abbfis Abu'1-Wafa Al-Iiuzjani.

THE WRITERS UPON DIOPHANTOS.


in the

41

Tarlkh Ilokoma (Hajji-Khalifa, No. 2204), by tho Imam ibn. 'Abd al-Karim al-Shahrastani wlio died A.ii. 548 or A.D. 1153\ Of course this work is not so trustworthy an authority as the Fihrist, which is about 160 years earlier, and the author of the Tarlkh HoJcoma stands to the Fihrist in the

Mohammed

In the Tarikh Abu'1-Wafa " wrote a commentary on the work of Diophantos concerning Algebra," (6) that Diophantos, the Greek of Alexandria, conspicuous, perfect, famous in his time, wrote a famous work on the art of

relation of a compiler to the original source.

Hokoma we

are told {a) that

'

Algebra, which has gone over into Arabic,"


lated.

i.

e.

been trans-

must obviously connect these two notices. Lastly the same work mentions (c) another work of Abu'1-Wafa, namely Proofs for the propositions given in his book by
'

We

Diophantos."

A later writer
ties,

still,

Abu'lfaraj, mentions,

the author of the History of the Dynasamong celebrated men who lived in
"

the time of Julian, Diophantos, with the addition that

His

book^..ou Algebra

is

celebrated,"
"

and again

in another place

he says upon Abu'1-Wafa,

He commented upon

the work of

Diophantos on Algebra."

The
^

notices from al-Shahrastani and Abu'lfaraj are, as I have


Bibliotheca arabico-hispana Escurialensis op. et studio Mich.
1760, gives

The work
Matriti,

Casiri,

many

important notices about mathematicians


title

from the Ta'rikh Hokoma, which Casiri denotes by the


sophorum.

Bibliotheca philo-

Cossali mentions the Ta'rikh Hokoma as having been written about a.d. 119^! by an anonymous person: "II hbro piti antico, che ci fornisca tratti relativi
all'

origine dell' analisi tra gli arabi e la Bihlioteca arabica de' jilosoji, scritta
1'

circa

anno 1198 da anonimo egiziano"

(Cossali,

i.

p. 174).

now apparently no doubt


the text.
2

that the author was al-Shahrastani, as

There is however I have said in


is

After the word

"book"

in the text

comes a word Ab-kismet which


it:

un-

intelligible.

PocoQke, the Latin translator, simply puts A. B. for

"cuius liber

The word or words are apparently Nesselmann conjectures that the original word was an Arabic translation of the Greek title, Arithmetics a supposition which, if true, would give admirable sense. The passage would then mark the Arabian perception of the discrepancy (according to the accepted meaning of termn)
A.
13.

quern Algebram vocat, Celebris est."


;

a corruption of something

between the

title

and the

subject,

which

is

obviously rather algebra than arith-

metic in the strict sense.

42
said, for

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
obvious reasons not so trustworthy as those in the

Fihrist.

They

are,

however, interesting as showing that Diofor

phantos continued to be kno^vn and recognised


able period after his work found
its

a consider-

way

to Arabia,

and was

commented upon, though they add nothing to our information as to what was done for Diophantos in Arabia. It is clear that the work of Abu'1-Wafa was the most considerable that was written in Arabia upon Diophantos directly ; about the obligations
to

Diophantos of other Arabian

writers,

as indirectly

shown by

3.

similarity of matter or method, without direct refer-

ence, I shall have to speak later.


I

now

pass to the writers on Diophantos in Europe.

From

the time of

Maximus Planudes

to a period as late as

about 1570 Diophantos remained practically a sealed book, and

had to be rediscovered even after attention had been invited to it by Regiomontanus, who, as was said above, was the first European to mention it as extant. We have seen (pp. 21, 22) that Regiomontanus referred to Diophantos in the Oration at Padua, about 1462, and how in a very interesting letter to
Joannes de Blanchinis he speaks of finding a MS. of Diophantos at Venice, of the pleasure he would have in translating it if he could
only find a copy containing the whole of the thirteen books, and
his readiness to translate

even the incomplete work in

six books,

in case

it

were desired.
;

But

it

does not appear that he ever

began the work it seems, however, very extraordinary that the which Regiomontanus took in Diophantos and tried to arouse in others should not have incited some of his German
interest

countrymen

to follow his leading, at least as early as

1537,

when we know

that his Oration at

Padua was
it

published.

Hard
Italian,

to account for as the fact

may

appear,

was

left for

an

Bombelli, to rediscover Diophantos about 1570; though the

mentions by Regiomontanus

may be

said at last to have borne

their fruit, in that about the

same time Xylander was en-

couraged by them to persevere in his intention of investigating Nevertheless between the time of Regiomontanus Diophantos.

and that

of Rafael Bombelli Diophantos

gotten, or rather

mentions of

tlie

was once more forunknown, for in the interval we find two name, (a) b} Joachim Camerarius in a letter

THE WRITERS UPON DIOPHANTOS.


published 1556\ in which he mentions that there
is

43
a MS. of

Diophantos in the Vatican, which he

is

anxious to

see, (6)

by
the

James

who merely mentions important mathematicians who preceded


Peletarius^
Pacioli towards the

the name.

Of

taglia

Bombelli, Fra Luca end of the loth century. Cardan and Tarin the 16th, not one so much as mentions Diophantos^

The first Italian to whom Diophantos seems to have been known, and who was the first to discover a MS. in the Vatican Library, and to conceive the idea of publishing the work, was Bachet falls into an anachronism when he Rafael Bombelli. says that Bombelli began his work upon Diophantos after the
appearance of Xylander's translation*, which was published
1575.
^

in

The Algebra

of Bombelli appeared in 1572, and in the


et

De

Graecis Latinisque tiumerorum notis

praeterea Saracenis

sett

Indicts,

etc. etc.,

studio Joachimi Camerarii, Papeberg, 1556.


:

In a letter to Zasius

" Venit mihi in nientem eorum quae

et

de bac et

aliis

liberalibus artibus dicta fuere, in eo convivio cujus in tuis aedibus

me

et

Peuce-

rum nostrum

Cum autem de Diophantus Graecus nominaretur, qui extaret in Bibliotbeca Vaticana, ostendebatur turn spes quaedam, posse nobis
participes esse, suavissima tua invitatio voluit.

autoribus Logistices verba fierent, et a

me

copiam tamen

libri illius.
iiifeliciter,

Ibi ego cupiditate videndi incensus, fortasse audacius


te

non

quasi procuratorem constitui negotii gerendi, mandate


et tu libenter
illo

voluntario,

cum quidem

susciperes quod imponebatur, et fides

solenni festivitate firmaretur, de

tuo et poculo elegante ct vino optimo.

Neque tu

igitur oblivisceris ejus rei, cujus explicationem tua benignitas tibi

commisit, neque ego non meminisse potero, non


-

modo

excelleutis \-irtuti8 ct

sapientiae, sed singularis comitatis et incredibilis suavitatis tuae."

Arithmeticae practicae methodus

facilis,

per Gemmani Frisium,

etc.

Hue

accedunt Jacobi Peletarii annotationes, Coloniae, 1571.

(But pref. of Peletarius

bears date 1558.) P. 72, Nota Peletarii: "Algebra autem dicta videtur a Gebro Arabe ut vox ipsa sonat hujus artis si non inventore, saltern excultore. Alii tribuunt Diophanto cuidam Graeco."
; ''

Cossali

I.

p. 59,
si

"Cosa

pero, che reca la

somma

maraviglia

si 6,
:

che largo
fiore

in Italia

non

spandesse la cognizionc del codice di Diofanto

che in

essendovi lo studio della greca lingua, non veuisse da qualche dotto a

coman

il

1' opposto niuna menzione ne faccia Fra Luca verso niuna Cardano, e Tartaglia intorno la metA del secolo XVI che nelle biblioteche rinianesse sepolto, ed andassc dimenticato per modo, che poco prima degli anni 70 del secolo xvi si riguardasse per una scoperta 1' averlo rinvonuto nella Vaticana liiblioteca." "Non longo post Xilandrum interuallo llaphael Bombellius Bononiensis, Graecum e Vaticana Bibliotheca Diophanti codicem nactus, omnes priorum

vantaggio tradotta; che per


fine del secolo xv, e
;

quattuor librorum quaestiones, et 6 libro quinto nonuuUas, probk-matibus uiub


iuseruit, in Algebra

sua

quam

Italico

sermono conwcripsit."

44
preface to this

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
work
*

the author

tells

us that he had recently

discovered a Greek book on Algebra in the Vatican Library,


written by a certain Diofantes, an Alexandrine Greek author

who

lived in the time of

Antoninus Pius

that, thinking highly

of the contents of this work, he and Antonio Maria Pazzi de-

that they actually translated five termined to translate it books out of the seven into wliich the MS. was divided but that, before the whole was finished, they were called away from
;

it

by other

labours.

The date

of these occurrences

must be a

few years before 1572. Though Bombelli did not carry out his plan of publishing Diophantos in a translation, he has nevertheless

taken

all

the problems of Diophantos'


fifth,

first

four Books and


in his Algebra,

some

of those of the

and embodied them


his

interspersing

them with

own problems.

Though he has

taken no pains to distinguish Diophantos' problems from his own, he has in the case of Diophantos' work adhered pretty
closely to the original, so that

Bachet admits his obligations

to

Bombelli, whose reproduction of the problems of Diophantos he

maintains that he found in


translation'^
1

many

points better than Xylander's

It

may

be interesting to mention a few points of


tells

This book Nesselmann


it

ns that he has never seen, but takes his inforI

mation about

from Cossali.

was fortunate enough

to find a

copy of

it

published in 1579 (not the original edition) in the British Museum, the Algebra, opera d'l Rafael BomheUi da Bolorjiia diiiisa in tre Libri being

title

In

Bologna, Per Giovanni Rossi.


quotations from the preface.

MDLXXIX.

have thus been able to verify the


is
:

The whole passage

"Questi anni passati, essendosi ritrouato una opera greca di questa disciplina nella libraria di Nostro Signore in Vaticano, composta da un certo Diofante
il quale fCl a tempo di Antonin Pio, e havendo mela Messer Antonio Maria Pazzi Reggiano publico lettore delle Matematiche in Roma, e giu dicatolo con lui Autore assai intelligente de numeri (ancorche non tratti de numeri irrationali, ma solo in lui si vcde vn perfetto ordine di opcrare) egli, ed io, per arrichirc il mondo di cosi fatta opera, ci dessimo a

Alessandrino Autor Greco,


fatta vedere

lo restaute tradurlo, e cinque libri (delli sette che souo) tradutti ne habbiamo non haueudo potuto finire per gli trauagli aueuuti all' uno, e all' altro, e in detta opera habbiamo ritrouato, ch' egli assai volte cita gli Autori Indiani, col che mi ha fatto conoscere, che questa disciplina appo gl' indiani prima ih, che a gli Arabi." The parts of this quotation which refer to the personality of Diophantos, the form Diofante, &c., have already been commented upon the last clauses we shall have occasion to mention again.
; ;
'^

Continuation of quotation in note

4, p.

43
immiecuit, ut has ab
illis

"Sed suas Diophanteis quaestionibus

ita

distiu-

THE WKITKKS UPON


notation in this work of Bombclli.

Dl< )1'|IANT()S.

45

Book ii he explains that he uses the word "tanto" to denote the unknown quantity, not "cosa" like his predecessors; and his symbol for
bef,dnning of
it is i, the square of the unknown (x-) is c., the cube i; and so on. For plus and minus (pm and meno) he uses the initial letters p. and m. Thus corresponding to x + Q we should find in Bombelli 11 p. 6, and for .r + ox-4<, 11 p. 5i m. 4. This notation shows, as will be seen later, some advance upon that of Diophantos in one important respect. The next writer upon Diophantos was ^Vilhelm Holznianu who published, under the Graecised form of his name Xylander by which he is generally known, a work bearing the title
:

At

Diophanti Alexandrini

Rerum

Arithmetical' um

LibH

sex, quo-

rum primi duo


est)

adiecta hahent Scholia

Maximi

{ut coniectura

Plamtdis.

Item Liber de Numeris Polygonis seu Multan-

fectionem continens, paucis adhuc uisum.

Opus incomparahile, uerae Arithmeticae Logisticae perA Guil. Xylandro Augustano incredihili lahore Latine redditum, et Commentariui explanatum, inque lucem editum ad Illustriss. Principem Ludovicum Vuirtemhergensem Basileae per Eusebium Episcopium, et Nicolai Fr. haeredes. mdlxxv. Xylander was according to his
gulis.

own statement

a " public teacher of Aristotelian philosophy in

the school at Heidelberg\"

He was

man

of almost universal
classical litera-

culture ^ and was so thoroughly

imbued with the

ture, that the extraordinary aptness of his quotations

and his

wealth

of expression

give exceptional charm to his writing

whenever he is free from the shackles of mathematical formulae and technicalities. The Epistola Nuncupatoria is addressed to the Prince Ludwig, and Xylander neatly introduces it by the line "Offerimus numeros, numeri sunt principe digni." This He tells us how he preface is very quaint and interesting. first saw the name of Diophantos mentioned in Suida.s, and
guere non
detrahat.
stare, et
'

sit in promptu, neque vefD se fidum satis interpretem pracbuit, cum passim verba Diophanti immutet, bisque pleraque addat, plcraque pro arbitrio

In multis nihilominus interprctationem Bombellii, Xilandriana prac-

ad banc emendandam

me

adjuvisse iu(,'enue fateor."

Ad

Icctorem.

" Publicus pbilosophiae Aristoteleae in schola Hcidolbergcnsi doctor."


shall see,

- Even Bachet, who, as wo omnibus disciplinis excultus."

was no favourable

critic, calls

him " Vir

46

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

then found that mention had been made of his work by Regio-

montanus as being extant in an Italian Library and having been seen by him. But, as the book had not been edited, he tried to reconcile himself to the want of it by making himself acquainted with the works on Arithmetic which were actually known and in use, and he apologises for what he considers to have been a disgrace to him\ With the help of books only he studied the subject of Algebra, so far as was possible from what men like Cardan had written and by his own reflection, with such success that not only did he fall into what Herakleitos called olrjo-Lv, lepav voaov, or the conceit of " being somebody " in the field of Arithmetic and " Logistic," but others too who were themselves learned men thought him (as he modestly tells us) But when he first an arithmetician of exceptional merit.

became acquainted with the problems of Diophantos (he continues) his pride had a fall so sudden and so humiliating that he might reasonably doubt whether he ought previously to have
1

cannot refrain from quoting the whole of this passage


:

"Sed cum ederet nemo cepi desideriimi hoc paulatim eorum quos consequi poteram Arithmeticorum librorum
tionibus nostris sepelire.

in

animo

consopire, et

cognitions, et medita-

Veritatis porro apud me est autoritas, ut ei coniunctum etiam cum dedecore meo testimonium lubentissime perhibeam. Quod Cossica seu Algebrica (cum his enim reliqua comparata, id sunt quod umbrae Homeric^ in Necya ad aniniam Tiresiac) ca ergo quod nou assequebar modo,

quanquam mutis duntaxat usus preceptoribus


uariare,

caetera ai)To5/5a/cTos, sed et augers,

adeoque corrigere in loco didicissem, quae summi et fidelissimi in docendo uiri Christifer Eodolphus Silesius, Micaolus, Stifelius, Cardanus, Nonius, aliique litteris

mandauerant

incidi in otrjaiv, lepav vbaov, ut

scitfe

appel-

lauit Heraclitus sapientior multis aliis philosophis,

hoc

est, in

Arithmetica, et

uera Logistica, putaui


ubi

iisque doctis uiris iuJicatum fuit,

primum

in

me passim etiam a multis, me non de grege Arithmeticum esse. Verum Diophantca incidi ita me recta ratio circumegit, ut flenddsne
me
esse aliquid: itaque de
:

an uero ridendus fuissem, haud iniuria dubitaucrim. Operas preciuni est hoc loco et meam inscitiam inuulgarc, et Diophantei operis, quod mihi ncbulosam istam caligincm ab oculis detcrsit, immo cos in coenum barbaricum defossos eleuauit et repurgauit, gustum aliquem exhibere. Surdorum

mihi

ipsi antca,

ego

uumerorum tractationem

ita

tenebam, ut etiam addere alioriun inuentis

non poenitendum auderem, atque id quidem in rebus arithmeticis magnum habetur, et difficultas istarum rerum multos a mathematibus deterret. Quanto autem hoc est praeclarius, in iis problematis, quae surdis etiam numsris uix posse uideutur explicari, rem eo deduccre, ut quasi solum arithmeticum ucrtere iussi obsurdescant illi plane, et ne mentio quidem eorum in tractatione
aliquid

inguniosissimarum quaustiouum admittatur."

THE WRITERS
bewailed, or laughed

I'PON DlOl'llANTOS.

47
it

at himself.

He

considers

therefore

worth while to confess publicly in how disgraceful a condition of ignorance he had previously been content to live, anil to do

something to make known the work of Diophantos, which had Before this critical time he was so familiar so opened his eyes. with methods of dealing with surds that he actually had ventured
to

add something to the discoveries of others relating

to

them

these were considered to be of great importance in questions


of Arithmetic,

and their

difficulty

was of

itself sufficient to

deter

" But how much more splendid " (says Xylander) " the methods which reduce the problems which seem to be hardly capable of solution even

many from

the study of Mathematics.

with the help of surds in such a way that, while the surds, when

bidden

(so to

speak) to plough the arithmetic

soil,

become true

to their

name and deaf

to entreaty, they are not so


!

much

as

mentioned in these most ingenious solutions " He then describes the enormous difficulties which beset his work owing to the coiTuptions in his text. In dealing, however, with the mistakes and carelessness of copyists he was, as he says, no
novice; for proof of which he appeals to his editions of Plutarch,

Stephanus and Strabo.


ing,

This passage, which


I

is

delightful read-

but too long to reproduce here,


" Id uero mihi accidit

give in

full in

the note

'.

>

durum
(iu

et uix superabile

incommodum, quM

mirificft

deprauata omnia inueni, ctim neque problematum expositio interdum integra


esset, ac

passim numeri

quibus sita omnia esse in hoc arRumento, quia

problematum quam solutionum siue cxplicatiouum corruptissimi. Non pudebit me ingenue fateri, qualem me heic gesserim. Audacter, et summo cum feruore potius qusim alacritate auimi opus ipsum initio sum aggressus, laborque mihi omnis uoluptati fuit, tantus est meus rernm arithmoticarum amor, quin et gratiam magnam me apud omnes liberalium scientiarum amatores ac
ignorat?) tarn

patronos initiirum,

et

praeclare de rep.

litteraria

nierituriim

intclligebam,

(quam ii bonis profectam nemo prudens aspernatur) gloriaeque fortasse etiam emolumento fore sperabam. Progressus aliquantulum, in salebras incidi quae tantum abest ut alacritatem meam retuderint, ut etiam animos milii addiderint, neque enim mihi novum aut insolons est aduersus

eamque rem mihi


:

laudi

librariorum incuriam certamen, et hac in re militaui, (ut Horatii nostri uerbis


utar)

non sine gloria, quod me non arroganter dicere, Dio, Plutarchu.^, Strabo, Stephanusque nostri testantur. Sed cum mox in ipsum pelagus nionstris scatons me cmsus abripuit: non dcspondi equidem animum, neque manus dedi, scd

tamen saepius ad cram undo soluissem respeju, qujmi portum in quem csaet euadeudum cogitandu prospicerem, depracheudiquc non minus uerii quum ele-

48

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
to get possession of a

Next Xylander tells us how he came


script of Diophantos.

In October of the year 1571 he


;

manumade

a journey to Wittenberg

while there he had conversations on

mathematical subjects with two professors, Sebastian Theodoric

and Wolfgang Schuler by name, who showed him a few pages of a Greek manuscript of Diophantos and informed him that it belonged to Andreas Dudicius whom Xylander describes as
"

Andreas Dudicius Sbardellatus, hoc tempore Imperatoris Ro-

orator." On his departure from Wittenberg Xylander wrote out and took with him the solution of

manorum apud Polonos

a single problem of Diophantos, to amuse himself with on his


journey.
sis,

This he showed at Leipzig to Simon Simonius Lucen-

a professor at that place,

who wrote

to Dudicius

on his
to

behalf.

few months afterwards Dudicius sent the MS.


to persevere in his

Xylander and encouraged him


insists

undertaking

to translate the Arithmetics into Latin.

Accordingly Xylander

that

the glory

of

the whole achievement belongs in

no

less

himself.

but rather in a greater degree to Dudicius than to Finally he commends the work to the favour of the

Prince Ludwig, extolling the pursuit of arithmetical and algebraical science

and dwelling

in enthusiastic anticipation on the

influence which the Prince's patronage would

have in helpThis Epistola

ing and advancing the study of Arithmetic \


ganter ea cecinisse Alcaeum, quae
tabula scribam.
(si

possum) Latino

in

hac quasi uotiua mea

Qui uela uentis uult dare, Cautus futuri praeuideat


Cursus.

dum licet, modum

mare ingressus, marine


est.

Nauigct arbitrio necesse


Sand,

quod de Echeueide pisce fertur, eum nauim cui se adplicet remorari, poenh Expediui credibile fecit mihi mea cymba tot mendorum remoris retardata.

tamen me

ita,

ut facilS

sint incredibilem

me

laborem

omnes mediocri de et aerumnas


milii

his rebus iudicio praediti, iutellecturi


difticilimas superasso
:

pudore etiam

stimulatum oneris quod ultro

imposuissem, non perferendi.

Paucula quaeet Arith-

dam non

plane explicata, studio et certis de causis in alium locum reiecimus.


ita

Opus quidem ipsum


professuri."
'

absoluimus ut ueque eius nos pudere debeat,

meticae Logisticesque studiosi nobis se

plurimum debere

sint

baud dubie
atque glorialibi,

"Hoc non modo


;

tibi

Princeps Illustrissimc, honorificum

erit,

osum

sed tc labores nostros approbantc, arithmcticae studium

cum

tum
ad

in tua

Academia

et

Gymuasiis, excilabitur, confirmabitur, prouebetur,

et

THE WRITERS UPON DIOPIIANTOS.

49

Nuncnpatoria boars the date 14th August, 1574'. Xylandcr (lied on the 10th of February in the year following that of the publication, 1576. Some have stated that Xy lander published the Greek text of Diophantos as well as the Latin translation. There appears to be no foundation for the statement, which
probably rests on a misunderstanding of certain passages in which Xylander refers to the Greek text. It is possible that

he intended to publish the Greek original but was prevented by his death which so soon followed the appearance of his transis a sufficient proof, how^ever, that if such was his was never carried out, that Bachet asserts that he himself had never seen or found any one who had ever seen such an edition of the Greek text ^ Concerning the merits of Xylander and his translation of Diophantos much has been written, and chiefly by authors who

lation.

It
it

purpose

were not weW acquainted with the subject, but whose very
ignorance seems to have been their chief incitement to startling
statements.

Indeed very few persons at

studied the book itself: a fact which


for

may

all seem to have be partly accounted

by

its rarity.

Nesselmaun, whose book appeared in 1842,


all

tells

us honestly that he has never been able to find a copy,


information on the subject

but has been obliged to take


at second

hand from Cossali and Bachet '. Even Cossali, so far as he gives any opinion at all upon the merits of the book, seems to do no more than reproduce what Bachet had said Nor does Schulz seem to have studied Xylander' before him. work at least all his statements about it are vague and may very well have been gathered at second hand. Both he and
:

perfectam

eiu.s scientiam multi tuis auspiciis, nostro labore pcrducti, niognam hac re tuis in remp. beneficiis accessionem factam esse gratissima commemora-

tione praedicabunt."
1

"Heidelberga. postrid. Eidus Sextiles cio

lo

lxxiv."

"An

vero et Graece a Xilandro editus

sit

Diophantus,

nondum
locis,

certti

com-

perire potui.

Videtur sanb in multis suorum Commcntariorum

de Graeco

Diopbanto tanquam a se cdito, vcl mox edendo, verba facere. Sed banc cditionem, neque mihi vidisse, neque aliquem qui viderit hactcnus audivisse contigit."
Bachet, Epist. ad Led.
3 There is not, I believe, a copy even in the British Museum, but I had the rare good fortune to find the book in the Library of Trinity College,

Cambridge. H. D.

50

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Nesselmann confine themselves to saying that it was not so worthless as many writers had stated it to be (Nesselmann on his part confessing his inability to form an opinion for the reason that he had never seen the book), and that it was
well received

among

savants of the period, while

its effect

on

study of Algebra was remarkable \ On the other hand, the great majority of writers on the subject may be said to shout in chorus a very different cry. One
the growth of the
instance will suffice to show the quality of the statements that

of space.

have been generally made to enumerate more would be waste Dr Heinrich Suter in a History of Mathematical
:

Sciences (Zurich 1873) says^ " This translation


as Xylander

is

very poor,

was very little versed in Mathematics." If Dr Heinrich Suter had taken the trouble to read a few words of Xylander's preface, he could hardly have made so astounding
a statement as that contained in the second clause of this This is only a specimen of the kind of statements which have been made about Xylander's book indeed I have been able to find no one who seems to have adequately studied Xylander except Bachet and Bachet's statements about the work of his predecessor and his own obligations to the same
sentence.
; ;

later writers.

have been unhesitatingly accepted by the great majority of The result has been that Bachet has been universally considered the only writer who has done anything
considerable for Diophantos, while the labours of his predecessor

have been ignored or despised.


is,

This view of the relative


completely erroneous.

merits of the two authors

in

my

vieAv,

and comparison of the two editions I have come to the conclusion that honour has not been paid where honour was due. It would be tedious to give here in
careful study
1 "Wie uuvollkomiucn Xylanders Ai-beit auch ausfiel, wie oft cr Schulz. auch den rcchten Sinn verfehlte, und wic oft auch seine Aumerkuugeii den Laser, der sich Eathes eiholen will, im Stichc lasseu, so gut war dock die Aufnalimc, welche sein Uuch bei den Gelehitcn damaligcr Zcit fand; dcnn in der That giog den Matlicmatikcru durch die Erscheinung dieses Werkes ein

From a

neues Licbt auf, und es


-

ist

mir schr wabrscbcinlicb, dass er


ist

viel

dazu beigetrageu

hat, die allgemeiue Arithmetik zu ihrer nachnialigen

Hohe zu erheben."

"Dicse Uebersetzung aber

sebr schwach, da Xylander in Mathematik

sebr wenig bewaudcrt war."

THE WIUTEUS UPON DluPlIANToS.


detail the particular facts

ol
I

which led

me

to this conchision.
first

will only say in this place that

my

suspicions were

aroused

by reading Bachet's work alone, before I had seen tlie earlier From perusing Bachet I received the impression that his repeated emphatic and almost violent repudiation of obligation
one.
to Xylander,

and

his disparagement of that author suggested

the very thing which he disclaimed, that he was under too


great obligation to his predecessor to acknowledge
I
it

duly.

work itself It was the first edition published which contained the Greek text, and appeared
to Bachet's
in

must now pass

1621 bearing the


libri sex,
et

title:

Diophanti Alexandrini Anthmeticounus.


JVtoic

7-um

de numeris nndtancjulis liber

2)riinuin Graece et Latine editi, atque absolidissimis


illitstrati.

Commentariis

Auctore Claudio Gaspare Bacheto Mezinaco Sebusiano,

V.G.

Lidetiae Pansiorum, Surnptibus Hieronymi Drovart^, via

Jacobaea, sub Scuto Solari.

MDGXXI.

(I

should perhaps

mention that we have a statement^ that in Carl von Montchall's Library there was a translation of Diophantos which the mathematician "Joseph Auria of Neapolis" made, but did not apparently publish, and which was entitled "Diophanti
libri

sex,

cum

scholiis graecis
collati

Maximi Planudae, atque


this

liber de

numeris
a

polygonis,

cum
Of

Vaticanis codicibus, et latine versi

work we know nothing; neither Bachet nor Cossali mentions it. The date would presumably be about the same as that of Xylauder's translation, or a little later.) Bachet's Greek text is based, as he tells us, upon a MS. which he calls "codex Regius", now in the Bibliotheque NaJosepho Auria."
tionale at Paris;
this MS.
is

his sole authority, except

that

Jacobus Sirmondus had part of a Vatican MS. transcribed for him. He professes to have produced a good Greek text, having spent incalculable labour upon its emendation, to have inserted
1

For "surnptibus Hierouymi Drovart" Nesselinann has "surnptibus SebasCramoisy, 1021 " which
is

tiani

is

found in some copies.


I

The former

(as given

above)

taken from the title-page of the copy which

have used (from the

Library of Trinity College, Cambridge).


- Schulz, Vorr. xliii.: "Noch erwuhnen die Litteratorcn, dass eich in der Bibliothek eines Carl von Moutchall einc Bearbeitung des Diophantus von dem

beruhmten Joseph Auria von Neapel (vermuthlich doch uur handschriftUoli)


befuudeu habe, welche den Titel
I'uhrte u.
s.

w." (see Text).

52
in

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
brackets
all

additions which he
all

made

to

it

and

to

have

given notice of
trifling nature;

corrections, except those of an obvious or

a few passages he has left asterisked, in cases where correction could not be safely ventured upon. In spite however of Bachet's assurance I cannot help doubting the quality of his text in many places, though I have not seen the MS. which he used. He is careful to tell us what previous works relating to the subject he had been able to consult. First he mentions Xylander (whom he invariably quotes as Xilander), who had translated the whole of Diophantos, and

commented upon him throughout, "except


touched a considerable
sixth
rest of his
pai't of

that he scarcely

the

fifth

book, the whole of the

and the treatise on multangular numbers, and even the work was not very successful, as he himself admits that he did not thoroughly understand a number of points." Then he speaks of Bombelli (already mentioned) and the Zetetica of Vieta (in which the author treats in his own way a large number of Diophantos' problems Bachet thinks that he so treated them because he despaired of restoring the book completely). Neither Bombelli nor Vieta (says Bachet) made any attempt to demonstrate the difficult porisms and abstruse theorems in numbers which Diophantos assumes as known in
:

many
tions

places, or sufficiently explained the causes of his opera-

and

artifices.

All these omissions on the part of his

predecessors he thinks he

has supplied in his notes to the

various problems and in the three Books of "Porisms" which he


prefixed to the

work\

As regards

bis

Latin translation, he

says that he gives us Diophantos in Latin from the version of

know

Xylander most carefully corrected, in which he would have us that he has done two things in particular, first, corrected
^ On the nature of some of Bacliet's proofs Nicholas Saunderson (formerly Lucasian Professor) remarks in Elements of Algebra, 1740, apropos of Dioph. "M. Bachet indeed in the IGth and 17th props, of his second book of III. 17. Porisms has given us demonstrations, such as they are, of the theorems in the

problem: but in the

first

place he demonstrates but one single case of those

theorems, and in the next place the demonstrations he gives are only synthetical,

and so abominably perplexed


of
all

withal, that in each demonstration he


I

makes uso

the letters in the alphabet except


for."

and 0, singly

to represent the quantities

he has there occasion

THE WRITERS UPON DIuPllANTOS.

53

what was wrong and supplied the numerous lacunae, secondly, explained more clearly what Xylander had given in obscure or ambiguous language: "I confess however", he says "that this made so much change necessary, that it is almost more fair
to me than to Xilander. But if anyone prefers to consider it as his, because I have held fast, tooth and nail, to his words when they do not misrepresent Diophantus, I do not care'". Such sentences as these, which

to attribute the translation

are no rarity in Bachet's book, are certainly not calculated to

increase our respect for the author.

"the historian of the French

Academy

According to Montucla", tells us" that Bachet


fever,

worked at

this edition

during the course of a quartan

and
it

that he himself said that, disheartened as he was by the


culty of the work, he would never have completed
it,

diffi-

had

not been

for

the stubbornness which his malady generated iu

him.

As the
it,

first

and only edition of the Greek text

of Diofind in

phantos, this work, in spite of any imperfections

we may

does

its

author

all

honour.

The same

edition

was reprinted and published with the


Diophanti Alexandrini
itmis.

addition of Fermat's notes in 1G70.

Arithmeticorwni

lihri sex, et

de numeris multangidis liher


V. G. et ohseruationibus

Cum

commentariis

G. G.

Bacheti

D. P.

de Fermat Senatoris Tolosani.

Accessit Doctrinae Amdyticae

inuentum nouum, collectum ex variis eiusdem D. de Fermat Epistolis. Tolusae, Excudehat Bernardus Bosc, ^ Regione CuUegii Societatis Jesu, MDGLXX. This edition was not pubhshed

by Fermat
tissime
et

himself, as certain writers imply ^ but by his son


tibi

'"Deinde Latinum damus


castigata, in

Diophantum ex Xilandri versione


:

accura-

qua duo potissimum nos praestitisse scias velim, nam deprauata correximus, hiantesque passim lacunas repleuimus et quae sub-

obscure, vel ambigue fuerat interpretatus Xilander, dilucidius exposuimus; fateor

tamen, inde tantam inductam esse mutationem, vt propemodum aequius sit versioneni istam nobis quam Xilandro tribuere. Si quis autem potius ad eum \^ttinere contendat,

qu5d eius verba, quatenus Diophanto


licet."

fraudi

non

erant, niordicus

retinuimus, per
2 '
I.

me

323.

So Dr Hcinrich Suter: "Diese Am(fahe witrde 1G70 ditrch Fernuit ernnt^rt, der sie mit seinen eigenen algebraischep Untersuchungen und Erfindungen
^asstattete,"

54
after his death.

DIOPHANTOS OF AT.KXAXDRIA.
S.

Fermat

tells

us in the preface that this

publication of Fermat's notes to Diophantos was part of an

attempt to

collect together

from his

letters

and elsewhere

his

The "Doctrinae Analj'ticae Inuentum nouum" is a collection made by Jacobus de Billy from various letters which Fermat sent to him at different times. The notes upon Diophantos' problems, which his son hopes will prove of value very much more than commensurate with their
contributions to mathematics.
bulk, were (he says) collected from the margin of his copy of

Diophantos,

From

their brevity they were obviously intended

for the benefit of experts \ or

even perhaps solely

for

Fermat's

own, he being a
in the

man who

preferred the pleasure which he had

work

itself to all considerations of

the fame which might

follow therefrom.
tions,

Fermat never cared

to publish his investigaletters,

but was always perfectly ready, as we see from his

to acquaint his friends

and contemporaries with


is

his results.

Of

the notes themselves this

not the place to speak in detail.


is

This edition of Diophantos


additions in
it

rendered valuable only by the


for the rest it is a
is

due

to

Fermat;
far as

mere reprint
it is

of that of 1621.

So

the Greek text

concerned
is

very

much

inferior to the first edition.

There

a far greater

number

of misprints, omissions of words, confusions of numerals;


all,

and, most serious of

the brackets which Bachet inserted in


insertion of words in the text

the edition of 1621 to

mark the

are in this later edition altogether omitted.


tions

These imperfechave been already noticed by Nesselmannl Thus the


is

reprinted edition of 1670


^
:

untrustworthy as regards the

text.

Lectori Beneuolo, p. iii. "Doctis quibus tantum pauca sufficiunt, harum obseruationum auctor scribebat, vel potius ipse sibi scribens, his studiis exerceii

malebat quam gloriari


lucubratioues suas

adco autem

ille

ab omni ostentationo alienus


ct

erat, vt

nee

ty]iie

mandari curauerit,

suonim qiiandoquc resjionsorum


;

autographa nullo scruato exemplari pctentibus vitro miserit


rique celeberrimorum huius saeculo Geomctrarum,

iiorunt scilicet pleille et

quam

libenter

quaut&

bumanitate, sua
2

iis

inuenta patefecerit."

"Was

dieser

Abdruck an
ist

iiusserer

Eleganz gewounen hat (denn die Ba-

chet'sche

Ausgcbe

niit

ausserst unangcnehmen, nanientlich Griechischeu


sie

Lettern gedruckt), das hat


loren.
(z.

an inncrm Werthe in Bczug auf den Text ver-

Sie ist nicht bloss voller Diuckfchler in cinzelnen


ir

Worten und Zeichen


25 eine doppelt und

B. durchgehends

statt
(z.

"?>),

900) sondern audi ganze Zeilen sind ausgelassen

Oder doppelt gedruckt,

B.

iii.

12 cine Zeile doppelt,

iv,

THE WRITERS UPON DIOPHANTOS.


I

55

omit here

all

upon Diophantos
Alb. Girard).
before

(e.g.

We

mention of works which are not directly the so called "Translation" by Stevin and have accordingly to pass from 1670 to 1810

work directly upon Diophantos. In 1810 was published an excellent translation (with additions)
find another extant

we

of the fragment

upon Polygonal Numbers by Poselger


iiher die Polygonal-Zahlen.

Dio-

phantus von Alexandrien


Lastly, in

Uebersetzt

mit Zusdtzen von F. Th. Poselger.


very meritorious

Leipzig, 1810.
in Berlin,

1822 Otto Schulz, professor

published a

German

translation with notes: Diupliantus

von Alexandria arithmetische Aufgahen nebst dessen Schrift iiber die Pohjgon-Zahlen. Aus dem Griechischen ilbersetzt iind mit

Anmerkungen begleitet von Otto Schulz, Professor am BerlinischColnischen Gymnasium zum grauen Kloster. Berlin, 1822. In der Schlesingerschen Buck- und Musikhandlung. The former
work of Poselger
is

with the consent of

its

author incorporated

in Schulz's edition along with his

own

translation and notes

upon the larger treatise, the Arithmetics. According to Nesselmann Schulz was not a mathematician by profession: he produced, however, a most excellent and painstaking edition, with notes chiefly upon the matter of Diophantos and not on the
text (with the exception of a very few emendations)
:

notes

which, almost invariably correct, help


author.

much

to understand the

Schulz's

translation

is

based upon the

edition

of

Bachet's text published in 1670; so that nothing has been done


for the

Greek text since the

original edition of

Bachet (1621).

have now mentioned


directly

all

the extant books which have been

Of books here omitted which are concerned with Diophantos indirectly, i.e. those which reproduce the substance of his solutions or solve his
written

upon Diophantos.

gleich hinterher eine ausgelassen, rv. 52 eine doppclt, v. 11 eine aup^'clnpsen,

desgleichen

v.

14,

2.5,

33, vi. 8, 13

und

so weiter), die Zalileu Verstiimmcit, was

aber das Aergste

ist,

die Bacbet'schen kritischen Zeicheu sind fast iiberall, die

Klammer
vcillig

durcbgtingig weggefallen, so dass diese Ausgabe als Text des Diophant


ist," p.

unbrauchbar geworden

283.

Accordingly Cantor errs when he says "Die beste Textamijabe ist die von Bachet de Meziriac mit Anmerkungen von Format. Toulouse, 1G70." (Getch.
p. 31)0.)

56

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

problems or the like of them by different methods a list has been given at the outset. As I have already mentioned a
statement that Joseph Auria of Naples wrote circa 1580 a
translation of Diophantos

which was found (presumably


it is

in MS.

form) in the library of one Carl von Montchall,

necessary

here to give the indications we have of


phantos.
First,

lost works upon Dioby Vossius (as some have understood him) that the Englishman John Pell wrote an unpublished Commentary upon Diophantos. John Pell was at one time a professor of mathematics at Amsterdam and gave lectures there on Diophantos, but what Vossius says about his commentary may well be only a recommendation to undertake a commentary, rather than a historical assertion of its comple-

we

find

it

asserted

tion.

Secondly, Schulz states in his preface that he had lately found a note in Schmeisser's Orthodidaktih der Mathematik that Hofrath Kausler by command of the Russian Academy pre-

pared an edition of Diophantos \

Of

this

nothing whatever

is

known;

if

ever written, this edition must have been only for

private use at St Petersburg.


I find a statement in the

New American
vol.

Cyclopaedia

(New
made

York, D. Appleton and Company),

VI.

that "a complete

translation of his (Diophantos') works into English was

by the
^

late

Miss Abigail Lousada, but has not been published."


of Schmcisser is:

"Die mechanische, geistlose Behandvon Herru Hofrath Kausler stark geriigt worden. In der Vorrede zu seiner Ausgabe des Vjlakerschen ExempcUmclis beginnt er so Seit mehreren Jahren arbeitete ich fiir die Kussisch-Kaiserliche Akademie der Wissenschaften Diophants unsterbliches Werk iiber die Arithnietik aus, und fand darin einen solchen Schatz von den feinsten, scharfsinnigsten algebraischcn Auflosungen, dass mir die mechanische, geistlose Methode der neuen Algebra mit jedem Tage mehr ekelte u. s. w.' " (p. 33.)
lung der Algebra
ist

The whole passage

ins besondere

'

CHAPTER

IV.

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OF DIOPHANTOS.

1.

As

it

is

my

inteution, for the sake of brevity

and

perspicuity, to
in giving

make

use of the modern algebraical notation

my
it

account of Diophantos' problems and general

methods,

will

be necessary to describe once


for

for

all

the

working out the solutions of his problems, or the notation by which he expresses the relations which would be represented in our time by algebraical
equations, the extent to which he
quantities,
is

machinery which our author uses

able to manipulate

unknown

and

so on.

Apart, however, from the necessity of

such a description for the proper and adequate comprehension


of Diophantos, the general question of the historical develop-

ment
essay,

of algebraical notation possesses great intrinsic interest.

Into the general history of this subject I cannot enter in this

my

object being the elucidation of Diophantos

I shall

accordingly in general

confine

myself to an account of his


it is

notation solely, except in so far as

interesting to compare

it

with the corresponding notation of his editors and


cases) that of other writers, as for

(in certain

example certain of the early

Arabian algebraists.
2. First, as to the representation of an unknown quantity. The unknown quantity, Avhich Diophantos calls ttXj/^o? fiovdBoiu aXoyov i.e. "a number of units of which no account is given,
or undefined "
is

denoted throughout
or in

(def.

versally printed in the editions as the

accent,

thus

?',

the

form

s'.

2) by what is uniGreek letter ? with an This symbol in verbal


i.e.

description he calls u

aptOfxo'^,

"the number"

by

inipli-

58
cation, the

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

number par

excellence of the
is

problem

in question.

(In the cases where the symbol

used to denote inflected

forms, e.g. accusative singular or dative plural, the terminations

which would have been added to the stem of the full word dpi6fi6<i are printed above the symbol 9 in the manner of an exponent, thus 9'' (for dpidfxov, as r' for t6v), <?", the symbol
being in addition doubled in the plural cases, thus
99'
99'',

99"'^ 99""

for dpidfjLOL K.T.X.

When
thus

the symbol

is

used in practice, the


to

coefficient is expressed

by putting the required Greek numeral


99'

immediately after

it,

Td corresponds to

11a-, 9'a

sc

and so on. Respecting the symbol


clear that, if
9'

as printed in the editions

it

is

must be different in kind from all the others described in the same definition, for they are clearly mere contractions of the corresponding names\
represents dpiOixo^, this sign

The
on

opinion which seems to have been universally held as to


text by
the
best
writers

the nature of the symbol of the

Diophantos
tell

is

that of Nesselmann and


is

Cantor ^

Both

authors

us that the final sigma

used to denote the

unknown quantity
it
;

representing upi6p6<i, the complete word for

and they imply in the passages referred to that this final sigma corresponds exactly to the x of modern equations, and that we have here the beginning of algebraical notation in the strict sense of the term, notation, that is, which is purely
conventional and shows in itself no necessary connection be-

tween the symbol and the thing denoted by it. I must observe, however, that Nesselmann has in another place ' corrected the impression which the reader might have got from the first
passage referred
dpi6fji6<;

to,

that he regarded the use of the sign for

as a step towards genuine algebraical notation.


that,

He

makes the acute observation

as

the symbol occurs in

many

places

where

it

represents dpidfio^ used in the ordinary


is

untechnical sense, and


designate the
all

therefore

not exclusively used


the
technical
dpi6fi6<i,

to
it

unknown

quantity,

must
'
!

after

be more of the nature of an abbreviation than


kv^os, dwafioSufafxis, &c.

Vide infra S", k", 55", &c. contractions for Suva/jLi^, Nesselmann, pp. 290, 291. Cantor, p. 400.
pp. 300, 301,

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OF DIOPHANTOS.


an algebraical symbol.
correct
;

59

This view
:

is,

think,

undoubtedly

but the question now arises

bow can

the final signia


?

of the

Greek alphabet be an abbreviation

for dpiOfio^

The

difficulty of

answering this question suggests a doubt which, so far as I am aware, has been expressed by no writer upon Diophantos up to the present time. Is the sign, which Bachet'.s
gives
as

text

a final sigma, really the final sigma at


to
9

all ?

Nesselmann and Cantor seem never


they both assign a reason
designation of the

why unknown

the final

have doubted was appropriated


it

it,

for

for

the

quantity,

namely that
to

was the
princi-

only letter of the Greek alphabet which was not already in


use as a numeral.
pally

The question was suggested


final sigma,
9,

me

by the doubt whether the


cr

was developed

as distinct from the form

as early as the date of the MS. of

Diophantos which Bachet used, or rather as early as the first copy of Diophantos, for the explanation of the sign is given

by the author himself


in

in the text of the


if

second definition.\

This being extremely doubtful,

not absolutely impossible,

what way

is its

representation as a final sigma in Bachet's

? The MS. from which Bachet edited Greek text is in the Bibliotheque Natiouale, Paris, and I have not yet been able to consult it but, fortunately, in a paper

text to be accounted for


his

by M. Kodet
the

in the Journal Asiatique (Janvier 1878), I found

certain passages quoted

by the author from Diophantos


These passages M, Rodet
tells

for

purpose of comparison with the algebra of

Mohammed
us that

ibn Musti Al-Kharizmi.

he copied accurately from the identical MS. which Bachet used. On examination of these passages I found that in all but two
cases of the occurrence of the sign for as the final sigma.
(ipi6/j.6<;

it

was given
for

In one of the other cases he writes

6 dpiOfiof (in this instance untechnical) the abbreviation o

d\

and in the other case we find ijTj"' for dpt6fj.oi In this last place Bachet reads 99'. But the same symbol cji|" which M. Rodet
gives
is

actually found in three places in Bachet's

own

edition.

he gives a reading from his MS. which he has corrected in his own text and in which thr signs i\d and qi|^ occur. They must here necessarily signify npidp.6<i d and
(1) In his note to iv. 3

dpidfiol

7)

respectively because, although

tlic

sense

rcciuire.s

GO

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
1

the notation corresponding to -

not

x, 8x,

we know, not

only from Bachet's direct statement but also from the translation of certain passages
is

by Xylauder, that the sign

for dpi6fjb6<;

in the MSS. very often carelessly written for dpid/MoaTov


(2)

and

In the text of iv. 14 there is a sentence (marked by Bachet as interpolated) which has the expression ij? where again the context shows that i|L| is for dpcO/xoL (3) At the
its sign.
l|

beginning of
MS. reads 6

v.

12 there

is

a difficulty in the text; and Bachet


l|... where a Vatican Xylander also notes

notes that his MS. has o SfjrXaaifoi' avroO


hijfkaa-iwv

avrov

dpLdjjiov...

that his MS. had

that the MS. which

avrov ap.... It is thus clear Bachet used sometimes has the sign for dpiOfMo^; in a form which is at least sufficiently like q to be taken for it. This last very remarkable variation as combut oq refepared with 9?' seemed at first sight inexplicable rence to Gardthausen, Griechische Falaeur/raphie, I found under
firjTe o hiir\.aaL(ov
;

the head

"

hieroglyphisch-conventionell

for dpidfio'^, dpiO^JbOL,

an abbreviation 9, 9^ which the author gives as occurring in


'.

"

The same statement is made MS. of Euclid by Lehmann'^ {Die tackygraphischen Ahkurzungen der griechischen Handscltriften, 1880) who names as a sign for dpcd^io^,
the Bodleian

found in the Oxford MS. of Euclid, a curved line similar to


that used as an abbreviation for Kai
is

He

adds that the ending


is

placed above

it,

and the simple sign


is

doubled

for

the

plural.

Lehmann's facsimile of the sign

like the form given

by Gardthausen, except that the angle in the latter is a little more rounded by Lehmann. The form ijq' above mentioned as given by M. Rodet and Bachet is also given by Lehmann with a remark that it seems to be only a modification of the other. If we take the form as given by Gardthausen, the change
necessary
is

the

very slightest possible.


abbreviation
2, 30.

Thus by assuming
it
is

this conventional

for

dpi,6/j.6<i

easy

to see

D'Orvillo MSH. X. 1 inf.


p. 107:

"

"Von

Sigeln, welchcn ich

uennen
Kal

apiOixb^,

das in der Oxfordcr Euclidhandsclirift


Schlangenlinie

audi nnderwarts begegnet bin, sind zu niit eiucr der Note


Die

ahnlichen

bezeicbuet wird.

Enduug wird

dariiber

gesetzt, zur

Bezejchuung des Plurals wird das ejnfache Zeichen verdoppelt,"

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OF DIOrHANTOS.

01

how

also it

was thought by Bachet to be a final sigma and Iwiw might be taken for the isolated form given by M. Rodet. As I have already implied, I cannot think that the symbol
it

That the conand the sign in Diophantos are identical is, I think, certain; and that neither of the two is a final sigma must be clear if it can be proved that one of them is not. Having consulted the Ms. of the first
is

used by Diophantos

really a final sigma,

9.

ventional

abbreviation

in

the

Euclid

MS.

ten problems of Diophantos in the Bodleian Library, I conclude


that the symbol in this work cannot be a final sigma for the
following reasons. (1) thus, '<^ for dpcdfMO'i;

The

sign in the Bodleian MS.

is

written

and though the final sigma is used universally in this MS. at the end of words there is, besides a slight difference in shape between the two, a very distinct
difference in size, the sign for
larger.
dpc6/ji6<:

being always very

much

There are some cases in which the two come close together, e.g. in the expression eh '<^ Tee, and the difference is very strongly marked. (2) As I have shown, the breathing is
prefixed before the sign.
This, I think, shows clearly that the
letters be-

symbol was regarded as an abbreviation of certain


ginning with a the
first letter

of dpiO/xo^.

It is interesting also

to observe that in the Bodleian MS. there are certain cases in

which dpcdfio^ in

its

untechnical, and

dpt0fj,6<;

in its technical

sense follow each other as in era^a to tov Seurepov 'S^ dptdfiov

what might be expected) the sign is dpidfjio'i and the other is written in full. This is a very remarkable piece of evidence to show that the sign is an abbreviation and in no sense an algebraical symbol. More remarkable still as evidence of this view is the fact that in the same MS. the luord dpi6fi6<; in the definition
et'o's,

where (contrary

to

used for the untechnical

Be

firjBeu

tovtcop

toov

ISicofjidTayv

Kr'r}adfievo<;...e-)(Oiv

he...

dpidfjb6<; KaXeiTUL is itself

denoted by the symbol, so that

in

the MS. there

is

absolutely no difference between the full

name
?

and the symbol.

My

conclusion therefore being (1) that the sign given as

in Bachet's text of
(2) that it is

Diophantos

is

not really

tlic

final

.sigma,

an abbreviation of some kind

for

dpiOfMot, the
?

question arises.

How

was

this abbreviation arrived at

If

it is

62

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
its

uot a hieroglyph (and I have cot yet found any evidence of


hieroglyphic origin), I would suggest that
be
it

might very well


of the

a corruption, after combination, of


Before I go on to state

the

two

first letters

word, Alpha and Rho.


contraction
its

may

liave

come about,

when and how I conceive this I may observe that, given

possibility,
its

my

supposition
(1) It

thing in

favour.

has, it seems to me, everywould explain, and is countenanced

M. Kodet's transcription of the would also explain the remarkable variation in the few words quoted from Xylander's note on These words are v. 12, fMT]T 6 hiTrKaaioiv avTov ap fio a... important because in no other sentence which he quotes in
by, the solitary occurrence in
a*.

contraction

(2)

It

the

Greek does any abbreviation of


is

dpt9iJL6<i

occur.

As

his

work

a Latin translation he rarely quotes the original Greek

at all:
dpi6fx6(;

hence we might have doubted whether the sign for occurred in his MS. in the same form as in Bachet's.
did occur in the same form
III.

is, however, clear from the 12\ That is to say, both ap and <h are used in one and the same MS. to signify apt^/xo?. This circumstance is easily explained on my hypothesis and I do not see how it can be explained on any other. But (3) the most important advantage

That

it

note to

that

my

theory would hav

is

that

it

would establish uniformity

It between the different abbreviations used by Diophantos. would show him to have proceeded on one invariable principle in fixing those abbreviations

expected to be

parallel.

Diophantos, in
all
fi.

which we should naturally have fact, appears to have


cases the first letter of the

proceeded thus.

He

took in
i.e.

corresponding words

a, B, k,

Then, as these could not be


all

used alone for the reason that they

represented numbers, he

added another

letter to each.

letter in each of the four

Now, as it happened, the second words named occurred later in the

evidently occurred wrongly instead of the sign for the was commonly the case in the mss.), for after stating that the context showed the reading apidfids to be wrong Xy lander says: "Est sane in Graeco nota senarii S". Sed locum habere non potest." Now s and r are so much alike that what was taken for one might easily be taken for the
1

In

tills

problem

it

fraction apiOfioarbv (as

other.

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OF


alphabet than the respective
first letters.
/i

Dl< )|'HANToS.

Q:)

B with V added, k with v added, and

Thus a with p addctl, with o added gave abbrein the

viations luhich could not he confounded with particidar numbers.

No

doubt,
line

same

if the two letters in each case were not written by Diophantos, but the second raised above the

other,

the signs might, unless they or the separate letters were dis-

tinguished by some special marks, have been confused with

numerical fractions.
this
;

There would however be


it

little

danger of
the

such confusion would be very unlikely to

arise, for (a)

context would nearly always render


(6)

impossible, as also would

the constant recurrence of the same sign for a constantly


if

recurring term, coupled with the fact that,


occasion
it

on any particular

denoted a numerical

fraction, it could

and would
/c", /i

naturally be expressed in lower terms.

Thus,

if 8",

were

numerical fractions, they would be as unlikely to be written thus


as

we should be

unlikely to write -^,

^,

^.

Indeed the

only sign of the four which, written with the second letter
placed as an exponent to the second, could reasonably be supposed
to represent a numerical fraction
is a",

which miglit mean


is

yi^.
;

But, by a curious coincidence, confusion

avoided in this case

and the contraction, which I suppose to have taken place, might very well be an expedient adopted for the purpose thus we may have here an explanation why only one of the four signs ap, 3u, Kv, fio is contracted, (4) Again, if we assume <^ to be a
:

contraction of ap,

mark
letter

cases

we can and number

explain the addition of terminations to


in the place
is

where the second

letter of

the other abbreviations

written.

The

sign '<^

having no

superposed originally, this addition of terminations was

rendered practicable without resulting in any confusion.


its

On
clear
far

convenience

it

is

unnecessary to enlarge, because


full

it is

that the symbol could then be used instead of the

word

more frequently than the others. Thus oblique cases of Bvvafii'i are written in full where oblique cases of apidfi6<; would be abbreviated. For 8", /c", fi did not admit of the addition of terminations without possible confusion and certain clumsiness.

few words will suffice to explain

my

views concerning the


alternatives

evolution of the sign for dpid^xo^.


possible.
(1)

There are two

Diophantos may not himself have made the con-

64
traction at all
;

DTOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
he

may have

written the two letters in

full.

In

that case I suppcse the sign to he a cursive contraction used by


scribes.

I conceive it

tolerably obvious intermediate form,


to either of the
is

would then have come about through a 'p. The change from this
in MSS, for dpid/j-o^;

two forms of the symbol used

very slight, in one case being the loss of a stroke, in the


p.

other the loss of the loop of the

(2)

Diophantos

may have

used a sign approximately,

if

not exactl}^ like the form which

we now
"

find in

the MSS.

writing into two kinds, which he calls

Minuskelcursive."

Gardthausen divides cursive " Majuskelcursive " and One or other of these terms would be

Now

applied to a type of writing according as the uncial or cursive

element predominates.
dominates
is

That in which the uncial element prethe " Majuskelcursive," which is intermediate be-

tween the uncial and the cursive as commonly understood. Gardthausen gives examples of MSS. which show the gradations through which writing passed from one to the other. Among
the si^ecimens of the
"

Majuskelcursive
is

"

writing he mentions
A.D., i.e. earlier

a Greek papyrus, the date of which


the time of Diophantos.
for the

154

than

From

this MS.

two

letters

the

way

in

a and p, namely up. which Diophantos wrote the symbol

he quotes a contraction This may very well be


;

and, after

being copied by a number of scribes successively,


easily

it

might very

come

into the MSS.

which we know in the slightly simplified

form in which we find it\


1

Much

of

what
I

have written above concerning the symbol for dpi6/MS

appeared in an article
phantos," which
pp. 107

"On

a point of notation in the Arithmetics of Dio-

113).

contributed to the Journal of Philolofjy (Vol. xin. No. 25, Since that was written I have considered the subject more

thoroughly, and I have been able to profit by a short criticism of


as propounded in the article alluded to, by

my

theory,

Mr James Gow

in his recent History

of Greek Mathematics (Camb. Univ. Press, 1884). In the Addenda thereto Mr Gow states that he does not think my suggestion that the supposed final

sigma

is

a contraction of the

first

two

letters of apiOfi-os is true, for three reasons.

It is right that I

should answer these objections in this place.


contraction

I will take

them

in order.
1.

Mr Gow argues: "The

must be supposed
s

to be as old as

the time of Diophantus, for he describes the symbol as tA

instead of

to,

or

Tw

ap.

Yet Diophantus can hardly

(as

Mr Heath
remark that

admits) have used cursive


I

characters."

Upon

this objection I will

do not think the descrip-

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OV DMniANToS.


In the following paq^es, as
it
is

C".

impossible to say for


it
is

cort;iin

what

this sign really

is,

I shall

not hesitate, where

neces-

tion of the

symbol as to

proves that the supposed contraction must be ns


I see
Kal

oM

as the time of Piophantos himself.


liimself shoiikl not
to

no reason, even, why Diophnnfoi


cnjfxe'ov

have written

lanv avrov

to dp.

For

(a)

it

seems

me most natural tliat the article should be in the same number as Mr Gow might, I think, argae with equal force that the Greek should
((TTiv

ffrniuoy.

run, kcI

wuTov

ar]/M7a

ra dp.

And

yet

o-nixeTov

is

not disputed.

Saj)posing, then.

that
1(

we have assumed on other grounds that Diophantos used


contracted or uncontracted, of apiOp.6i as his symbol for

the
I

first

two

tters,

it,

do not seo

that the use of the article in the singular constitutes any objection to our

assumption.

(Ji)

Besides the censideration that to dp


its

is

perfectly possible

grammatically, we have yet other evidence for

possibility in expressions

which we actually find in the

text.

The symbol

for the fifth

power of the

unknown, or
twiarjixov

for 5vvaiJ.6Kv^os,

is

described thus:

Kal {<xtiv avrov arjftuov t6 ii

dp should
5k

/^cra v, ok". In this case much more than in the supposed case of we have expected the plural article with 5k instead of the singular but
;

iTria-rjfiov

?xo'to

i*

is

in apposition with ok"

and

is

looked upon as a single


If

expression,

and therefore preceded by the singular


it

article to.

we

give full

weight to these considerations,

must, I think, be admitted that

Mr Gow's

conclusion that the contraction must be as old as the time of Diophantoa,

whether true or not,


bodied in

is

certainly not established by his


r.

argument from the

description of the symbol as tA

Mr Gow's
appeai-s
to

first

Hence, as one link in the reasoning emobjection fail=;, the olijection itself breaks down.

Mr Gow

have misunderstood

me

w^hen he attributes to

me

tlic

inconsistency of supposing Diophantos to have used cursive characters, while


in another place I

clear from the explanation

had disclaimed such a supposition. It will be sufficiently which I have given of the origin of the contraction
At the same time meaning may be due
it

that I
as

am

very far from assuming that Diophantos used cursive characters such
in writing Greek.
it is

we now use

possible that

Mr Gow's

apparent mistake as to
glyph (and
thifs),

my

to

my own

.inadvertence in
is

saying (in the article above-mentioned) "If


I

[the symbol]

not a hiero-

have not found any evidence of


it

its

hieroglyphic origin), I would


letters

suggest that

might very well be a corruption of the two


I

where, however,

did not

mean

the cursive letters any

dp" (printed more than

uncials.
2.

now

pass to

Mr Gow's

second objection to

my

theory.
is

"The
It is

abbreviation

s for dpi.0p.6s

in its ordinary sense

very rare indeed.

not found in the mss. of Nicoraachus or Pappus, where it might most It may therefore be due only to a scribe who had some readily be expected. reminiscence of Diophantus." The meaning of this last sentence does not seem
quite clear.
it

presume
I

Mr Gow

to

mean "/h
I

the rare cases where

it

does occur,

may

be due, &c."

do not know that


I

dpiOixos is of
Still

very frequent occurrence in


(,,

concerned to prove that to" for mss. other than those of Diophanlon.
in stating to be the

am

the form

which

have no hesitation
lis.

same as

t-,.

occurs often enough in the Oxford

of Euclid to

make Gardthausen and


J

H. D.

CG
sary to designate

DIOPHAXTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
it,

to call it the final

sigma
is

for convenience'

Lebmann

notice

it.

And, even

if its

use in that ms.

due

to a scribe

wbo bad
tliis

some reminiscence

of Diophantos, I do not see that this consideration affects si^n

my

tbeory in the least. In fact, it is not essential for my theory that should occur in a single instance elsewhere than in Diophantos. It

is really
its

quite sufficient for


ordiiKn-y sense,
3.

my
I

purpose that o," occurs in Dioi>hantos for apiOfwi in

which

hold that

have proved.
is

Mr Gow's
full

tliird

objection

stated thus:

"If

is

for dp. then, by

symbol should be s' (like 5", k'") and not j." (a) I must first remark that I consider that arguments from analogy are inapplicable in The fact is that there are some points in which all the five signs of this case. which I have been speaking are undoubtedly analogous, and others in which some are not; therefore to argue from analogy here is futile, because it would be equally easy to establish by that means either of two opposite conclusions. I might, with the same justice as Mr Gow, argue backwards that, since there
analogy, the
is

undoubtedly one point in which

and

5" are

not analogous, namely the


a result which,
if

superposition in one case of terminations, in the other case of the second letter
of the word, therefore the signs

must be

differently explained
(b)

so far as
force of

it

goes,

would favour

my

view,

Besides, even that


s'

we admit the

Mr Gow's argument by

analogy,

is it true

(on the supposition


s

that

is for dp) is

analogous to 5" at all?

I think not; for

does not corres-

pond to 5, but (on my supposition) to 8v, and I only partially corresponds to v, inasmuch as is the tliinl letter of the complete word in one case, in the other (c) As a matter of fact, however, I maintain that my is the second letter, suggestion does satisfy analogy in one, and (I think) the most important respect, namely that (as I have above explained) Diophantos proceeded on one and the same system in making his abbreviations, taking in each case the two first letters of the word, the only difference being that in one case only are the two letters contracted into one sign. Let us now enquire whether my theory will remove the difficulties stated by Mr Gow on p. 108 of his work. As reasons for doubting whether the symbol for dpid/xoi is really a final sigma, he states the following. "It must be remembered (1) that it is only cursive Greek which has a final siijma, and that the cursive
t
i;
:

form did not come into use

till

the 8th or 9th century


s'

(2)

that inflexions are

and that his other symbols The objection (1) might be disposed (except f) are initial letters or syllables. of by the fact that the Greeks had two uncial sigmas C and 1, one of which might have been used by Dioi)hantus, but I do not see my way to dismissing
appended to Diophantus' symbol
(e.g. s", ssS etc.),

objection (2)."

First,

with regard to objection


s, it

(1)

Mr Gow
it

rightly says that,

supposing the sign were really

would be possible

to dismiss this objection.


:

On my

tlieory,

however,

it is

not necessai-y even to dismiss


(2).

it

does not exist.

"Diophantus' other symbols "Inflexions (except /;>) are inititil letters or syllables." I answer "So is to." are appended to Diophantus' symbol s'." I answer "True; but the nature of the sign itself made this convenient," as I have above explained.
Secondly,

my

theory will dismiss objection

NOTATION AND DKriNITIoNS uV


sake, subject to the
subject.
3.

)li

.pll

VNToS.

CyJ

remarks which

have here ma^le on the

to express the different

Next, as regards the notatiou Avhich Diupliaiitus used powers of the unknown quantity, i.e.

corresponding to
is

called
B".

tion*

x^, x^ and so on. The square of tlie unknown by Diophantos SviafiK: and denoted by the abbreviaNow tiie word Bvvafiiq ("power") is commonly used in

Greek to express a square number. The first occurrence of the word in its technical sense is probably as early as the second
B.C. Eudemos uses it in quoting from Hippokrates (no doubt word for word) who lived about that time. The dilBference iu use between the words Bvvafj.i<; and

half of the fifth century

TTpnycovo<i

corresponds, in Cantor's

view^, to the difference

l)etween our terms "second power" and "square" respectively,


first having an arithmetical signification as referring to a number, the second a geometrical reference to a plane surfacearea. The difference which Diophantos makes in their use is, however, not of this kind, and Sui/a/i/.? in a geometrical sense, is not at all uncommon; hence the correctness of Cantor's suggestion is not at all certain. Both terms are used by Diophantos, but in very different senses. hvvafii<i, as we have said, or the contraction 8" stands for the second power of the unknown quantitt/. It is the square of the unknown, apidfio'i or '<h, only and is never used to express the square of any other,

the

i.e.

Diophantos uses

For the square of any known number The higher powers of the unknown quantity which Diophantos makes use of he calls Kvfio<:, any known number.
TeTpdj(ovo<;.
BvvafioSvva/jic<;, Bvva/j,6Kv^o<;, KVfS6Kv/3o<i,

corresponding respec-

tively to x^,

X*,

x\

a.".

Beyond the
for higher

sixth

power he does not

go,

having no occasion
1

powers in the
mark over
in the

.solutions of his
it is

I should observe with respect to the


text of

the v that

given in the

Greek

Bachet as a circumtiex accent printed


later

form ~.

By

writers

on Diophantos
5".

than Bachet the sign has been variously printed as


it

3", a"

or

have generally denoted

by

quoting or referring to writers

who

except in a few special cases, when use either of the other forms. The same
5",

the abbreviation for ixovdSn, as well as to the circumflex written above the denominators of Cheek numerical fractions piven in this

remark applies

to

/tt,

chapter as examples from the text of Diophantos.


'

Gesrhichte der Mtitheiiuitik, p. 178.

GS
problems.
S/c",

DIOPH\NTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

For these powers he uses the abbreviations k^, ht'\ There is a difference between Diophantos' use of the complete words for the third and higher powers and that of Bvvafit<;, namely that they are not always restricted like Bvvafxt<; to powers of the unknown, but may denote powers of This is probably owing to ordinary known numbers as well. the fact that, while there are two words hvvafii<i and TeTpdywvo^ which both signify "square", there is only one word for a third
kkP respectively.

power, namely kv^o'?.


the abbreviations
",

It is important,
8S", 8/c",
/c/c"

however, to observe that

are, like Bvva/j,i<i

and

S", onlij

used to denote powers of the unknown. It is therefore obviously inaccurate to say that Diophantos "denotes the square
of a

only

number number

{hvvajxi^)

by

S",

the cube by

",

and

so on", the
9'

of which this could be said being the

{dpi,6fM6<;)

of the particular problem.

The

coefficients

which the different

powers of the unknown have are expressed by the addition of the Greek letters denoting numerals (as in the case of dpidfj.o'i
itself),

thus Sk^ kW corresponds to 26ir^


8"

Thus

in Diophantos'

system of notation the signs

and the

rest represent not

merely

the exponent of a power like the 2 in x^, but the whole expression, x\ There is no obvious connection between the symbol

tween

and the symbol 9' of which it is the square, as there is bex^ and X, and in this lies the great inconvenience of the But upon this notation no advance was made by notation. They wrote N Xylander, or even by Bachet and Fermat. (abbreviation of Numerus) for ?' of Diophantos, Q {Quadratas) for 8", C for " (cubus) so that we find, for example, \Q\oN='l^f,
S"

corresponding to x^

-\-

5x= 24.

Thus these

writers do in fact no

more than copy Diophantos.

We do, however, find other symbols

used even belore the publication of Xylander's Dioiiliantos, e g. Bombelli denotes the in 1572, the date of Bombelli's Algebra.

unknown and its powers by the symbols i, t, ^, and so on. But it is certain that up to this time the common symbols had
been Ji {Radix or Res), Z {Zensus i.e. square), C {Cuhvs). Apparently the first important step towards x'^, x^ &c. was taken by Vieta, who wrote Aq, Ac, Aqq, &c. (abbreviated fur A quadratus and so on) for the powers of A. This system,
besides showing in itself the connection between the difforfut.

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OF DIOI'HANTOS.


powers, has the infinite advantage that by
use in one and the
quantities.

GO

means of it we can same solution any number of unknown

This is absolutely impossible with the notati(.n used by Diophantos and the earlier algebraists. Diophantos does in fact never use more than one unknown quantity in the
solution of a problem,

namely the

apLdfi6<i ur

<;'

Diophantos has no symbol for the operation of multiplication: it is rendered unnecessary by the fact tiiat his coefficients are all definite numerals, and the results are simply put down without any preliminary step wdiich would make a symbol essential. On the ground that Diophantos uses only

4.

numerical expressions for coefficients instead of general symbols,


it

would occur to a superficial observer that there must be a

great want of generality in his methods, and consequently that


these, being (as

might appear) only applicable to the particular numbers which the author uses, are necessarily interesting only as clever puzzles, but not general enough to be valuable to the

serious student.
place, it

To

this

objection I reply that, in

the

first

was absolutely impossible that Diophantos should have used any other than numerical coefficients for the reason that the available symbols of notation were already employed, the letters of the Greek alphabet always doing duty as numerals,
with the exception of the
final
<?,

which Diophantos was supposed


quantity.

to have used to represent the

unknown

In the second

place T do not admit that the use of numerical coefficients only

makes
seen

his 'solutions

any the
to
to

less general.

This will be clearly

when

methods.

come Next as
I

give an account of his problems ami

Diophantos' symbols for the operations

of Addition and Subtraction.

For the former no symbol

at all

is

used:

it is

expressed by mere juxta-position, thus

K^dh^ly^i

corresponds to x^
is

+ V^x" + ox.

In this expression, however, there

no absolute term, and the addition of a simple numeral, as for instance /3, directly after e, the coefficient of vv, would cause confusion. This ."act makes it necessary to have some term to
indicate an absolute term in contradistinction to the variable

For this purpose Diophantos uses the word ^ovdha, or and denotes them after his usual manner by the abbreviation lA?. The number of monads is expressed as a c<offiiipnf.
terms.
units,

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Thus correspouding

to the above expression x^ i-ISou^

+ 5x+

we should

find in

Diophantus

''

8"

r-y

99 e

fi

$.

As Bachet

uses the sign

+ for addition, he has no occasion for a distinct symbol to mark an absolute term. He would accordingly write

IC +1'3Q + 5X+2.
Italians
first

It is

worth observing, however, that the

namely (Xumero), the power of the unknown being with them li (Rudice). Cossali* makes an interesting comparison between the terms used by Diophantos for the successive powers of the unknown and those employed by the Italians after their instructors, the Arabians. He observes that Fra Luca, Tartaglia, and Cardan begin their scale of powers from the power 0, not from the power 1, as does Diophantos, and compares the scales thus
do use a symbol
in this case,
Scala Diojantea.
1

Sc((la Anibii.

Numero.
Censo.

.il

Noto.

X
X.!' .T^

1.

Numero... riguoto.
Podesta.
Ciibo.

2.
:?.

Cosa, Radice, Lato.

2.
'6.

4.
5.
C).

Cubo.

4. 5.

Podesta-Podesta.

Censo Ccuso

di

Censo.

^5 x* x7
.1-8

Podesta Cubo.

Eelato V.
di

6.

Cubo-Cubo.

7.

Cubo, o Cubo

di

Censo.

7 8
[)

S.
1).

Relato2.

Censo

di
di

Censo
Cujo.

di Ceuso.

.1-9

10.

Cubo

and so on. So far, however, as this is meant to be a comparison between Diophantos and the early Arabian algebraists themselves (as the title Scala Araba would seem to inply), there
appears to be no reason

why

Cossali should not have placed


fiovdBe<i

some term
1, 2, 3, S:c.

to

express Diophantos
scale,

iu

the

with Numero in the other

and moved
first

tlie

one place upwards in the

scale, or

same line numbers downwards

comparison of the Diophantiue with the Arabian scale Cossali remarks: "ma egli non ha riflettuto a due altre diflerenze tra le scale medesime. La prima si e, che laddove Diofanto denomina con singolarita Numero 11 numero ignoto, denominanJo Monade il numero dato di compara'

Upon

Wallis'

zione

gli

antichi italiani degli arabi seguaci

e Radice, o IjuIo, o

comincia
risaltino

la

coiiiinciano
all"

denominano questo il Numero numero sconosciuto. La scconda e, che Diofanto scala dal numero ignoto; e Fra Luca, Tartaglia, Cardano la indal numero noto. Ecco le due scale di rincontro, onde meglio
;

Cosa

il

occhio

le

diffcrcnzc loro."

i.

p.

I'.lo.

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS


in tlie secoiul.

<K

l)It>l'IfANT(s.

71
sixtli

As Diopliantos does nut go "beyond


tirst

the

power, the hist three phices in the

scale are left blank.

An

examination of these two scales


for

will

show

also that the

generation of the successive powers

dirt'ers in

the two systems.

The Diophantine terms


cube" means

them

are based on the addition of

exponents, the Arabic on their multipliaition \


in ])iophantos of, in the Italian

Thus the "cube-

and Arabic system The first method of generation may (says Cossali) be x". described as the method by which each power is represented

by the product of the two lesser powers which are nearest to it, the method of viidtiplication ; the second the method of elevation, i.e. the method which forms by raising to the second or third power all powers which can be so formed, or the ^ih,
Cth, 8th, 9th, &c.
so

formed are called in Italian Relati.

The intermediate powers which cannot be Thus the fifth power is

Relato 1", x' is Relato 2", a-'" is Censo di Relato 1", .r" is Relato 3", and so on. Wall is calls these powers supevsolida, reproduced by Montucla as sursolides. For Subtraction Diophantos uses a symbol. His full terra for Negation is Xei-\\r.<;, corresponding to inrap^i<i, which denotes the opposite. Thus Xeiylrei (i.e. with the want of) stands for
minus, and the symbol used to denote
inverted
i/r

it

in

the MSS.
yfr

is

an

or
>>jt)

(Def. 9 /cat t^? Xet>|re&)9 (njfietov

X\nre<i

Kara) vevov

with the top shortened.

As Diophantos

uses

no distinct sign
together
after

for +, it is clearly necessary, to avoid confusion,

that all the negative terms in an expression should be placed


all

the positive

terms.

And
to x^

so

in

fact

he
1,

does place

them^

Thus corresponding

ox'

Sx

There is at least 1 This statement of Cossali's needs qualification however. one Arabian algebraist, Alkarkhi, the author of the Fakhri referred to above de(pp. 24, 25), who uses the Diophantine system of powers of the unknown pending on the additioji of exponents. Alkarkhi, namely, expresses all powers of the unknown above the third by means of nUil, his term for tlie square, and ka% his term for the cube of the unknown, as follows. The fourth power is
with hun mdl mdl, the
fifth null Jca'b,

the sixth ka'b ka'b, the seventh null mal

ninth ka'b ka'b ka'b, and bo on. Dr Heinrich Suter however has the erroneous statement that Diopliantos " ij ^ M '. which is exactly what h would express j?-5x^ + 8.r - 1 by k" d
ka'b, the eighth nial ka'b ka'h, the
/A

would not do.

72

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDKIA.
"

Diophantos would write

s"'

?;

>//v

S" e

d.

With

respect

and described as an inverted truncated \\r, I must here observe tliat I do not believe it to be what it is represented as being. I do not believe that Diophantos used so fantastic a sign for minus as an inverted truncated In the first place, an inverted -^^ seems too curious a sign, and too far-fetched. To one wlio was looking for a symbol to express mimis many others more natural
to this curious sign, given in the MSS. as
-v/r.

and

less

fantastic than

j/v

must have suggested themselves.


-x/r,

{Secondly, given

that
it
?

Diophantos used an inverted


expected
it

why
it,

should he truncate
sary
;

Surely that must have been unnecesunless, without

Ave could

hardly have

confusion was likely to arise; but

could hardly have been

confused with anything.


tion throws

It

seems to

me

that this very truncait

doubt on the symbol as we find


is

in the MS.

Hence
it

believe

that the conception of this symbol as an

inverted truncated -^
as such
is

a mistake, and that the description of


;

not Diophantos' description

it

appears to

me to

be

an explanation by a scribe of a symbol which he did not understand*. It seems to me probable that the true explanation is
the following
:

Diophantos proceeded

in this case as in

the others

which we have discussed (the signs for apt^/xd?, ^vvaiJii<;, etc.). As in those cases he took for his abbreviation the first letter of the word with such an addition as would make confusion with

numbers impossible (namely the second letter of the word, which in all happens to come later in the alphabet than the
corresponding
\et>|rt9
first

first

letter),

so,

in seeking

an abbreviation
Xtir,

for

and cognate

inflected

forms developed from


the word.

he
is

took the
Clearly

initial letter of itself

The

uncial" form

A.

would not serve his purpose, since it denotes a number. Therefore an addition is necessary. The second letter is E, but AE is equally a number. The second
1

A by

am

not even sure that the description can be

made

to

mean

all that it is

intended to mean.

AXiWs

scarcely seems to be sufliciently precise.


off,

Might
top?

it

not be applied to ^ with any part cut


*

and not only shortened


If

at the

adhere to the uncial form above for clearness' sake.

Diophantos used

the "Majuskelcursive" form, the explanation will equally apply, the difference
of form being for our purpose lU'Rlifiihle.

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OF


letter of the

DIOl'llANTt

)S.

7:{

stem Xnr

is

I,

but

Al

is

open
I

to objectiuii \slnii

so written.

Hence Diophantos placed the

inside the A, thus,

A.

Of

there

are

the possibility of this I entertain no doubt, because indubitable cases of combination, even in uncial

writing, of
ticular to

two

letters into
is

one sign.

would refer
for

in

par-

X, which
A,
is

an uncial abbreviation

TAAANTON.
(written in

Now

this sign.

an inverted and truncated

i/r

the uncial form, ^j; and we can, on this assumpti(tn, easily account for the explanation of the sign for minus which is given in the text.

i.e.

For Division it often happens that no symbol is necessary, in the cases where one number is to be divided by another which will divide it without a remainder. In other cases the by a
fraction,

division has to be expressed

whether the divisor

Thus the case comes under that of Fractions. To express numerical fractions Diophantos adopts a uniform system, which is also seen in other writers. The numerator he writes in the ordinary line like a number; then he places the denominator above the line to the right of the numerator, in the same place
or contain the variable.

be an absolute

number

of Division

as

we should
aP,

write an exponent, usually placing a ciicumflex


it.

a-cent over the eud of


is

Thus

i| is represented by tf'^

yJ^j^
,

-Win- is (v. 12) ^eTZT?""^", ^[\%' is (iv. 17) y.S'xicd^'^^'. Diophantos, however, often expresses fractions by simply putting
iv
fjLopiro

or [lopiov

between the numerator and the denominator,


Cf. IV,

i.e.

one number divided by another.


Vif/nV'
is
^^^'J
"^'-

29

pF-.^f

^ttS fiopiov
i.e.

HS^.fipixh, i.e.

-'^

/5-,^X

^^ p-opiw

pK^.aKi,

TyiC^o*
tos

There

a peculiarity in the

way

in

which DiophanIt
will

expresses such complex fractions as

,.,,'

be

best

understood

by giving a typical

case.

This jiarticular
is,

fraction Diopliantos writes thus,

aoyXB^^^.u^, that
i.
.

it is

as

if

he had written with our notation y^Y


"
-

Instances of this
fiH[)ii

notation occur passim,

cf.

V. 2 T7r6i"'^.d^ is e(iuivalent to in

-p.f

Bachet reproduces Diophantos' notation by writing


cases '/jY h ^^^^ iti
h

the.se

respectively.

74

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDHIA.
But there
is

another kind of fraction, besides the purely


is

numerical one, which


metics, such fractions
in

continually occurring in the Arithas involve the

namely

unknown quantity

some form or other in their denominators. The simplest case is that in which the denominator is simply a power of the Concerning fractions of this kind Diophantos unknown, 9'. says (Def. 3) "As fractions named after numbers have similar names to those of the numbers themselves (thus a third is

named from three, a fourth from monymous with what are called
- from
Kv^o<i, to

four), so
dpiO/iot,

the fractions hoor

unknowns, are
fraction to
BvvafiL<;,

called after them, thus from dpi6fx6<;


dpiOfjioaTov
[i.e.
;r],

we name the
from

to Suvafioarov

to

Kv^oarov from
/i.t<?,

SwafjuoBwafioaTov from SuvafioBvva-

TO Bvva/xoKv/SoaTOv from

Bwap-oKv^o^, and to kv^okv-

^oarov from Kv^oKv/So'i. And every such fraction shall have its symbol after the homonymous number with a line to indiThus we find, for cate the species" (i.e. the order or power)*.
8
. ,

example,

IV.

3,

77"*"

corresponding to

or with

the genitive

termination of dpiOfioaTov,

e.g., IV, 16, Xe''^-^

or

Cf. av^"-^

or-V-

250

^iJe by side with the employment of the symbols to


2, &c.,

express fractions corresponding to -,

we
:

find

the terms
regularly

dpiOfioarov, Bwafioarov k.t.X. used in full

this is

when the numerator Thus in numerical fraction.


the case

of the fraction itself contains a


v.

31 dptdfjioaTov d d^ corre^

sponds to

-^ and hwapLoarov T

d^ to -

complicated
1

Diophantos extends his use of fractions still further to more ca.ses in which the numerator and denominator
The meaning
is

of the last sentence

is

not quite clear.

am

inclined to

think there
?$ft 5^

something wrong with the


iirl Toy< ofiuvi'ifiov

text,

which stands

in

Bachet as follows
Ixo" SiaffT^Wovaav

iKaarov avTwv

dpiO/xov arjiii'iov

ypdij.fj.r]v

This he translates, "Habebit autem quaelibet pars a sibi cognomitie numero notarn et literam superscriptam quae speciem a specie distinguat."' Here apparently literam corresponds to ypdfifxr]v.
rb el5os.

XOTATIOX AND DKFIMTK t.NS OF UK )l'll ANTi )S.

7o

may be compound expressions themselves, Thus, iv. 37, we liave known ([uantity.
'

involving the un/u."

9''

"''", i.e.

AVhen, however,

tlie

denominator

is

a compound ex-

pression Diophantos uses the expedient which he adopts in the case of Large numbers occurring as numerator or denominator, namely, the insertion between the expressions denoting tlio

numerator and denominator of the term iv fjLopi(p or fxoplov. Thus in VI. 13 we find, h" ^./u," j34>k iv fiopup B"6" a /x" "^ \ei\Jrei 60^-' + 2520 -'5 c>., . ^,
.'

c.

sjc fiopiM o" a

'

>i^

s
/j.

^ r a corresponding to

2j-'

+
^

ox^^

+ ix +

\
.

To connect the two


are

sides of an equation Diophantos uses


i<to<;

Avords (cro9 or i'ao9 iari, or the oblique cases of

when they
It

made necessary by grammatical

construction.

would

appear, at least from Bachet's edition of Diophantos, that the

equations were put

down

in the

ordinary course of writing,

and that they were not placed


in

in separate lines for each step

the process of simplification, being in fact written in the


as the propositions of Euclid.

same way

We

have, however,

by which the steps were tabulated in a manner very similar to that of modern algebraical work, s<^ that by means of a sort of skeleton of the procedure we get a
signs of a system

kind of bird's-eye view of


])hantos

its course, in

the manuscript of Dio-

which Bachet

himself used.
in

We

have

it

on

the

authority of M. Rodet,

who

an

article in the

Journal Asia-

tique^ has occasion to quote certain passages from the text of

J)iophantos, that

to

certain

problems

is

attached a tabular

view of the whole process, which Bachet has not in his editinn reproduced at all. M. Rodet gives from the MS. several iniitances.

like

the modern, the two


I

In these we have equations set down in a form very members being connected by the
Besides

letter

(abbreviated for Xaoi) as the sign of e<iualit\'.

Janvier, 1878.
is
(

Here again the abbreviation which I have previously discnssed.


-

explicable

on the .same

jirinciiik-

as 11kc

by

itself

means
it.

10,

but a distin^ishinp

mark

is

ready to Land in the breathing' phmcd over

70
the
side

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
equations
written in this form words signifying the nature of
there
tlie

are

on

the

left

operation in passing
illustrate this I will
i.

from one particular step to the next.


"

To

give the table after Rodet for the very simple problem

32.

two numbers whose sum, and the ditference of whose squares are given." (The sum is supposed to be 20, the diffind

To

ference of squares
of the two

is

80.)

Diophantos assumes the difference


to be two dpidfioL
side,

numbers themselves
left

the Greek table on the


equivalent.
iKdeais
s" /uoT

I will put and on the right the modern

The operations
:

will

be easily understood.

yuoif. set]

virepox-f)

NOTATION AND DEFINITIONS OF DIOPIIANToS.

77

may remark on

the general system which he uses that it is essentially different in its character from the modern notation.

While in modern times signs and symbols have been developed which have no intrinsic relationship to the things which they syml)olise, but depend for their use upon convention, the case is quite different with Diophantos, where algebraic notation takes the form of mere abbreviation of words which are considered a.s
pronounced or implied.
This
is

partly proved by the symbols


first letter

themselves, which in general consist of the

or letters

of words (so written as to avoid confusion), the only possible exception being the supposed final sigma, 9, for dpiBfxof or the

unknow^n quantit3^ Partly also it is proved by the fact that Diophantos uses the symbol and the complete word very often
quite indifferently.
9

Thus we

find often in the

or 99

and

dpt6fi6<;, dpiO/xol, S"

and
is

hvvaixi<;,

^ and

same sentence \eiyjrei, and

so on.

The

strongest proof, however, that Diophantos' algebraic

notation >vas mere abbreviation

found in the fact that the


those words have a quite

abbreviations, which are his algebraical symbols, are used for

the corresponding words even


different signification.

when

So

in particular the

symbol
is

9 is

used as
its

an abbreviation

for dpL6fi6<;,

when the word

used, not in
in its

technical Diophantine sense for the

unknown, but

ordinary

meaning

of a number, especially in enunciations ^\here dpi$fi6<;

in its ordinary sense naturally occurs oftenest.

Similarly

is

not used only for

Xelyjret

but also
diro

for

other inflexional forms of

the stem of this word,


Tpel<;

e.g. for Xiiruv or \Lyjra<; in ill. 3:

Evpeh'
JJ^

dpiOfiov^
nroifj

o7rco<;

tov avy/ceifievov

iic

rcov rpLiov

eKaarov

Other indications are (1) the separation of the symbc.ls and coefficients by particles [cf. I. 4:J 99"' dpa I] (2) the addition of terminations to the symbol to represent the different cases. Nesselmann gives a good instance in which many of these peculiarities are combined, 99' dpa
rerpdycovoi'.
;

fx

laot elalv

99'*

Td fiovdcrc

Tt.

I.

ad Jin.

In order to determine in what place, in respect of .systems


of algebraic notation, Diophantos stands, Nesselmann observes

that

we

can, as regards the

form of exposition cf algebraic

operations and equations, distinguish three historical stages of

development, well marked and easily discernible.

1.

Tho

first

<S

DIorilANTOS OF ALKXANDlilA.

Stage Nesselinann repiesonts by the


or "reckoning by Complete words."

name Rltetoric Algebra, The characteristic of this


of complete words,

stage

is

the absolute want of

all

symbols, the svhole of the

calculation being carried on by

means

and

forming in fact continuous prose.


first

As

representatives of this

stage Nesselmann mentions lamblichos (of whose algebraiwork he quotes a specimen in his fifth chapter) "and all Arabian and Persian algebraists who are at present known." In their works we find no vestige of algebraic symbols the same may be said of the oldest Italian algebraists and their followers, and among them Regiomontanus. 2. The second stage Nesselmann proposes to call the Syncopated Algebra. This stage is essentially rhetorical and therein like the first in
cal
;

its

treatment of questions, but we now find for often-recurring

operations and quantities certain abbreviational symbols.


this

To

stage

belongs Diophantos and after him

all

the later

Europeans until about the middle of the seventeenth century (with the exception of the isolated case of Vieta, who, as we
have seen, initiated certain changes which anticipated later notation to some extent; we must make an exception too, though Nesselmann does not mention these cases, in favour of being used by certain symbols used by Xylandcr and Bachet, the former to express equality, + and by both, as also the
j|

ordinary
tor

way of representing a
3.

fraction

by placing the numera-

above the denominator separated by a Hue drawn horizon-

tally').

To the

third stage

Nesselmann gives the name

Symbolic Algebra, which uses a complete system of notation

by signs having no visible connection with the words or things which they represent, a complete language of symbols, which
supplants entirely the rhetorical system,
it

being possible to

work out a solution without using a

single

word of the ordinary

written language, with the exception (for clearnes.s' sake) of


1

These are only a few scattered instances.

Nesselmann, though he does

not mention Xylauder's and Bachet's symbols, gives other instances of isolated or common uses of signs, as showing that the division between the dilTerent

He instances the use of one operational algebraic is not shfirphj marked. symbol by Diophantos, namely ^, for which Lucas de Bnrgo uses m (and p for plKn), Targalia (p. Vieta has + and -, also = for ~. Oughtred uses x and Harriot expresses multiplication by juxtaposition.
stages
,

NOTATION AND DKl'lMTK )NS

(.F

Llopll ANTuS.

70
is
it

a conjunction here ami there, and so on.

Neither

thr

Europeans posterior to the middle of the seventeenth century who were the first to use Si/mbolic forms of Algebra, In this they were anticipated many centuries by the Indians.

As examples of these three stages Nesselmann gives three instances quoting word for word the solution of a quadratic
equation by
stage,

trate

Mohammed ibn Musa as an example of the first and the solution of a problem from Diophantos to illusthe second. Thus
Example from Molmmmed
square and ten of
is, if

First Stage.

ibn

Musa

(ed.

Rosen,
the

p, 5).

"A

its roots

are equal to nine

and thirty dirhems, that

you add ten

roots to one square,

sum

is

equal to nine and thirty.

The
is

solution

is

as follows
five
;

halve the

number

of roots,

that

in this case

then

and the result is five and twenty. Add this to the nine and thirty, which gives sixty-four; take the square root, or eight, and subtract from it half the number of roots, namely five, and there remain three this is the root of the square whicli was required and the square itself is
multiply this by
itself,
:

nine^."

bers, so that this

Here we observe that not even are symbols used for numexample is even more "rhetorical" than the

w^ork of larablichos

who does

use the Greek symbols

for his

numbers.
Second
lation
stage. for

word

As an example of Diopliantos I give a transword ^ of II. 8, So as to make the symbols

correspond exactly I use


her) for
"
9,

S {Square)

for h" {8vvaf/.c<i),

(Xiunbe

U for

Units

{fiovdhe<i).

To

divide the proposed square into two squares.

Let

it

proposed then to divide 16 into two squares.


'

And

let the first

Thus Mohammed ilm

Mfisfi states in

words the solution

x2+10j + 25 = C4,
therefore

x + 5 = 8, x = 3.

words whenever Diophantos does so, and to avoid confusion have written Siium-c and Xiimbfi- in the technical sense with a capital letter, and italicised tlicm.
'

have used the

full

80

DIOPHANTOS OF Al.EXANDIUA.

be supposed to be Oue Square.

Thus 16 miuus One Square must be equal to a square. I form the square from any number of iV's minus as many U's as there are in the side of 16 U's. Suppose this to be 2 K's miuus 4 U's. Thus the square itself These are equal to will be 4 Squares, 16 U. minus 16 ^V.'s. 16 Units minus Oue Square. Add to each the negative term deficiency) and take equals from equals. Thus (Xeti/ri?, 5 Squares are equal to 16 Numbers; and the Number is 16 fifths. One [square] will be 256 twenty-fifths, and the other 144 twenty-fifths, and the sura of the two makes up 400 twenty-fiftlis, or 16 Units, and each [of the two found] is a

square.

Of
^>^

the third stage any exemplification

is

unnecessary.
is

6. that he

To the form
is

of Diophantos' notation

due the

fact

unable to introduce into his questions more than one


quantity.

unknown

This limitation has

made

his procedure

modern work. In the first place he performs eliminations, which we should leave to be done in the course of the work, before he prepares to work out the problem, by expressing everything which occurs in such a way This is the case in the great as to contain only one unknown.
often very different from our

majority of questions of the

first

Book, which are cases of the


first

solution of determinate simultaneous equations of the

order

with two, three, or four variables; all these Diophantos expresses in terms of one unknown, and then proceeds to find it

from a simple equation.

In cases where the relations between

these variables are complicated, Diophantos shows extraordinary

acuteness in the selection of an unknown quantity. Secondly, however, this limitation affects much of Diophantos' work injuriously, for while he handles problems which are by nature

indeterminate and woukl lead with our notation to an inde-

terminate equation containing two or three unknowns, he


these
arbitrarily-chosen numbers which have the making the problem a determinate one. However
fair to

is

compelled by limitation of notation to assign to one or other of


effect
it is

of

but

say that Diophantos in assigning an arbitrary value to


is

a quantity

careful to tell us so, saying " for such

and such

a quantity we put any number wliatever, say such and such

NOTATION AND DKFINITION'S


a one."

(tF

1)F<

)riIANT()S.
(in

Hi
LfiMieral)

Thus
is

it

can lianlly be said

tliat

there

is

any loss of Diophantos

universality.

We

may

say, then, that in general

obliged

to

express

all

his
is

unknowns
something

in terms,

or as functions, of one variable.

There

exce.ssively
.so

interesting in the clever devices by which he contrives

to

express

them

in

terms of his single unknown,


all

<?,

as that

by that

very expression of them


satisfied

conditions

of the

problem are

except one, which serves to complete the solution by

determining the value of


tos'

Another consequence of Diophan9. want of other symbols besides 9 to express more variables
is

than one

that,

when

(as often

happens)

it is

necessary in the

course of a problem to work out a subsidiary problem in order


to obtain the coefficients &c. of the functions of 9 which express

the quantities to be found, in this case the required

unknown
is

which

is

used for the solution of the new subsidiary problem


9
;

denoted by the same symbol

hence we have often in the


with two
diti'erent

same problem the same


meanings.
cases,

variable 9 used

an obvious inconvenience and might lead to confusion in the mind of a careless reader. Again we find two
This
is
II. 29 and 30, where for the proper working-out of the problem two unknowns are imperatively necessary. We should

of course use x and y


i.e. 1.

but Diophantos

calls

the

first 9

as u.sual

the second, for want of a term, he agrees to

call "

one unit,"

Then,

later,
9

necessary to find

having completed the part of the solution he substitutes its value, and uses 9 over
1 "

again to denote what he had originally called "


variable

the

second

and so finds

it.

This

is

the most curious case I have

with, and the way in which Diophantos after having worked with this " 1 " along with other numerals is yet able to pounce upon the particular place where it has passed to, so as to

met

substitute 9 for

it, is

very remarkable.

sible in particular cases

such as those which

This could only be posI have mentioned

seems scarcely possible now to work out the problem using x and 1 for the variables as originally taken by Diophantos without falling into confusion. Perhaps, however,- it may not be impo.ssible that Diophantos in working out the
but, even here,
it

problems before writing them down as we have them may have given the " 1 " which stood for a variable some mark by which
H. D.

82

DIOPHANTo.S OF ALKXANDl'JA.

it and distinguish it from otlier numbers. For the problems themselves see Appendix. It may be in some measure due to the defects of notation in his time that Diophantos will have in his solutions no numbers whatever except rational numbers, in which, in addition to surds and imaginary quantities, he includes negative quantities. Of a negative quantity i^er se, i.e. without some positive quantity to subtract it from, Diophantos had apparently no conception. Such equations then as lead to surd, imaginary, or

he could recognise

negative roots he regards as useless for his purpose


tion
is

the solufind
it

in these cases dSvvaro'i, impossible.

So we

him

describing the equation 4


give ^

= 4.r +

20 as utotto^ because
it

would
fre-

4.

Diophantos makes

throughout his object to

obtain solutions in rational numbers, and

we

find

him

quently giving, as a preliminary, conditions which


satisfied,

must bo

which are the conditions of a result rational in DioIn the great majority of cases when Diophantos arrives in the course of a solution at an equation M'hich would give an irrational result he retraces his steps and finds
phantos' sense.

out

how

his equation has arisen,

the previous work substitute for

and how he may by altering it another which shall give

a rational result. This gives rise, in general, to a subsidiary problem the solution of which ensures a rational result for the

problem
for

itself.

Though, however, Diophantos has no notation


results, it is scarcely true to

a surd, and does not admit surd


results.

say that he makes no use of quadratic equations which lead to

such

Thu.s, for
far

example, in

v.

33 he solves such an

equation

so

as

to

be able to see to what integers the

solution would approximate

most

nearly.

CHAPTEIi

V.

DIOPHANTOS' METHODS OF SOLUTION.

1.

Before I give an accouut in detail of the

differojit

methods which Diophantos employs

for the sohition of his pro-

blems, so far as they can be classified, I must take exception to some remarks which Hankel has made in his account of Diophantos {Zur Geschichte der Mathematik in Alterthum vnd
Mittelalter,

Leipzig,

1874, pp. 164


:

5).

This

account does

not only possess literary merit

it is

the work of a

man who

has read Diophantos.

His remarks therefore possess excep-

tional value as those of a

man

particularly well qualified to

speak on matters relating to the history of mathematics, and also from the contrast to the mass of writers who have thought
themselves capable of pronouncing upon Diophantos and his
merits, while they

show unmistakeably that they have not


Hankel, who has read Diophantos with
aj)-

studied his work.

preciation, says in the place referred to,

"The
of,

reader will

now

be desirous to become acquainted with the classes of indeterminate problems which Diophantos treats
of solution.

and

his

methods
that

As

regards the

first

point,

we must observe

in the 130 (or so) indeterminate questions, of which Diophantos


treats in his great work, there are over 50 different classes of

questions, which are arranged one after the other without any

recognisable classification, except that the solution of earlier

questions facilitates that of the later.


tains determinate algebraic equations;

The

first

Book only con-

Books ir. to v. contain for the most part indeterminate questions, in which expressions which involve in the first or second degree two or more variables Lastly, Book vi. is concerned are to be made squares or cubes.

84

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
regarded purely arithmetically, in

Avith riglit-augled triangles

which some one linear or quadratic function of the sides is to be made a square or a cube. That is all that we can pronounce
about this elegant series of questions vnthout exhibiting singhj each of the fifty classes. Almost more different in kind than the questions are their solutions, and we are completely unable
to give an even tolerably exhaustive review of the different
varieties in

his
is

procedure.

Of more

general comprehensive
:

methods there
tion requires
the

in our author no trace discoverable

every ques-

an

entirely different method, winch often, even in


to

problems most nearly related

the former, refuses its aid.

It is on that account difficult for

a more modern mathematician

even after studying 100 Diophantine solutions to solve the lOlsi


question
;

and

if

endeavours read Diophantos' own solution,


to see

we have made the attempt and after some vain we shall be astonished
leaves the broad high-road,

how suddenly Diophantos


often

dashes into a side-path and with a quiet turn reaches the


goal

enough a goal with reaching which we should not we expected to have to climb a difficult path, but instead of to be rewarded at the end by an extensive view which our guide leads by narrow, strange, but smooth ways to He lacks the calm and a small eminence he has finished concentrated energy for a deep plunge into a single important problem and in this way the reader also hurries with inward unrest from problem -to problem, as in a succession of riddles, without being able to enjoy the individual one. Diophantos dazzles more than he delights. He is in a wonderful measure
:

be content

wise, clever, quick-sighted, indefatigable, but does not penetrate

thoroughly or deeply into the root of the matter.


tions

As

his ques-

seem framed

in

obedience to no obvious scientific necessity,

often only for the sake of the solution, the solution itself also lacks

perfection and deeper signification.

He

is

a brilliant performer

in the art of indeterminate analysis invented

by him, but the

science has nevertheless


brilliant genius for

been indebted, at

least directly, to this

few methods, because he was deficient in

speculative thought which sees in the


Correct.

True more than the

That

is

the general impression, which I have gained

from a thorough and repeated study of Diophantos' arithmetic."

DIOPIIANTOS

METHODS OF SOLUTION.
if

S.")

Now
tion
is

it

will

be at once obvious that,

Ilaiikcl's representa-

any hope of giving a general account of Diophantos' methods such as I have shown in the heading of this chapter would be perfectly illusory. Hankel clearly asserts tliivt there are no general methods distinguishable in the Arithmetics. On the other hand we find Nesselmann saying (pp. 308 9) that the use of determinate numerals in Diophajitos' problems constitutes no loss of generality, for throughout he is continually showing how other numerals than those which
correct,

"

he takes will satisfy the conditions of the problem, showinnthat his whole attention is directed to the explanation of the
method, for Avhich purjjose numerical examples only serve as

means " this is proved by his frequently stopping short, when the method has been made sufficiently clear, and the remainder of the work is mere straightforward calculation. Cf. v. 14, IS, It is true that this remark may only apply to the 19, 20 &c. isolated " method " employed in one particular problem and in no other but Nesselmann goes on to observe that, though the Greeks and Arabians used only numerical examples, yet they had general rules and methods for the solution of equations, as we have, only expressed in words. "So also Diophantos, whose methods have, it is true, in the great majority of cases no such
; ;

universal character, gives us a perfectly general rule for solving

what he calls a double-equation." These remarks Nesselmann makes in the 7th chapter of his book the 8th chapter he
;

entitles

"Diophantos' treatment of equations',"


classified

in

which he

gives an account of Diophantos' solutions of (1) Deterniinato,


(2)

Indeterminate equations,

according to their kind.

Chapter 9 of his book Nesselmann


of solution^"

calls

"Diophantos' methods
:

These "methods" he gives as fcjlJows^ (1) "The adroit assumption of unknowns." (2) "Metho<l of reckoning
^

2
3

"Diophant's BehandlunR der Gleichunt,'tn." "Diophant's AuflosuriKsmethodeu." "Die gescbickte Annahme dcr Unbekannten." (1)
(3)
(4)

(2)

'Mflhode
fiir

ilcr

Zuriickrechming und Nebenaufgabe."

"Gebrauch dcs Symbols


"Autt.isung
in

dio

Unbekannte in verschiedenen Bedeutungen." "Auflosung durch blo.sse Reflexion." (G) (5)


Ausdriicken."
(7)

"Metliodc der Gren/.fu."


ollKemeinPn
(8)

" Willkiihrliche Bestiniraungen

und Annuhnien."

"tie-

branch dcs rcchtwinkhu'cn Dipiecks."

86

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
(3) "

backw artls and auxiliary questions."


for

Use

of the
(4)

symbol

the

unknown
(5)
"

in

different significations."

"Method

of Limits."
in

Solution by mere reflection."

(G) " Solution

general expressions."
(8) "

(7) "Arbitrary determinations and

assumptions."

Use

of the right-angled triangle."


it
is

At

the end of chapter 8 Nesselmann observes that


at,

not

the solution of equations that we have to wonder


fect art

but the per-

which enabled Diophantos

to avoid such equations as

he

could not technically solve.

We

look (says Nesselmann) with

astonishment at his operations, when he reduces the most difficult questions by some surprising turn to a simple equation.
"

Then, when in the 9th chapter Nesselmann passes to the methods," he prefaces it by saying " To represent perfectly Diophantos' methods in all their completeness would mean nothing else than copying his book outright. The individual
:

him occasion to upon it a peculiar procedure or found upon it an artifice Meanwhich cannot be applied to any other question while, though it may be impossible to exhibit all his methods in any short space, yet I will try to give some operations which occur more often or are by their elegance particularly noticeable, and (where possible) to make clear their scientific principle by a general exposition from common stand-points." Now the question whether Diophantos' methods can be exhibited briefly, and whether there can be said to be any methods in his work, must depend entirely upon the meaning we attach to the word "method." Nesselmann's arrangement seems to me to be
characteristics of almost every question give
try

faulty

equations

inasmuch as (1) he has treated Diophantos' solution of which certainly proceeded on fixed rules, and there" separately from what he calls " methods of fore by " method solution," thereby making it appear as though he did not look

upon the

" treatment of equations " as " methods." Now cer" should, if anything, have tainly the " treatment of equations head of " methods of solution " and obviously

come under the

the very fact that Diophantos solved equations of various kinds by fixed rules itself disproves the assertion that no metJwds
;nc
"

discernible.

(2)

The

classification

under the head of


In
tlic

Mctliods

of

solution"

seems

unsatisfactory.

first

DIOPHANTOS METHODS UF SoLlTIoX.


place,

S7

some

of the classes can hardly be said to be nu'thmls of

solution at all;

thus the third, "Use of the symbol for the


significations",

unknown

in

different

might be more justly


it

described as a "hindrance to the solution";

is

vlxx

inconve-

nience to which Diophantos was reduced owing to the want of

Secondly, on the assumption of the eight " methods" Nesselmann describes them, it is really not surprising that " no complete account of them could be given without copying the whole book." To take the first, "the adroit assumption of unknowns." Supposing that a number of distinct, ditferent
notation.
as

problems are proposed, the existence of such differences makes a different assumption of an unknown in each case absolutely
necessary.

That being
cases
?

so,

how

could

it

be possible to give a
is

rule for

all

The

best that can be done

an enumera-

tion of typical instances.

The assumption

that the methods

of Diophantos
fact,
i.e.,

cannot be tabulated, on the evidence of this


"

because no rule can be given for the


Precisely the

adroit assump-

tion of

unknowns" which Nesselmann

classes as a

"method,"

is

same may be said of "methods" (2), (5), (C), (7). For these, by the very nature of things, no rule can be given they bear in their names so much The case of (4), "the of rule as can be assigned to them. Method of Limits", is different; here we have the only class which exemplifies a "method" in the true sense of the term,
entirely unwarranted.
:

i.e.

as an instrument for solution.

And

accordingly in this case


:

the method can be exhibited, as I hope to show later on


(8) also

deserves to some extent the

name

of a " method."

I think, therefore, that neither

Nesselmann nor Hanktl has

treated satisfactorily the question of Diophantos' methods, the


classification, the latter by methods are anywhere discernible in Diophantos. It is true that we cannot find in Diophanto.s' work statements of method put generally as book-work to be applied

former through a faulty system of


general

denying that

But it was not Diophantos' object to write a textto examples. book of Algebra. For this reason we do not find the separate rules and limitations for the solution of different kinds of equations systematically arranged, but we have to seek them out
laboriously from the

whole of his work, gathering

.5cattcred

88
indications here

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

and there, and so formulate tlicni in the best Such being the case, I shall attempt in the following pages of this chapter to give a detailed account of what may be called general methods running through Diophantos. For the reasons which I have stated, my arrangement will be different

way we

can.

from that of Nesselmann, who is the only author who has attempted to give a complete account of the methods. I shall not endeavour to describe as methods such classes of solutions as are some which are, by Nesselmann, called "methods of solution":
and, in accordance with his remark that these "

methods" can

only be adequately described by a transcription of the entire

work,

shall

leave

them

to

be gathered from a perusal of


is

my

reproduction of Diophantos' book which

given in

my

Appendix.

2.

I sluili

begin

my

account with

Diophantos' tueatmknt of equations.


This subject
falls

naturally into two division.s


different

(A) Deter-

minate

equations

of

degrees.

(B)

Indeterminate

equations.

(A.)

Determinate equations.
difficulty to solve
;

Diophantos was able without


c( [nations

determinate

of the first

and second degree

of a cubic equation
is

we

Hnd

in his Arithmetics only

one example, and that

a very

special case.

over; hence
of solution

The solution of simple equations we may pass we must separately consider Diophantos' method
of
(1)

Pure

equations,

(2)

Adfected, or mixed

quadratics.

(1)

Pare determinate
equations I

equations.

By pure
solution
is

mean

those equations which contain

oidy one power of the unknown, whatever the degree.


effected in the .same
;

The way whatever the exponent of


eijuations
first

the term in the

unknown and Diophantos regards pure

of any degree as though thfy were simple C(iuations of the

DIOPHANTOS METHODS OF SOLLTION.


degree'.

M)

He

the degree: "If


side the

gives a general rule for this case without regard to we arrive at an equation containing on each
different coefficients,

same term but with


if

we must take

equals from equals, until


term.

we

get one term equal to another


sides until all tiie terms

But,

there are on one or on both sides negative terms,

the deficiencies

must be added on both


is left

on both sides are positive.


equals until one term
tions have

Then we must take


on each
side."
is

equals from

After these opera-

been performed, the equation


is

reduced to the form

Ax"*

= B and

considered solved.
in

The

c^vses

which occur
is

in

Diophantos are cases


a
rational

which the value of x

fouud to be

number, integral or fractional. Diophantos only x which satisfies this equation thus if m is even, he gives only the positive value, a negative value jjer In the same se being a thing of which he had no conception. way, when an equation can be reduced in degree by dividing
recognise one value of
;

throughout by any power of

x,

the possible values,

x=0,

tlius

arising are not taken into account.

Thus an equation
t'>

of the

form

x^

= ax,
x

which
is

is

of

common

occurrence in the earlier part


the simjIe

of the book,
ecpiation
It

taken to be merely equivaleut

= a.
observed that the greater proportion of the pro-

may be
in

Book l. are such that more than one unknown quantify Now% when there are two unknowns and two condiis sought. tions, both unknowns can be easily expressed in terms of one symbol. But when there are three or four quantities to be found this reduction is much more difficult, and Diophanto-s
blems
manifests peculiar adroitness in effecting
that
it is
it
:

the result being

unknown

only necessary to solve a simple equation with one With regard to pure eciuations, .some have quantity.
tlie

asserted that pure quadratics were

only form

>f

([uailratic

'

Dof. 11:
fir}

MerA

5^

Tavra iav

airb

irpofi\r)naT6s rii'ot yivijTai Crapiit ilitai

To?s aiiToh

bixoirX-qdr)

Si dirb iKaripwv tCiv fitpCiv, Strati i^xupfiy rd Ofioia


(?)

aw6 im-

Twv

ofioiwu,

iws av ifbs

eZSos ivl etdfi toov y^vrrrai.

4cu>

bl

Twt

(V oTOTifHfi

irdpxv^^) V ^v diJ.<poT^poii ivtWei^f/ri TifiL etSr), Sc^ati Kp<(jOtlvai ri. Xiiworra itSif (i> dn(l>oT^pois Tois ixipeaiv, ?wj dv inaTtpip tu.'v nfpwv to. ttorj iwwdpxovTa finfrai.
Kal
trdXiv

d^eXfiv

rd

cp.oia

dirb

rwf

ofioluv

tm

ay cKor^/x^ twi' fitpif In tlSot

Kara\ui>0^.

Bachet's text

(lO-il). p. 10.

90

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
:

solved in Diuplianto;;'

a statement entirely without foundation.

We

proceed to consider
(2)

Mixed quadratic

equations.

After the remarks in Def. 11 upon the reduction of pure


equations until

we have one term equal

to

another term,

Diophantos adds*: "But we will show you afterwards how, in the case also when two terms are left equal to a single term,
such an equation can be solved."
Arithmetics, as

That

is

to say, he promises to

explain the solution of a mixed quadratic equation.

In the
fulfilled.

we

possess the book, this promise

is

not

The

first

indications

we have on the
is

subject are a

number

of

cases in which the equation

given, and the solution written

down, or stated to be rational without any work being shown.


Thus,
IV. 23,
a;

"x
:

4a;

4,

therefore

cc

= 2":

vi. 7, "8-^x^

lx = 7,
vi.

hence

= ^"

vi. 9, " 630.^'^


G,

73.r = 6,

therefore

x = f^": and,

and x is rational." These examples, though proving that somehow Diophantos had arrived at the result, are not a sufficient proof to satisfy us that he necessarily was acquainted with a regular method for the solution of quadratics these solutions might (though their variety makes it somewhat
8, " G30j;*^

+ 7Sx =

mere ti'ial. That, however, mixed quadratics were not merely In this problem he empirical, is shown by instances in v. 3.1 shows pretty plainly that his method was scientific, in that he
unlikely) have been obtained by

Diophantos' solutions

of

indicates that he could approximate to the root in cases


it is

not rational.

As

this

is

where an important point, I give the


:

substance of the passage in question


that
x'
it

"x has
.

to be so
2

determined
o.r,

must be >
S.r.

^'-GO -

and <

x'-iJO

-^

i.e. .x

,.n - 00 >

and

GO <

Therefore

x"

Hx

+ some number >

GO, therefore
a;

be not

less

than II, and x^

<8x +

60, therefore

x must must be not

greater than 12."


1

Cf. Iloimer,

translation

of

Bossut's

Ge.^rh.

d.

Dictionary.
*

Also Dr Hcinrich Siitcr's doubts in Oesch.


(TOL

Math. i. 55. Kliigel's d. Math. Zurich, 1873.

vaTfpov hi

Sci^ofxev Kal

ttois

8i'o iidJiv

lawv

iv\

KaraXfifdivTwv t6 towvtov

\vtTai.

DIOrilAXTOS' MKTIloDS UF SOLUTION.

11

Now

by examining the roots of these two equations we rtnJ

x>

^,

and .'<4 +

V<(),

or .v> lO-G'-ldi and


It
is

x<

Il'TITN.

clear therefore that x inai/ be

<

1 1

or

>

12,

and there-

fore Diophantos' limits are not strictly accurate.

As however

it was doubtless his object to find integral limits, the limits 11 and 12 are those wdiich are obviously adapted for his purpose, and are a fortiori right. Later in the same problem he makes an auxiliary determination of x, which must be such that

x^+m>1c,
which give

a,-'

+ GO <

Sir,

x>\l+J(ji, a;<12 + J^\.


10,

Here Diophantos says x must be >


are clearly the nearest integral limits.

<21,

wliioli

again

The occurrence
be hit upon by

of these two examples which we have given

of equations whose roots are irrational, and therefore could not


trial,

show's that in such cases Diophantos

must

have

liad a
it

method by which he approximated


mixed quadratic
equations.

to these roots.

Thus

may

be taken for granted that Diophantos had a definite

rule for the solution of

We

are further able to

make out

the formula or rule by

which Diophantos solved such equations. Take, for example, In our modern method of solution the equation ax^ \- hx c = 0. we divide by a and write the result originally in tlic form
-\-

x=

/~T^

y~

It docs not
a.

appear that Diophantos

divided throughout by

to bring the equation into the

Rather he first multiplied by a so as tlicn form aV + ahx + ac =


;

solving

he

found
f..rm

ax= \h J\i}^ ac,


,^_^
^

and regarded the

result in the'

^'l

^'-^,

Whether
it is

the

inter-

a
mediate procedure was as we have described
but
it is

n(H certain

certain that he used the result in the form given.

One

remark however must be made upon the form


'

of the root.

Nessi'luiann, p.

:ilO.

Also

IJo.li-t,

Jountdl

A^iniiijiir. .Iiiiivi.r, I'-T-.

92

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
tlie

Diophantos takes no account of

existence of two roots,

according to the sign taken before the radical.


giving the value of the root.
surprise us in cases

Diophantos

ignores always the negative sign, and takes the positive one as

Though

this

perhaps might not

where one of the roots obtained is negative, yet neither does Diophantos use both roots when both arc In contrast to this Nessehnann points out positive in sign. that the Arabians (as typified by Mohammed ibn Milsa) and the older Italians do in this latter case recognise both roots. M. llodet, however, remarks upon this comparison between
Diophantos and the Arabians, so unfavourable to the former, as follows (a) Diophantos did not write a text-book on Algebra, and in the cases where the equation arrived at gives two
positive solutions one of

them
a;

is

excluded a priori, as
v. 13.

for ex-

ample
72.r

in the case quoted


llx'^

by him,

>

+ 17

would give

< ff

or else

Here the inequality x<-^. But the other


19,

inequality to be satisfied
ov

is

*l^x<l^x^ +

which gives

x>\%

x> f^.

impossible.

As however -^j < /\j, the limits x<^\> fjj are Hence the roots of the equations corresponding
must necessarily be
rejected.

to the negative sign of the radical


(6)

Mohammed

ibn Mu^a, althougli recognising in theory two

roots of the equation x^

+c=

hx, in practice

only uses one of

the two, and, curiously enough, always takes the value cor-

responding to the negative sign before the radical, whereas

Diophantos uses the positive

sign.

But

see Chapter viii.

the rule given in Def. 11 for compensating by addition any negative terms on either side of an equation and taking equals from equals (operations called by the Arabs aljahr and

From

almulcahala)

it

is

clear

that

as

a preliminary to

solution

Diophantos so arranged his equation that all the terms were Thus of the mixed quadratic equation we have three positive.
cases of which

we may give

instances

thus,

Case

1.

YoYm mx^

-rpx

q; the root
instance

-^,p + Jip' + m<i


is
1)1

according to

Diophantos.

An

is

afforded

by

VI.

G.

Diophantos arrives namely at the equation C./-I- 3u: = 7, which, if it is to be of any service to his solution, should give a rational
value of X
;

whereupon Diophantos says

"

the S(]uarc of half

tlic

DIOPHANTOS' MrnioDS OF SOLUTION.


coefficient' of
a;

[):}

togetlier with tlie pn.duot

ul"

the absohite term

and the
i.e.

coefficient of x^
tliis

]/>"+ mq, or in

must be a square number; but it is not," case (^)'' + 42, must be a scjuare in onh-r
which
in
tliis

that the root

may be

rational,

case

it is

not.

Case

2.
i)^

Form
.

mx^

= px +

q.

Diopliantos
2x-*

takes
1

X=

- f^

+ V iii i + tun 1
:

An example

is IV.

45, where

> Gx +

S.

Diophantos says
efficient of X,

"

To

solve this take the square of half the co-

i.e. 9,

the coefficient of
root^ of

x', i.e.

and the product of the ftbsolute term and od. Adding, we have 45, the square

which

divide

by the
is

coefficient of

of the root

half the coefficient of x and whence x < 5." Here the form given completely; and the whole operation by
is

not^

<

7.

Add
;

x"^

which Diopbantos found


Case
3.

it is

revealed.
3'

Form mx^ +

P''

'

Dioplianto.s'

root

is

17.6-^+

M-/.
17 <72x.

Cf. in V. 13 the equation already mentioned,

Diophantos says: "Multiply half the


:

coeffi-

and we have 1296 subtract the i)roduct The of the coefficient of x^ and the absolute term, or 2<S9. remainder is 1007, the square root of which is not^ > 31. Achl Divide half the coefficient of x, and the result is not > 07. by the coefficient of x^, and x is not > f f ." Here again we have
cient of

into itself

the complete solution given.


(3)

Cubic equation.

is no ground for supposing that Diophantos was acquainted with the solution of a cubic ct[uation. It is true

There
is is

there

but

it

one cubic e(piation which occurs In only a very particular case.

in

the Arithmetics,

vi.

19 the equation
says

arises,

a.'^

+ 2^ +

= a;^ +
is

3a;

3a;'^

4."

1,

and

Diophantos

simply,
1

"whence x
= coeff
of x.

found to be

All that can be said of


irX^t'os,

For "coeflicient" Diophantos uses simply


.

luiinbcr: thus

"number

of apiOfiol "
2

Diophantos
7,

calls the "square root" irXei'pd or side. though not accurate, is clearly the nearest integral limit which

will servo

the purpose.
*

As

before, the nearest intajruJ limit.

O-i

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

this is that if

we

write the equation in true Diophantine fashion,

so that all terms are positive,

x^

+ oc =

4'X^+

4.

This equation being clearly equivalent to x{x^ + l)


equation of a
a;

= 4(.r'^ + l),
by
it is

Diophantos probably detected the presence on both sides of the

common
account

factor.

The

result of dividing

= 4, which is X = J 1 no
From
far

Diophantos' solution.
is

Of the two other

roots

taken, for reasons stated above.

this single

example we have no means of judging how

Diophantos was acquainted with the solutions of equations


I pass

of a degree higher than the second.

now

to the second general division of equations.

(B.)

Indeterminate equations.

As has been already stated, Diophantos does not in his Arithmetics, as we possess them, treat of indeterminate equations of the first degree. Those examples in the First Book
which would lead to such equations are, by the arbitrary assumption of one of the required numbers as if known, converted into determinate equations. It is possible that the
treatment of indeterminate equations belonged to the missing
portion which (we have reason to believe) has been lost between
I. and II. But we cannot with certainty dispute the view that Diophantos never gave them at all. For (as Nessel-

Books

mann
object

observes) as with indeterminate quadratic equations our


is

to obtain

a rational

result, so in

indeterminate simple

equations

we seek

to find a result in ivhole numbers.


is

But the

exclusion of fractions as inadmissible results


to our author; indeed

entirely foreign

we do not

find the slightest trace that he

ever insisted on such a condition.


first

We

take therefore as our

division indeterminate equations of the second degree.

I.

Indeterminate equations of the second degree.


in

which these equations occur in Diophantos is one or two (and never more) functions of the uid<nown quantity of the form A.x^ { Bx + G are to be made
universally this
:

The form

rational

s(|iiaro

mnnbers by finding a

suitable

value

for

x.

DIOPIIANTCJS

MKTIloDS OF SOUTlnX.
two equations
ol

<).-,

Tims we have

to deal with one or

the fuini

Ax^+Bx+ C = y\
(1)

Single equation.
single equation of the form

The

Ax"

-\-

Bx

-\-

C = if

takes
r

special forms

when one

or

more

of the coefficients vanish,

are subject to particular conditions.

It will be well to give in

order the different forms as they can be identified in Dio-

phantos, and to premise that for


uses the formula laov rerpaycovcp.
1.

"=/"

Diophantos

sim})l\'

is

the case

Equations which can always be solved rationallv. when ^ or C or both vanish.

This

Form Bx = f.
number =

Diophantos puts

y^
C'f

= any
iir.

arbitrary square

nr, say therefore

x=

2x

= f,

i/

1 (I,

x=S.
and x=
T-,

Form Bx + C = f.

Diophantos puts

for

any value
x,

m'',

He

admits fractional values of


i.e.

onlv takin<f
E.x.

care that they are "rational,"


III. 7.

rational and positive.

Form Ax' + Bx = f.
of.r, -a:; whence n and the root x=0

For

i/

Diophantos puts any multiple


.,x,

Ax+B=
being
II.

the factor x disappearinf?


as
usual.

tin

neglected

Therefore

x=
Hi
2.

,^"\

,. A ir

Exx.

22, 34.

Equations whose rational solution

is

only possible under

certain condition.s.

The
>/.

cases occurring in Diophantos are

Form
(a)

Ax"^

+ C=
is

This can be lationally solved accord-

ing to Diophantos

When A

positive and a square, say


_?/*,

a'.

Thus
therefore

oV

-f

C=

In this case

?/*

is

put

= (ax

in)*

a'x'

+ C=

(ax m)^

a-

m'

96

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
sign being always

(m and the doubtful


c

assumed

so as to give

a positive value).
{/3)

When C

is

positive
y^.

and a square number, say


?/

c*.

Tlius Aa;'
therefore

+r=

Here Diophantos puts


c^

= (mx

c)

Ax^ +

= (mx

cf,

A
(7)

lit'-

When
for

one solution
found.

is

known, any number of other


is

solutions can be

This
in

enunciated in

vi.

16 tlms,

though only

the case

which

is

negative:

"when

two numbers are given such that when one is multiplied by some square, and the other is s\ibtracted from the product, the result is a square number; another square also can be found, greater than the first taken square, which will have the same effect," It is curious that Diophantos does not give a general enunciation of this proposition, inasmuch as not only is it applicable to the cases Ax^ C^ = if, but to the general
form Ax^
-\-

Bx

-\-

G = y"'.
12 Diophantos does prove that the

In the

equation Ax^
i.e.

Lemma at vi. + C = y can

be solved when

^+C

is

a square,
the

in the particular case

when the value x = l


is

satisfies

equation.
III.

But he does not always bear

this in mind, for in

12 the equation o2x^

+ 12 = y^
-f

sible of solution,

although 52

12
So,

= G4,
ill.

pronounced to be imposa square, and a rational


13, 2(j(jx^
it.

solution
to

is

therefore possible.
a;

10 =

3/*

is

said

be impossible, though

=1
a;

satisfies

It is clear that, if

satisfies

the ciiuation,

(7

is

square, and therefore this case (7) includes the previous case
It is

(/?).

interesting to observe that in VI. 15 Diophantos

states that a rational solution of the equation

Ax' -' =
is

7/

impossible unless

A is

the

sum of two

squares^.

'

Nesselmann compares

Lpj,'cmlro, Tlirorie des

Xomhrrs,

p. GO.

DIOPHANTOS
Lastly,

MI-:TH01)S Ol' SOLI TloN.

!)7

we must consider the

Form Ax^ + Bx+C = y\


This equation can be reduced by means of a change of
variable to the previous form, wanting the second term.
if

Thus

we put

x=z

the transformation gives

^- +

^A

Diophantos, however, treats this form of the equation quite


separately from the other
rational solution
(a)
is

and

less fully.

According to him the

only possible in the following cases.


is

When A

positive

aV+ Bx +

C=y"; and Diophantos puts if=

and a square, or the equation is {ax + mf, whence


Exx.
II.

2am -B'
(yQ)

20, 21 &c.

When C
-\-

is

Ax^ + Bx

c'

= y-;

positive and a square, or the ccjuation is and Diophantos writes y' = {mx + c)^ whence

Y A - m'
is

Exx.

IV. 0,

10 &c.

(7)

When
but
it

\B'^

AG
is

positive

and a square number.


possibility of this
iv. 33.

Diophantos never expressly enunciates the


case:
occurs, as it

were unawares, in

In this

problem 3

+ ^x-\-\^ a? =
To

18
y'^

a;^

to

be made a square, and the ec|uation

comes under the present form.

solve this Diophantos assumes 3a;+ 18

j;* = 4x*
do
:

which
is

leads to the quadratic 3a;

18

ox^ =

0,

and

" the equation

not rational".

Hence the assumption


[to

4a/'

will not

"and we

must seek a square


square

replace 4] such that 18 times (this

1)

(f)"''

may be

a square".

Diophantos then solves


finding

this auxiliary eciuation 18 {x"

1)

+ = if,
;,'

x=

IS.

TIr-u

he assumes

3x+l8-a,'=(18)V,
which gives 325a;^
H. D.

3a;

18

0,

whence

Jc

= -^^.
7

98
It
is

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
interesting to observe that from this example of Dio-

phantos we can obtain the reduction of this general case to the

form At? + G^ = y^, wanting the middle term.


Thus, assume with Diophantos that
therefore

Ax^+Bx-^ C = m^x^,

by solution we have

B+
^

and X

is

rational provided

~t-

AC+ Cnf

is

a square.

This

B'^

condition can be fulfilled


case.

if

- AC he a square by a previous

Even

if

that
for

is

not the case, we have to solve (putting,

for brevity,

~ AG) the equation


D+
Cm'

= f.

Hence the reduction


(2)

is effected,

by the aid of Diophantos alone.

Double-equation.
the

name "double-equation" Diophantos designates the problem of finding one value of the unknown quantity x which
will

By

numbers.

make two functions of The Greek term

it

simultaneously rational square

for the

"double-equation" occurs

variously as Bnr\ola-6T7](; or BtTrXi}


solve the equations

caorij'i.

We

have then to

mx^ + ax +
nx'-{-

a= u'\

^x + b = w')

in rational numbers.

that each of the two expressions can severally be

This

is
is

The necessary preliminary condition is made squares. always possible when the first term (in x') is wanting.
it first.

This

the simplest case, and wc shall accordingly take

DIOPHANTOS MKTIKJDS OF SOLUTION.

})0

1.

Double equation of the

first degree.

Diophautos has one

distinct

method of solving the ociuations


II'

ax +

a=

^x + b=w'
taking slightly different forms according to the nature of the
coefficients.
(a)

First

method

of solution of

^a;

+ b = wy

This method depends upon the equation

'-^J-P<I.

If the difference between the two functions can be separated


into
(

two
]
.

factors p, q, the functions themselves are equated to

Diophantos himself states his rule thus,

in

ii.

12:

"

Observing the difference between the two expressions, seek


is

two numbers whose product

equal to this ditfercncc

then

either equate the square of half the difterence of the factors to

the smaller of the expressions, or the square of half the

sum

to

the greater."

We

will take the general case,


is

and investigate
to,

what particular cases the method

applicable

from Dio-

phantos' point of view, remembering that his cases are such


that the final quadratic equation for w arising reduces always to

a simple one.

Take the equations


ax
/S./;

+ a= ii\ + i = n)\
(a

'

and subtracting we have


Let

(a
e

/8) x +

6) =

i^

w*.
+e =
7
'

a 13 = 8,

-6=

for brevity,

thou 8x

>

ui\

100

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

We
factors

have then to separate


be
,

B:c

+e

into

two

factors

let these

+p

and

\vc accordins^ly

write

p
u +
v

8x
1-

/hx

Thus

therefore

5-

SV
-\

2hxfe

{\p

+ p] +
/

fe
{

,, V =4 (ax + a). +p]


s

\p

Now
either
(1)

in order that this equation

may

reduce to a simple one,

the coefficient of x^ must vanish or 8


or

= 0,

therefore

= ^,
(2)

the absolute term must vanish.


~

Therefore

i^

=
e'

4a,

or
i.

p'

+ 2e/ +

4ap%
0.

e.

/ +2{a-h-2a)
Therefore
{p^

pi'

+ (a - 6)" =
4a6,

a + hf =

whence ah must be a square number.


Therefore either both a and h are squares, in which case

may

substitute for
:

them

c'

and d\ p being then equal

to c

we d,

or the ratio a

is

the ratio of a square to a square.

With

respect to (1)

we observe that on one condition


i.e.

it is

not necessary that S should vanish,


solving the equations,

provided

we

can, before

make

the coefficients of x' in both equal


or both

by multiplying either equation


plied by a square
is still

by a square number, an

operation which does not affect the problem, for a square multi-

a square.

DIOPHANTOS MI-yniODS OF SOLUTION.

101

Thus
satisfied
i/r
;

if
jo

=^
il

or aii^

= ^m^,

the coudition 8

will
n'

bo

by multiplying the equations respectively by


also solve the equations

and

and thus we can

like the equations


' ,v

+ = '^^l + b = w')

in

an

infinite

number

of ways.
(2),

Again the equations under

ax+ 6^= ^i^ ^x + d' = w\


can be solved in two different ways, according as we write them
in this

form or

in the

form

^c'x

c'd'

= 2U"
(T,
c*

obtained by multiplying them respectively by


that the absolute terms

in order

may

be equal.

We
(1)

now

give those of the possible cases which are found

solved in Diophantos'
of the form

own work.

These are equations

ant'x

+ a=

ii^]

a case which includes the more common one, when efficients of X in both are equal.
(2)

tiie

co-

of the form

^x + cP = 2uy
solved in two different ways according as they are thus written,
or in the alternative form,

ad\c

c'd^

u'

^c'x

+ c"d' = w

102

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
General solution of

Form

(1), or,

am
an
Multiplying respectively by
equations,
if,

nf,

we have

to

solve the

am^n^x

an^

= il^\
'

amVic + hm^ = w'^)


The
two
difiFercnce

aif

hm^.

%d

Suppose

this separated into

factors p, q.

Put

It'

p,

n T w' = q, whence
..^

(P

3)\

^r-

= (P-^)'

therefore

am'^ifx

+ an^ = 9(

or

a'm^n^x

+ hm'^= \y^
x,

Either equation will give the same value of


p^

and

X
since

q^

arf

+
2

hmf

xmSi^

yq

= arf hnf.
factors p, q
is positive.

Any
obtained

may be

chosen provided the value of x

Ex. from Diophantos.

65- G=w') G5 - 24^ = to'}


,,
.

'

2G()

therefore

Oo

...

- 24.7- = w'-) ^, 24a; = w


.

The

difference
/ 15

195

15

13 say,
24a;

therefore

- 13

C-^^)

y ^ ^^^ _ ^^^^

64, or

a;

= .

DIOPHANTOS MKTHODS OF SOLUTION.


General solution
(first

1()3

method) of Form

(2), or,

oc

+ c" =

ii'^l

^x + d'' = 2o'y
In order to solve by this method, we multiply by
respectively
rf*,

c*

and write
(xd^x

^c'x u being the greater.

+ c'dr = n") + c\V = w")

'

The

diti:

{id'

/3r) x.

Let the factors of

this

be px,

7,

therefore

ii^=(&i+lJ\\

Hence x

is

found from the equation

This equation gives

j9V + 2x (pq - 2a^) +


or,

q"

^c'd'

= 0, = 0.

since

pq =
p'x'

ad^

y8c^
q'

2x {ad'

+ /Sr ) +

^c'd'

In order that

this

may
q'

reduce to a simple equation, as

Diophantos requires, the absolute term must vanish.


Therefore

whence

- ^c\l' = q = 2cd.

0,

Thus our method


2cd,

in this case furnishes us with only one

solution of the double-equation, q being restricted to the value

and

this solution is

_2

{ad:"

+ I3c') _ Sc'ff (gff + )9c')


This method
c'
is

Ex. from Diophantos.


particular case, IV. 45, w^here stand,

only used in one

= d'
u'\
'

as the equations originally

namely

8x+-i =
(jx+4>

= iv']

104-

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
is

the difference

2x and q
,

is

necessarily taken

2>/i

4,

and

the factors are ^


therefore

4,

8a;

+ 4 = r^ +

2j

and

rr

= 11 2.
(2),

General solution (second method) of

Form

or

Here the
brevity.

difference

={ol

^) x

(c^

(T)

hx

-\-

say, for

Let the factors oi dx


(p.

e\iQ p,
(c

h
d).

Then, as before proved

100),

must be equal to

Therefore the factors are

-/3
, oj

+c+

a, c

ft,

fZ

and we have

finally

\cd
kC

d.

two.

(^^)^'^+4.f<;;/>-fo,

which equation gives two possible values for x. Thus in this case we can find by our method two values of x, since one of the
factors, p,

may be

d.
III.

Ex. from Diophantos,

17

to solve the equations

10a;

+ 9 = w'^) 5a; + 4 = 10^ +


is

'

The
value
c

difference
5,
a;

is

here 5x

5,

and Diophantos chooses as

the factors

+ l.
The

This case therefore corresponds to the


solution

+d

of jj.

given by

(i-y= lOx +

!),

whence x -

28.

DIOPHANTOS METHODS OF SOLUTION.

105

The other value


it

(Z

of

jj is

in this case excluded, because


x.

would lead to a negative value of

any number of solutions of a double-equation when one solution is known does not seem to have been noticed by Diophantos, though he uses the prinpossibility of deriving ciple in certain special cases of the single equation.

The

Fermat

was the
be done,

first,

apparently, to discover that this might always

if

the equations

one value a of x were known, by substituting in x+ a for .v. By this means it is possible to find
if

a positive solution even


cations of the principle.

is

negative, by successive appli-

But nevertheless Diophantos had certain peculiar artifices by which he could arrive at a second value. One of these
artifices

(which

is

made

necessary in one case by the unsuit-

x by the ordinary method), employed in iv. 45, gives a different way of solving a doubleequation from that which has been explained, used only in
ableness of the value found for

a special case.
(/S)

Second method of solution of a double-equation of the

first

degree.

Consider only the special case

hx + if =

u^,

{h+f)x +
Take these
magnitude, denoting them
for

n^

= iu\
and write them
in order uf
C.

expressions, and

?^^

convenience by A, B,

A = {h+f)x + n\
,,

B = hx + n\
,

G = n\

therefore

A-B = f ^^^ A-B=fx

F^

5-

(7

= 1...

Suppose now
therefore
therefore

hx +

hx

if = {}j + nf, = y~ + 2ny,


^nij),

A-B = ^(if +
f

or

^=(2/+)' + ^(2/'+2ny),
it is

thus

only necessary to

make

this expression a s(|uarc.


106

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Write therefore
(l

+ {) / +

2'^

({

1)2/
for y,

'^'

(Vy

- '')"'
for x,

whence any number of values found, by varying p.


Ex.

and therefore

can be

The only example


is

in

the Arithmetics

is

in iv. 45.

There

the additional condition in this case of a limit to the


X.

value of

The double-equation
8a;

Qx +

+ 4 = u^^ = vf
4!

has to be solved in such a manner that

x<1.

A B ~ Here ^
^
therefore

>

^^^

^^

taken to be {y
'

+ 2)^

^-5=^^^,
^ = 2^!+^^^ + ^^ + 4 + 4 = ^|-V -|^ + 4
1/

therefore

which must be made a square,


3^/^
-I-

or,

multiplying by f
square,

12t/

+9=a

where y must be <

2.

Diophantos assumes
32/^+123/

whence
and the value of

?/

+ 9 = (m2/-3r, 6w + 12
-^
.,
,

is

then determined so that

?/

<

2.

As we
this
1

find only a special case in


it

Diophantos solved by
to investigate the con-

method,

woidd be out of place


variable

Of course Diophantos uses the same


I

.r

where

have

for clearness

used y. Then, to express what

have called

in later,

he says:

"I form a square from 3 minus some number of x's and .r becomes some number multiplied by 6 together with 12 and divided by the dillerence by which the square of the number exceeds three,"

DIOPHANTOS METHODS OF SOLUTION.


ditions

1()7

under which more general cases might be solved

in this

manner \
2.

Double equation of the second degree,

or the general form


Ace'
A'x''

+ Bx + C = 2i\ + B'x + C' = w\


less

These equations are much


tos

thoroughly treated in Diophan-

than those of the

first

degree.

Only such

special instances

occur as can be easily solved by the methods which we have described for those of the first degree.
separate case must be mentioned, which cannot be from Diophantos' standpoint, by the preceding method, but which sometimes occurs and is solved by a peculiar method.
solved,

One

The form

of double-equation being
ax'

+ ax =

u']

(1), (2),

^x'+bx = w'\
Diophantos assumes

whence from

(1)

X
and by substitution
a
in (2)
\~

-2 m a

aj
a'^

+ 7n

ha

must be a

square,

+ ha{m'-a)
IS

a square.

Therefore we have to solve the equation

abm^ + a

(/9a

ah) = if,

and

this

form can or cannot be solved by processes already

given according to the nature of the coefficients^


, .

OJ+bi
^^^

Bachet and after him Cossali proved the

pos.Kibility of solving

j\ "V

this
-

method under two

conditions.

Diophantos did not apparently observe that this form of e<iualion could be

108

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Indeterminate equations of a degree liigher than the second.
(1)

II.

Single Equations.

These are properly divided by Nesselmann into two classes the first of which comprises those questions in which it is required to make a function of a; of a higher degree than the
second a square
;

the second comprises those in which a rational

value of X has to be found which will

make any

function of

cc,

not a square, but a higher power of some number.


class of

The

first

problems

is

the solution in rational numbers of

Aar + Bx""' +
the second the solution of
Ax''
for

+ Kx + L = f,
4-Kx + L = y\

+ Bx"-' +

Diophantos does not go beyond making a function of j; a Also in no instance of the first class does the index n cube.
exceed exceed
6,
3.

nor in the second class (except in a special case or two)

First class.

Equation
Ax''

5a;""'

+ Kx + L = y\
in Diophantos.
d"-

We
1.

give

now the forms found


Ax""

Equation

+ Bx^ + Cx +

= y\
for

Here we might

(the absolute

term being a square) put


in which case

y the expression mx + d, and determine of X in the resulting equation vanishes,

ni so that the coefficient

%nd =
and we obtain
giving ^ ^
in

G,

Q m=^

Diophantos' manner a simple equation for x,

_ G'-U'B
first

reduced to one of tbe

degree by dividing by x- and putting

?/

for

iu

wbich case

it

becomes
a

+ ay = u''-

p + by^w'^S'
Tbis reduction was given by Lagrange.

DIOPHANTOS METHODS OF SOLUTION.

l(j!)

Or we might put
inine

for

y an expression

mV +

H.r

(/,

and

(k-ter-

m, n so that the coefficients of x, x'' in the resultiin' equation both vanish, whence we should again have a simple equation for x. Diophantos, in the only example of this furm of equation which occurs, makes the first supposition. Thus in
VI.

20 the equation occurs,

x'-Sx' + Sx +
and Diophantos assumes
2.
?/

i/,

i]

x-

1,

whence

x=^K

Equation

Ax*

+ Bx^ +

Cx"

+ Dx + E=tf.
solved by Diophantos'
If

In order that this equation


method, either
equal to a^

may be
a square.

ox

E must be

is

a square and

we may assume

y = ax^ +
If
is

x-\- n,

determining n so

that the term in x' vanishes.

Tm?+

^x +

e,

determining

^ a square (e^ we may write m so that the term in may


a-'

vanish in the resulting equation.


obtain a simple equation for
x, in

We

shall then in either case

Diophantos' manner.

The examples
a

of this form in Diophantos are of the kind,

V + Bx^ + 6V + Dx +
=
ax^

e'

= y;
x*,

where we can assume y

+ kx

e,

determining k so that

in the resulting equation (in addition to the coefficient of

and the absolute term) the coefficient of a;', or that of vanish, after which we again have a simple equation.
Ex.
IV.

a;,

may

29

9x'

4a;'

+ -

6a;'

- 12a; + 1 = y'.
=
anda; =
U.

Here Diophantos
to

assumes y

ox"

Ga;

1,

and the equation reduces


3Ga;'

32a-'

Diophantos
pression
result.

is

guided in his choice of signs

in

the ex-

aaf+kxehy the necessity more

for obtaining a "rational"

But

far

difficult to solve are those e<[uations in

which

(the left expression being bi-quadratic) the odd powers of

arc

wanting,

i.e.

the eciuations Ax*

Cx'

E= y',

and Ax* +

A*

= y*,

"

110
even when
-<4

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
or

is

a square, or both are

so.

These cases

Diophantos treats more imperfectly.


3.

Equation
this

Ace*

Ccc''

+ E = if.
cases.

Of
which

form we find only very special

The type

is

aV-cV + e'=2/',
is

written

Here

ii is ^

assumed

to be
x.

ax or - and X
,

in either case

we

have a rational value of


Exx.
V.

30

25*^

-9 +

25

2/^

This

is

assumed

to be

equal to 25a;^
V.

31

-^ c^

- 25 +

= y"-

assumed

to

be

= -7-^

4.

Equation

Ax''^E =

if.
is
a;'*

The case occurring in Diophantos


tries

+ 97 = if.
finds

Diophantos

one assumption,
-i^,

_y

a;^

10,

and

that this gives

^=

of investigating in

which leads to no rational result. Instead however what cases this equation can be solved, he
first

simply shirks the equation and seeks by altering his original

assumptions to obtain an equation in the place of the one


found, which can be solved in rational numbers.

The
a;*

result is

that by altering his assumptions and working out the question

by

their aid he replaces the refractory equation,

+ 97 = y^,

by

the equatioQ x*
stitution
for y,
cc

+ 337 = f,

and

is

able to find a suitable sub-

solution

=
it,

'^.

namely o^ 25. This gives as the required For this case of Diophantos' characteristic

artifice of retracing his steps'

"back-reckoning,"
in the special

as Ncsscl-

mann
5.

calls

see

Appendix

v. 32.

Equation of sixth degree


a;

form

_ Ax" + Bx + c' = f.

"Methode der Zuriickrccbnung und Ncbcnaufgabe.

DIOPHANTOS METHODS OF SOLUTION.


It is only necessary to

Ill

put y

= .7/ +

c,

whence

A.r'

+ B=

2cx*

and
if

^^'^

= 7",
IS

This gives Diophantos a rational solution

a square.

G.

If

however

this last condition does not hold, as in the

case

occurring

IV.

19,

x'^

- 16^' +

a;

64

?/^

Diophantos

back-reckoning," by which he is enabled to replace this equation by .*' 128a;' + a; + 409G = y*,

employs his usual

artifice of "

which

satisfies
-j^r.

the condition, and (assuming y

= x^-\- 04) x

is

found to be

Second Class.
Ax''

Equation of the form

+ Bx''~^ +

+Kx + L = y^.
= if,
where
it is

Except

for

such simple cases as Ax^='if, Ax*

only necessary to assume

y = mx, the

only cases which occur in

Diophantos are Ax^


1.

-^

Bx-\-

C= y^,

Ax^ + Ba? +

Cx+D = if.

Equation

Ax' + Bx + C = y\

a;*

4a: + 4

There are of this form only two examples. First, in vi. 1 is to be made a cube, being at the same time already
Diophantos therefore naturally assumes
8,
;c

a square.

2=a
is

cube number, say

whence

x= 10. A
cube
to be
2.

Secondly, in vi. 19 a peculiar case occurs.

found which exceeds a square by


(a;-l)^ for the cube,
a;'

Diophantos a.ssumes
the square, obtaining

and
2a;
a;'

(a^

l)^

for

- 3a;" + 3x -

= a;^ +

+ 3,
+
a;

or the equation

= 4a;* + 4,

previously mentioned (pp. 36, 93), which is satisfied by x = 4. The question here arises: Was it accidentally or not that this

cubic took so special and easy a form?

Were a;

l,a;

assumed with the knowledge and intention of finding such an equation ? Since 27 and 25 are so near each otlier and are, as Fermat observes \ the only integral numbers which satisfy the
1

Note

to VI.

I'J.

Fermatii Opera Math.

p.

I'.i'i.

112
conditions,

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

it seems most likely that it was in view of these numbers that Diophantos hit upon-the assumptions x + 1, x1, and employed them to lead back to a known result with all the

a general proof. Had this not been so, we should probably have found, as elsewhere in the work, Diophantos first leading us on a false tack and then showing us how we can in all cases The very fact that he takes the right correct our assumptions.
air of

assumptions to begin

witli

makes us suspect that the


is

solution

is

not based upon a general principle, but


2.

empirical merely.

The equation
Ax^+Bx-' + Gx

+ D^f.
= ax+
and we

If -4 or

is

a cube

number

this equation is easy of solution.

For,

first, if

A = a^

we have only
manner

to write

-^

arrive in Diophantos'

at a simple equation.

Secondly,

if

D = d?, we

put y

C = ^^ x+

d.

If the equation is a^x^

+ Bx^ + Cx + d^ = y^, we can use

either

assumption, or put
equation.

y=ax + d,

obtaining as before a simple

he

Apparently Diophantos only used the last assumption for rejects as impossible the equation y^=8x' x^+8xl
;

because y = 2x l gives a negative value a; = ^y, whereas either of the other assumptions give rational values
(2)

Double-equation.

There are a few examples in which of two functions of x one is to be made a square, the other a cube, by one and the same rational value of x. The cases arc for the most part very simple, e.g. in vi. 21 we have to solve

4x 2x
therefore
1

+ 2=y'' + l=z''
to be
1)

?/'

^z^,

and z

is

assumed
C aud

2.

There

is

a special case in which

vanish, Ax'^ + Bx- = y'K

Here y

is

put

mx

and

x-

.,

-A

Cl'.

iv. 0, 30.

DIOPHANTOS' METHODS OF SOLUTION.

\l:\

rather more complicated case

is

vi.

23,

where we have

the double equation

of

+ 2x- + X = 2^\' = moc,


wheuce

Diophantos assumes

)j

x= ^

2
,

and we have

to solve the single equation


/

W-2)
To make 2m* a

2 .^/^^_y ^^\m^-2) "^ nT^l

^ (m-2f
cube,

= ^.
2in a cube, or put

we need only make

m = 4.

This gives for x the value f


case

The general

Ax' + Bx^+ Cx = z\
hx^

ex =y^>
difficult
;

would, of course, be

much more
X

for,

putting

i/

nix,

we

find

and we have

to solve

or

Ccm* + c(Bc- 2b C) m"

+ hc{hC-Bc) + A c' = u\
is

of which equation the above corresponding one

a very parti-

cular case.

3.

Summari/ of the preceding

investigation.

We may
1.

sum up

briefly the results of our investigation of


tiius.
first

Diophantos' methods of dealing with equations

Diophantos

solves

completely equations of the


in

degree, but takes pains beforehand to secure that the solution


shall be positive.

He

shows remarkable address


first

reducing a

number

of simultaneous equations of the

degree to a single

equation in one variable.


H. D.

114
2.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
For determinate equations of the second degree Dio-

phantos has a general method or rule of solution. He takes however in the Arithmetics no account of more than 07ie root,

even when both roots are positive rational numbers.


object
is

But

his

always to secure a solution in rational numbers, and

therefore

we need not be

surprised at his ignoring one root of a

quadratic, even though he


3.

knew

of its existence.

No

equations of a higher degree than the second are

found in the book except a particular case of a cubic.


4.

Indeterminate equations of the

first

degree are not

treated in the work as


of the second degree,
in the case

we have it, and indeterminate equations e.g. Aaf + Bx -\-G = y', are only fully treated
or

where
"

vanishes, in the

more general

cases

more
5.

imperfectly.

For

double-equations

"

of the second degree he has a

definite

method when the


;

coefficient of x^ in

both expressions
is

vanishes

this

however

is

not of quite general application, and

supplemented in one or two cases by another


application.

artifice of particular

Of more complicated
conditions

cases

we have only
for

a few

examples
method.
6.

under

favourable

solution

by his

Diophantos' treatment of indeterminate equations of

higher degrees than the second depends upon the particular


conditions of the problems, and his methods lack generality.
7.

After

all,

more wonderful than

his actual treatment of

equations are the extraordinary artifices by which he contrives


to avoid such equations as he cannot theoretically solve, e.g.
his

by

device of " Back-reckoning," instances of which, however,


in this

would have been out of place

chapter, and can only

be studied in the problems themselves.

I shall, as I said before,

4.

not attempt to class as methods

what Nesselmann has


reflection,"

tried so to describe, e.g. "Solution

by mere

"solution in general expressions," of which there

are few instances definitely described as such

by Diophantos,
It
is

and

" arbitrary

determinations and assumptions."

clear that
" is

the most that can be done to formulate these " methods

the

DIOPHANTOS METHODS OF SOLUTION.

.')

1 1

enumeration of a few instances. This is what Ncssclmann has done, and he himself regrets at the end of his chapter on "Methods of solution" that it must of necessity be so incomplete.

To understand and appreciate these

artifices of

Diophantos

it

is

necessary to read the problems themselves singly, and for these I refer to the abstract of them in the Appendix. As for the
"

Use

of the right-angled triangle," all that can be said of a


is

general character

that rational right-angled triangles (whose

sides are all rational

numbers) are alone used

in Diophantos,

and that accordingly the introduction of such a right-angled triangle is merely a convenient device to express the problem of
finding two square

numbers whose sum


for the sides of

is

also a square

number.

The general forms


c^ -f
h^,

a right-angled triangle are

a^

1>\

2ab,

which

clearly satisfy the condition

{a'

+ by={a'-b'f + {2abY.
b."
It is

The
by

expression of the sides in this form Diophantos calls "form-

ing a right-angled triangle from the numbers a and


this

time unnecessary to observe that Diophantos does not


a, b 7,
2',

use general numbers such as

but particular ones.

a right-angled triangle from


triangle whose sides are
7'^

2 "
7"

" Forming means taking a right-angled


2'^

2,

or o3, 4o, 28.

5.

Method of

Limits.

As Diophantos

often has to find a series of


:

numbers

in

ascending or descending order of magnitude


not admit negative solutions,
reject a solution
it
is

as also he does

often necessary for

him

to

which he has found by a straightforward method, in order to satisfy such conditions he is then very frequently obliged to find solutions of problems which lie within certain
;

limits in order to replace the ones rejected.


1.

very simple case

is

the following: Required to find a


x", shall lie

value of X such that some power of it,


assigned limits, given numbers.

between two
a, b.

Let the given numbers bo

Then Diophantos' method

is

Multiply a and 6 both succes.sively

by 2", 3", and so on until some (nf' power is seen which lies between the two products. Thu.s suppose c" lith between up' and /*//

62

Il6

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

then we can put

in

which case the condition


6.

is satisfied,

P
for(-|

&
Exx.
:

lies

between a and
IV.

In

34 Diopbantos

thus

he multiplies by a square, 64
is
(lo)'^

and 128; 100


hence

between f and 2 limits 80 clearly a square lying between these limits


finds a square
;

thus

we have the

Here
and
82,

or f| satisfies the condition of lying between | and 2. of course Diophantos might have multiplied by any

other square, as 16, and the limits would then have become 20

between which there

lies

the square 25, and so

we

should have f again as the square required. In VI. 23 a sixth power (a " cube-cube ")
lies

is

required which
first

between 8 and

16.
1, 64,

Now

the sixth powers of the

natural numbers are


in rule)

729, 409 6... Multiply 8

by 2 or 64 and we have as 729 lies between them therefore "^^-^^ was required. To multiply by 729 in
;

and 16 (as limits 512 and 1024, and is a sixth power such as
this case

would not give

us a result.
2.

Other problems of finding values of x agreeably to

certain limits cannot be reduced to a general rule.

By

giving,

however, a few instances,

we may

give an idea of Diophantos'


Q

methods
Ex.
lies

in general.
1,

In

IV,

26

it

is

necessary to find x so that

x'

between x and x+l. The first condition gives 8 Diophantos accordingly assumes
8

>

a;''

+x + a;^

= {x+lY = x' + x' + + Jj,


'^^

which
is

is

>x''

+ .c\

Thus x = ^

satisfies

one condition.
a;
-f-

It also

seen to satisfy the second, or -5-

+X

<

1
it

but Diophantos '


turns out to be

practically neglects this condition,


satisfied.

though

The method

is,

therefore, hero imperfect.

Ex.

2.

Find a value of x such that


x>y^x''-C)0)<l-(x'-(y()),

or

x^

60 > ox,

x^

- 60 <

'Sx.

DIOPIIANTOS' MKTIIODS

()F

SOLrTIuX.

II7

Hence, says Diophantos,


already spoken
(pp.

00,

rr is <(: 11 nor > 12. Wi- liave 91) of the reasoning by which h.-

arrives at this result (by taking only one root of the quadratic,

and taking the nearest integral limits). It is that a? 60 shall be a square. Assuming then
a;^

also required

- 60 =

{x

- mf, x =

^ 2m
lie

which must be > 11 <

12, Avhence

m'
and

+ 60 >
x''

22m, m" + 60 < 2hn, between 10 and


21.
is

(says Diophantos) in

must therefore

Accordingly he writes

- 60 = (x - 20)^ and x =

llh, which

a value of x satisfying the conditions.

6.

Method of Approximation to
come now
to a very distinctive

Limits.

method called by DioThe object of this is to find two or three square numbers whose sum is a given number, and each of which approximates as closely as possible to one and the same number and therefore to each other. This method can be best explained by giving Diophantos' two instances, in the first of which two such squares, and in the
phantos
7rapia6T7]<i or irapiaorrjro'; dywyjj.

We

second three are required.

In cases like this the principles

cannot be so well described with general symbols as with concrete numbers, whose properties are immediately obvious, and
render separate expression of conditions unnecessary.
Ex.
1.

Divide 18 into two squares each of which >


\^

6.

Take

or 6i

and

find

what small

fraction -^

added

to

it

makes
is

it

a square

thus 6^

+ -^ must be a
X

square, or 26

4-

-,

a square.

Diophantos puts
26

\_

[^+l)\

or

26/ +

=(5^+

1)',

whence

?/ J

10 and

y'

t.W. '""

!"

J-

in,'

""'

*''
*"

i^>'>

~ ^

118
square
for

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

= (f l)^

[The assumption of {oy

+
y

1)^

is

not arbitrary,
^
,

assume

26?/^

{py

+ l)^

therefore

=^ ^

and, since

- should be a small proper fraction, therefore 5

is

the most

y
suitable or p^
to

and the smallest possible value for ^^, 26


2jj

p-

being

<

Ip

>

27.]

It

is

now

necessary

(says Diophantos)

divide 13 into two squares whose sides are each

as near

as possible to |^.

Now

the sides of the two squares of which


2,

18

is

by nature

compounded are 3 and


3
2

and

is

is

> <

fi by

^1

f^ by l^i

Now
their

if

-g^,

+^

were taken as the sides of two squares

sum would be
2^^601
^^^
400
'

which

is

>

13.

Accordingly Diophantos puts


3

9a;,

ll.r,

for the sides of the required squares,

where x

is

therefore not

exactly

^ but

near

it.

Thus, assuming
(3 -9a:)'

+
x

(2

+ 11a;)' = 13,
y^. f^.

Diophantos obtains

Thus the
Ex.
is 2.

sides of the required squares are \^\,

Divide 10 into three squares such that each square

>3.

Take
to it will

^o or

3^ and find what fraction of the form


it

added

make

a square,

i.e.

make 30 +

9
-^

a square or Wy'^

1,

3 where I

DIOPHANTdS' METHODS OF SOLUTION.


Diophautos writes

Ill)

30/ +

(r)y

1)-,

whence y =

and

^*And
3^

+ ^V = a
if

square

'^'

[As before,

we assume

30//^

{py

+ 1)*,
30
;:>''

Z"'

and since - must be a small proper


or

fraction,

should

<

2y;

p^+

2jj

For

this

and 5 is the smallest reason Diophantos chooses it.]


81,

+1>

possible value of p.

We
Now
and
3,

required squares as near as

have now (says Diophantos) to make the sides of the may be to y.

10=9+l = 3^+(f)^+(|)^
4 are the sides
(3,

f,

of three squares

whose sum =

10.

Bringing

f 4) and
,

y
(f^,

to

a common denominator, wo have

^, M) and M.

Now

3is>ffbyf,

If then

we took

is<M by M. f is<Mby M3 - f^, f + f, f + fi


f

for the sides, the

sum

would be 3 (y )* or ^{f, which is > 10. Diophantos accordingly assumes as the sides of the three required squares
of their squares

Zox,

+ 37a-,
37a,f

31a-,

where x must therefore be not exactly


Solving
or
(3

^'^,

but near

it.

- rox)' +

(f +

+ (4 + 3U-)^ = 10,

10-llG.t-+3555a;'=10,
x = ^-^
;

we have

the required sides are therefore found to be

sw.
and the squares

w.

sw>

'UM^^> VW^'. "Mi^-

The two

instances here given, though only instiinces, serve

perfectly to illustrate the

method of Diophantos. To have put them generally with the use of algebniical symbols, nistead <f

120

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

concrete numbers,

duction of a large

would have rendered necessary the introof such symbols, and the number of conditions (e.g. that such and such an expression shall be a square) which it would have been necessary to express would have nullified all the advantages of this general treatment. As it only lies within my scope to explain what we actually

number

find in Diophantos' work, I shall not here introduce certain

investigations

embodied by Poselger in
Analysis," published

his article " Beitrage zur in

TJnbestimmten

the

Ahhandlungen

der Koniglichen Akademie der Wissenschaften zu Berlin

Aus dem

Jahre 1832, Berlin, 1834.


entitles

One

section of this paper Poselger

in

"Annaherungs-methoden nach Diophantus," and obtains upon Diophantos' principles \ a method of approximation to the value of a surd which will furnish the same results as the method by means of continued fractions, except that the approximation by what he calls the " Diophantine method " is quicker than the method of continued fractions, so that it may serve to
it,

expedite the latter ^

"Wenn wir den Weg des Diophantos verfolgen." "Die Diopliantisehe Mctbode kann also dazii diencn, Partialbriiche des Kettenbruchs zu beschlcunigen."
^

die

Convergcnz der

K^r.r^.

CHAPTER
1.

VI.

THE PORISMS OF DIOPIIANTOS.


(in

We

have already spoken

the Historical Introduction)

of the Porisms of Diophantos as


distinct part of the

having probably foiined a

work of our author. We also riiscussed the question as to whether the Porisms now lost formed an integral portion of the Arithmetics or whether it was a completely separate treatise.

What remains for us to do under the head of Diophantos' Porisms is to collect such references to them and such enunciations of definite porisms as are directly
If we confine our list of Porisms to those name by Diophantos, it docs not therefore

given by Diophantos.
given under that
follow that

many

other theorems enunciated, assumed or implied

in the extant work, but not distinctly called Porisms,

may

not

with equal propriety be supposed to have been actually propounded in the Ponsm^. For distinctness, however, and in
order to

make our assumptions

perfectly safe,

it

will

be better

to separate

what are actually called porisms from other theorems implied and assumed in Diophantos' problems.

I shall not First then with regard to the actual Porisms. attempt to discuss here the nature of the proposition which was called a porism, for such a discussion would be irrelevant to my purpose. The Porisms themselves too have been well

enumerated and explained by Nesselmann in his tenth chapter; also given, mth few omissions, the chief of the other theorems assumed by Diophantos as known. Of necessity, therefore, in this section and the next I shall have to cover
he has
very

much
be.

the same ground, anil shall acconliugly bo

a.s

brief us

may

122

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Porism
1.

occurs in v.

by Diopbantos bave from tbe Porisms tbat if eacb of two numbers and tbeir product wben severally added to tbe same number produce squares, the numbers are the squares This theorem is not correctly of two consecutive numbers \" enunciated, for two consecutive squares are not the only two

The

first

porism enunciated

3.

He

says "

We

numbers which
x

will satisfy the condition.

For suppose

+ a = m\
first

y + a = n^, xy+a= p^.


two equations we find

Now
and

by help of the xy

+ a= m^n^ a {m^ + n^ \)+ a^


]f.

this

is

equal to

In order that
l)-\-d^

m\^ a {m^ + n^
may be
sufficient condition is

a square certain conditions must be satisfied.

One

m^ +
or

1 = 2inn, m n = + 1,
?i"

and

this is Diopbantos* condition.

But we may

also regard

rrrn

2,8

a {m?

71"

1)

a''

= p^
we know one

as an indeterminate equation in
solution,

m
1.

of which

namely

m=n

for
{re

Other solutions are then found by substituting z m, whence we have the equation

{ii

1)

-a)z'

+2

{n' (n

l)-a{nl)}z +
(w

{ii'

- a)

{n

If
1)

- a(?r
or
{7i'

+ a'^ = p^,

a) / + 2 {n' - a)

1) ^

+ {n (n

1) - af = p\

which

is

easy to solve in Diopbantos' manner, the absolute term

being a square.

But

in the problem V. 3 tlwee

numbers are required such

that each of them, and the product of each pair, severally added
^

Kal iirel ^xoM*"

^''

'''O'S

irophixaffiv,
ttoltj

on

(of hvo

dpiO/Jiol

iKarepds re Kai 6

vir^

avTuiv /nerd rod avTov SoOivTos


KOLTk Tb ^f ijs.

Tfrpdycovov, yt-ybvaaiv dwb Svo

reTpayuvuv rwv

THE PORISMS OF DIOPHANTOS.


to a given

123

number produce

squares.

Thus,

if

the third

number
zx-\-a,

be
if

z,

three more conditions must be added, namely, z

+ ,

yz + a should be squares.

The two

last conditions are satisfied,

m + 1 = n,

by putting
z

= 2{a; + y) 1 =
xz

when

4/m" + 4??i + 1 4a, + a= {m {2m + 1) - Sa}", yz + a= {m {2m + 3) - (2a -

l)f
affected the

and

this

means of

satisfying the conditions

may have

formulating of the Porism.


V.

4 gives another case of the Porism with


"

for

+ a.

We have in the Porism 2. In V. 5 Diophantos says* Porisms that in addition to any two consecutive squares we can
,

find another

number which, being double

of the

sum

of both

and increased by 2, makes up three numbers, the product of any pair of which ^lus the sum of that pair or the third

number produces a

square,"

i.e.

m\

m^

2??i

( 7?i'

+ m + l),
of in the follow-

are three numbers which

satisfy the conditions.

The same porism


ing problem,
v. 6.

is

assumed and made use

Porism 3 occurs
enunciation
is

in v. 19.

Unfortunately the text of the


is "

corrupt, but there can

correct statement of the porism

The

be no doubt that the difference of two cubes

can be transformed into the

sum

of two cubes."

Diophantos

contents himself with the mere enunciation and does not proceed to effect the actual transformation. Thus we do not know
his

a perfectly general theorem.


Vieta, Bachet
1

he was able to prove the porism as The theorems upon the transformation of sums and differences of cubes were investigated by

method, or how

far

and Format.
(v toZs wopifffMacriv

Kal txoiJ^o

irdXi;/

on

iraai 56o Ttrpaywvoif toTj (tori t6 iint


<jvv<ifj.<t>oripov

irpo<TevplaKTai irepos dptOubs 8i a)c


apidfiodi TTOtei tSv 6

divXaaiuv

Kal SvUt.

fxtiiuiv,

t/xji

vwd

6iroiu}vo!}i>

idvTe

<> irpoffXdiir] avvan<p!)Ttpov, iatnt Xoiw-di-

TeTpd-ywvov.

124

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Vieta gives three problems on the subject
1.
^

(Zetetica iv.).

Given two cubes, to find in rational numbers two others whose sum equals the difference of the two given ones. As a solution of a^-I/ = x^ H- y^, he finds

^2.

_ a{a'-^h') a' + h'

'

y~

hj^a'ja'

If)
'

+ b'

Given two cubes,

to find in rational

numbers two

others,

+0 -X

y,

X-

^3_^,

^,_^,

3.

others,

Given two cubes, to find in rational numbers two whose difference equals the difference of the given ones;

a
In

-u -X
1 clearly

y,

X-

^3_^^3
if

y-

^^,_^^,

is

negative

2b^>a^', therefore, to secure a


for

"rational" result,

(v-j

>

2.

But

a "rational" result in 8 we

must have exactly the opposite


apparently was the
first to

condition, t5

<

2.

Fermat, who

notice this, remarked that in con-

sequence the processes


1

and 3 exactly supplement each other,


He
gets,

Poselger {Berlin Abhandhuigcn, 1832) has obtained tlicse results.

e.g. the first as follows:

Assume two cubes {a-xf, (mx-j3f, which are to sum = a3 - /33. (a-x)^ = a^-3a-x + 3ax--x\ Now
(fftx

be taken so that their

- /3)3 = - /33 + 3?/3-x -

3i''/3x2

+ m^a?.

If

then

G)'
3(TO2/3-a)

Sap'

and

THB PORlSMS OP DIOPHANTOS.


SO that

125
effect the trans-

by employing them successively we can


1,

formation of

even when

Process 2

is

always possible, therefore by the suitable com-

bination of processes the transformation of a


into a difference, or a difference of
others,
is

sum of two cubes two cubes into a sum of two


many
other propositions

always practicable.
the
Po)nsins, there

Besides

are

assumed or implied by Diophautos which are not definitely called porisms, though some of them are very similar to the
porisms just described.

2.

Theorems assumed or implied by Diophantos.


rightly distinguishes two classes, the

Of these Nesselmann
first

being of the nature of identical formulae, the second

theorems relating to the sums of two or more square numbers, &c.


1.

The

first class

do not require enumeration in

detail.

We

may mention one

or

two examples,

e.g.

that the expressions


are squares, and that

C^-)
a
{a^

- ah
-\-

and

a" (a -h 1)'

+ a' + (a + 1)"

a)

(a^

a)

is

always a cube.

Again, Nesselmann thinks that Diophantos


separation
of a'

made

use of the
v. 8, in

1/

into

factors in

the solution of

which he gives the result without clearly showing his mode though its separability into of procedure in obtaining it factors is nowhere expressly mentioned, and is not made use of
;

in certain places
it, e.g.

where we should most naturally expect

to find

in iv. 12.

are the

But ftxr more important than these identical formulae numerous propositions in the Theory of Numbers which we find stated or assumed as known in the Arithmetics. It is, in general, in explanation or extension of these that Fermat
2.

wrote his famous notes.


is

So

far as

Diophantos

is

concerned
far

it

extremely

difficult,

(jr

rather impossible, to

.say

how

these

126

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

him upon rigorous mathematical demonand how far, on the other hand, his knowledge of them was merely empirical and derived only from trial in particular cases, whereas he enunciates them or assumes them to hold in all possible cases. But the objection to assuming that Diophantos had a completely scientific system of investigating these propositions, as opposed to a merely empirical knowledge
propositions rested for
stration,

of them, on the ground that he does not prove

them

in the
o-svn

present treatise, would seem to apply equally to Fermat's

theorems set forth in these notes, except in so


to

far as

we might

be inclined to argue that Diophantos could not, in the period

which he belongs, have possessed such machinery of demon-

stration as Format.

Even supposing

this to

be true, we should

be very careful in making assertions as to what the ancients could or could not prove, when we consider how much they
did actually accomplish.
of proof,

And, secondly, as regards machinery


that up to Fermat's time there had

we have seen
little

been very
notation.

advance upon Diophantos in the matter of

It will be best to

enumerate here

in order the principal

propositions of this kind which


in each case

we

find in
is

Diophantos, observing

any

indication,

which
It

perceptible, of the extent

which we

may
to

suppose Diophantos' knowledge of the Theory of


will

Numbers

have reached.

be necessary and useful

to refer to Fermat's notes occasionally.

The question
this
is

of the merits of Fermat's notes themselves

not

the

place

to

inquire

into.

It

is

well

known

that he almost universally enunciates the theorems contained

inserting the proofs that his

and gives as his reason for not margin was too small, and so on. It is considered, however, that as his theorems are always true, he must necessarily have proved them rigorously. Concerning this statement I will only remark that in the note to v. 25 Format addresses himself to the solution of a problem which was " most difficult and had troubled him a long time," and
in these notes without proof,

Of this says that he has at last found a general solution. he gives a demonstration wliich is hopelessly wrong, and which
vitiates the solution completely.

THE PORISMS OF DIOPHANTOS.


(a)

27

Theorems in Diophantos respecting


the

the comjyosition

of

numbers as

sum of two

squares.
be resolved into two squares in

1. Any square number can any number of ivays, li. 8, 9.

2.

Any number

luhich is the

sum of two

squares can be
u. 10.

resolved into two other squares in

any number of ways,

N.B.

It is implied

throughout that the squares may be

fractional, as well as integral.


3.

sum of tiuo
The

If there are two whole numbers each of tuhich is the squares, their product can be resolved into the sum of
iii.

two squares in two ways,


object of
ill.

22.

22

is

to find four rational

right-angled
is

triangles having the

same hypotenuse.

The method

this.

Form two
viz.

right-angled triangles from

(a, b), (c, d) respectively,

a==

c'

+ b\ + d',

a'

- b\

2ab,
2cd.

c'-cr,

Multiplying
other,

all

the sides of each by the hypotenuse of the


triangles having the

we have two
{a'
(a'

same hypotenuse,
2ab{c'

+ h'){c'+d^),

{a'-b'){c'
(a'

+ b')

(c'+

cf),

+ b')

{&

+ d?l - d'),

2cd

(a^

+ d'), + b').

Two

other triangles having the same hypotenuse are got by


viz.

using the theorem enunciated,


(a'

+ )

(c'

+ d') = (ac

bdf + (ad +
bd, acl

be)',

and the triangles are formed from ac

be,

being

+ b') (c* + d'), {a' + 6") {c' + d'),


(a'

+ (rr - b') ^abcd - {a' - b')


4abcd

- d"), (c' - d'),


(c'

+ bd) {ad - be), 2 {ac - bd) {ad + be).


2 (ac

In Diophantos' case
a'

+ b' = V + = 5, d' + d'=2' + :i'=U;


2"-

and the triangles are


(65, 52, 39),

(65, 60, 2o),

(65, 63. 16),

(65,

c>i>,

33).

128
[If
fails.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
certain relations hold

between

a,

h,

c,

this

method

Diophantos has provided against them by taking two right(3, 4, 5), (5,

angled triangles viro iXax^o-Toov dptOfiwv

12, 13)].

Upon

this

problem Fermat remarks that

(1) a

prime number

of the form ^n

+1

can only be the hypotenuse of a right-angled


it

triangle in one way, the square of


(2)

in two ways,

&;c.

prime number made up of two squares be multiplied by another prime also made up of two squares, the product can be divided into two squares in two ways if the first is mulIf a
;

tiplied

by the square of the second, in three ways, &c. Now we observe that Diophantos has taken for the hypotenuse of the first two right-angled triangles the first tiuo prime numbers of the form 4n + 1, viz. 5 and 13, both of which numbers are the

sum

of two squares, and, in accordance with Format's remark,

they can each be the hypotenuse of one single right-angled It does not, of course, follow from this selection triangle only.
of 5 and 13 that Diophantos was acquainted with the theorem

that every prime number of the


squares.

But,

form 4?i + 1 is the sum of two when we remark that he multiplies 5 and 13
it is

together and observes that the product can form the hypotenuse
of a right-angled triangle in four ways,

very hard to resist

the conclusion that he was acquainted with the mathematical


facts stated in

Format's second remark on this problem.


also

For

clearly 65

is

the smallest

number which can be the hypotenuse


;

of four rational right-angled triangles


find out this fact simply

Diophantos did not


to

by
it

trijing all

numbers up

G5

on
first

the contrary he obtained

by multiplying together the

two prime numbers of the form 4?j-f- 1, in a perfectly scientific manner. This remarkable problem, then, serves to show pretty conclusively that Diophantos bad considerable knowledge of the properties of numbers which arc the sum of two squares.
4.

Still

more remarkable

is

a condition of possibility of

solution prefixed to the problem v. 12.

The

object of this
if

problem

is

"to divide 1 into two parts such that,

a given

number

is

added

to

either part, the result will be a square."


is

Unfortunately the text of the added condition

very

much

THE PDKISMS
corrupted.

(^F

Dlnl'HANTOS.
first

1l>!

words, "

no doubt, however, about the The given number must not be odd."
is

There

few

i.e. No number of the form 4/i-|- 3 [or 4 - 1] can be the sum of two squares. The text, however, of the latter half of the condition is, in

Bachet's edition, in a hopeless state, and the point cannot be


settled without a fresh consultation of the Mss.^

The

true con-

dition
be odd,

is

given by Fermat thus.


the double

"

The given number mu.st not

and

greatest square which

of it increased by one, when, divided by the measures it, mu^st not be divisible by a

pnme number

of the form 4h 1." (Note upon v. 12; also in a There is, of course, room for any number of conjectures as to what may have been Diophantos' words'.
letter to Roberval).

There would seem to be no doubt that in Diophantos' condition there was something about "double the number" (i.e. a number of the form 4n), also about "greater by unity" and "a prime number." From our data, then, it would appear that, if Diophantos did not succeed in giving the complete sufficient and
necessary condition stated by Fermat, he must at
all

events have

made a
1

close

approximation to
8r]

it.

Bachet's test has bel


fi^a. fjceL^ova

tov
.

diS6iJLevoi>
fj

n-qn irepiaaov

iXvai, firire

6 BiirXafflui'

avTov q

^r)

fxipos 5

fxerpdrai viro rot a".


/nTjre

s".

He

also says that a Vatican ms. reads

6 diirXajlujv avrov api9iJ.ov fioudSa

d. fiell^ova

^XV M^pos Tiraprov, fj neTpelrai viro tov irpwrov apiO/j-ov. Neither does Xylander help us much. He frankly tells us that he cannot
'
'

understand the jmssage.


(ut aiunt) est

Imitari statueram bonos grammaticos hoc loco,

quorum

multa nescirc.
irpocoi.opi.dfiov,

Ego vcru

noscio hoic

non multa, scd pacnc omnia.


avrov ap no
a,

Quid enim

(ut reliqua

taccam) est

/xrjTe

6 onrXaalijsv
?

&c. quae

causae liuius
*

quae processus

immo

qui processus, quae operatic,


to correct the text,

quae solutio?"

Nesselmann discusses an attempt made by Schulz


nrfre rbv 8nr\affiova avrov apiOnov

and
not

himself suggests
rpeirai vir6

/xovdSi fitl^ova fx^iv, 6s fie-

rivoi irpurov api.6y.ov.

But

this ignores /i^pos riraprov

and

is

satisfactory.

Haukel, however (Gesch.d. Math. p. 169), says: "Ich zweifele nicht, dass die von den Msscr. arg entstellte Determination so zu lesen ist: Sei Si) rbv 5iW/i*ror
Urire ntpicabv ehai,
iino
/J-rire

rov dnrXacrlova ai/Tou apiOnbv

fjLovdSi

fitl^ova fitrptiadcu

d ixd^uv IxV t'-^po^ TirapTov." Now this correction, which exactly gives Fermat's condition, seems a decidedly probable one. Here the words p.ipos rirapTov find a place; and, secondly, the rept'tition of tov for tov is of course natural liovaSi d nd^uv might well confuse a copyist, enough Nesselmann reads nvos for tov.
TOV
irpil)Tov apid/iov, 8s aj' /louadi
;

H.

I).

130

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

We
number
and

thus see (a) that Diophantos certainly


of the form
4??.

knew
of

3 could be the

sum

that no two squares,

(b) that he had, at least, advanced a considerable way towards the discovery of the true condition of this problem, as

quoted above from Fermat.

(6)

On numbers
v.

luhich are the

sum of three
is

squares.

In the problem
unity

14 a condition

stated by Diophantos

respecting the form of a

clearly

makes each of 3a + 1 must be divisible into three Respecting the number a Diophantos
2."
i.

number which added to three parts of them a square. If a be this number,


squares.

says "It

must not be

2 or any multiple of 8 increased by


e.

squares.

a number of the form 24>i + 7 cannot be the sum of three Now the factor 3 of 24 is irrelevant here, for with respect to three this number is of the form 3w + 1, and this so
far as

is

concerned might be a square or the

sum
3 in

of

two or

three squares.

Hence we may neglect the


credit

factor

24/i.

We

must therefore

Diophantos with the knowledge of

the fact that no number of the


three squares.

form 8n + 7 can

be the

sum of

This condition

is

true,

but does not include

all

the

numbers

which cannot be the sum of three squares, for it is not true that all numbers which are not of the form 871 + 7 are made up Even Bachet remarked that the number a of three squares. might not be of the form 32?i -)- 9, or a number of the form
9G>i+ 28 cannot be the sum of three squares. Fermat gives the conditions to which a must be subject
thus:

Write down two geometrical

series

(common
1024 8192

ratio of each 4),


1, 8,

the hrst and second series beginning respectively with

14
8

16

32

128

C4 512

256 2048

4096 32768

then a must not bo (1) any number obtained by taking twice liny term of tlu' ii[)per scries ami adding all the preceding terms,

THE PORISMS OF DIOPHAN'TOS.


or (2) the

l.'H

number found by adding

to the

numbers

so obtained
series.

any multiple of the correspondino: term of the second Thus (a) must not be,

+ 2.1 + 2.4 + 1 128n + 2.1G + 4<+ ol2n + 2.64 + 16 +


8?i

8"

2,

32/1

= 32 + 9, =128n + 87, = 512n + 149,


which, though

&c.

Again there are other problems,

e.g. v. 22, in

conditions are necessary for the possibility of solution, none are

mentioned; but suitable assumptions are tacitly made, without by which they must be guided. It does not follow from the omission to state such rules that Diophantos was ignorant
rules

of even the minutest points connected with

them

as

however

we have no

definite statements,

it is

best to desist from specula-

tion in cases of doubt.

(c)

Goinposition of naniberti an the


is either

sum offour
the

squares.

Every number
four squares.

a square or

sum of

two, three or

This Avell-known theorem, enunciated by Format

in his note to Diophantos iv. 31, shows at once that

any number

can be divided into four squares either integral or fractional,

number can be divided into two other squares, We have now to look for indications in the Arithmetics as to how far Diophantos was acquainted with the properties of numbers as the sum of four squares. Unsince any square

integral or fractional.

fortunately

it

is

impossible to decide this question with any-

There are three problems [iv. 31, 32 and which it is required to divide a number into four squares, and from the absence of mention of any condition to which the number must conform, considering that in both cases where a number is to be divided into three or two Sipiares [v. 14
thing like certainty.
V. 17]

in

and 12] he does

state a condition,

we should probably be

right

in inferring that

Diophantos was aware, at

least empirically, if

not scientifically, that any number could be divided into four


squares.
it

would be rash

That he was able to prove the theorem scientifically But wc not impossible. to assert, though it
i.s

92

132

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
at least be certain that
it

may

Diophantos came as near to the


all

proof of
to 120

as did Bachet,
finds

who takes
that
all

the natural numbers up


actually be ex-

and

by

trial

of

them can

pressed as squares, or as the


in

whole numbers.

sum of two, three or four squares So much we may be sure that Diophantos
it is

could do, and hence he might have empirically satisfied himself


that in any case occurring in practice
possible to divide

any number into four squares, integral or fractional, even if he could not give a rigorous mathematical demonstration of the general theorem. Here again we must be content, at least in our present state of knowledge of Greek mathematics, to remain
in doubt.

CHAPTER

VII.

HOW FAR WAS DIOPHANTOS


1.

ORIGINAL

none

is

Of the many vexed questions relating to Diophantos more difficult to pronounce upon than that which we
Here, as in so

propose to discuss in the present chapter.

many
ca.se.

other cases, diametrically opposite views have been taken by authorities equally capable of judging as to the merits of the

Diophantos "optimum praeclarissiniumque Logisticae parentem," though possibly he means no more by this

Thus Bachet

calls

he was the first algebraist of "T abate Andres" as the most thoroughgoing upholder of the originality of Diophantos. M. Tannery, however, whom we have before had occasion to men-

than what he afterwards

says, "that

whom we

know."

Cossali quotes

tion, takes

a completely opposite view, being entirely unwilling

to credit Diophantos with being anything

compiler.

more than a learned Views intermediate between these extremes are those of Nicholas Saunderson, Cossali, Colebrooke and Nesselmann; and we shall find that, so far as we are able to judge
us,

from the data before


good.
is

Saunderson's estimate

is

singularly

He
first

the

says in his Elements of Algebra (1740), "Diophantos writer on Algebra we meet with among the ancients
is

not that the invention of the art


to him, for he has

particularly to be ascribed
rules

nowhere taught the fundamental


it

and

principles of Algebra; he treats

everywhere as an art already

known, and seems to intend, not so much to teach, as to cultivate and improve it, by applying it to certain indeterminate problems concerning square and cube numbers, right-angled triangles, &c., which till that time seemed to have been either not at all considered, or at least not regularly treateil cf. These

134

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
j^et

problems are very curious and ratertaining; but


resolution
of

in the

them

there frequently occur difficulties, which

nothing

less

than the nicest and moc^ refined Algebra, applied


skill

with the utmost

most certain

it is

that, in this way,

and judgment, could ever surmount: and no man ever extended the

limits of analytic art further than Diophantos has done, or dis-

covered greater penetration and judgment; whether we consider


his wonderful sagacity

and peculiar

artifice

in

forming such

proper positions as the nature of the questions under consideraing upon them.

more than ordinary subtilty of his reasonEvery particular problem puts us upon a new way of thinking, and furnishes a fresh vein of analytical treasure,
tion required, or the
is

which, considering the vast variety there

of them, cannot but

be very instructive to the mind in conducting itself through almost all difficulties of this kind, wherever they occur."
2.

We

will

now, without anticipating our results further,

proceed to consider the arguments for and against Diophantos'


originality.

But

first

we may

dispose of the supposition that

Greek algebra may have been derived from Arabia. This is rendered inconceivable by what we know of the state of learning Algebra cannot have been in Ai'abia at different periods. developed in Arabia at the time when Diophantos wrote
the claim of

Mohammed

ibn

Musa
if

to

be considered the
first,
is

first

important Arabian algebraist,


parently not disputed.
that

not actually the

ap-

On

the other hand Rodet has shown


largely

M(jhammed ibn Musii was


is
;

indebted to Greece.

moreover great dissimilarity between Greek and Indian algebra this would seem to indicate that the two were evolved

There

independently.

We may We

also here dispose of Bombelli's strange

statement that he found

that Diophantos very often quoted

Indian authors \
therefore

do not find in Diophantos, as we have

him, a single reference to any Indian author whatever.


is

There
suppose

some

difficulty in

understanding Bombelli's positive

statement.

It is at first sight a

tempting hypothesis

to

that the "frequent quotations" occurred in parts of Diophantos'


^

"Ed
lu

in detta opera

abbiamo

ritrovato, ch' egli assai volte cita gli autori

indiani, col cho rui lia fatto conoscere, che questa disciplina

appo

gl'

indiani

prima

che

agli arabi."

HOW FAR WAS DIOPHANTOS ORIGINAL?


work contained only
in the MS.

135

know

which Bombclli used. But wo is mentioned in that MS. We can only explain the remark by supposing that Bombelli confused the text and the scholia of Maximus Planudes for in
that not a single Indian author
;

the latter mention


tion."

method of multiplicaSuch must be considered the meagre foundation for


is
is

made

of an " Indian

Bombelli's statement.

There
indebted,
3.

not, then, mucli

doubt

that, if

we

are to find any

writers on algebra earlier than Diophantos to

whom he was

present

we must seek for them among his own countrymen. Let us now consider the indications bearing upon the question which are to be found in Diophantos' own work.
two references
to Hypsikles

Distinct allusions to previous writers there are none with the


sole exception of the

which occur

in the

fragment on Polygonal Numbers.

These references, how-

ever, are of little or

Diophantos' originality;

no importance as affecting the question of for, so far as they show anything, they
far in

show that Diophantos was


of the progress which

advance of Hypsikles

in his

treatment of polygonal numbers.

And,

so far as

we can judge
of

had been made

in their theoretical treat-

ment by

writers anterior to Diophantos from

what we know

such arithmeticians as Nikomachos and Theon of Smyrna, we must conclude that (even if we assume that the missing part of
Diophantos' tract on this subject was insignificant as compared

with the portion which has survived) Diophantos made a great


step in advance of his predecessors.

with polygonal numbers

is

new

His method of dealing and we look in vain among

his precursors for equally general propositions with regard to

such numbers or for equally


perties.

scientific proofs of known proNot that previous arithmeticians were uuaccjuaiuted

with Diophantos' propositions as applied to particular jwlygonal numbers, and even as applicable generally but of their general application they convinced themselves only empirically, and by
;

the successive evolution of higher and higher orders of

sucli

numbers.

We may here remark, with respect to the term "arithmetic" which Diophantos applies to his whole work, that he is making According to the previously ucc.-jt.-<l a new use of the term.

136

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
and XoytariKT] the former
treats of the

distinction of apLdfiijriKi]

abstract properties of numbers,

considered apart from

their

mutual

relations, XoyiaTCKi] of

problems involving the relations

of concrete numbers.

XoyiartKi], then, includes algebra.

Acon

cording to the distinction previously in vogue the term dpidfiTjTiKi]

would properly apply only to Diophantos'


;

tract

Polygonal Numbers

but, as in the six books of Diophantos the

numbers are treated as abstract, he drops the distinction. Next to direct references to the names of predecessors, 4. we must look to the language of Diophantos, in order to see whether there is any implication that anything which he teaches And in this regard we might naturally expect that is new. the preface or dedication to Dionysios would be important. It Trjv evpeaiv rwv iv Toh dpi6p.ol<i irpo^X'qiicnoiv, is as follows
:

TifiicoTari fioL Aiovvcrte, jivooaKcov ere a7rovSai(o<; e')(0VTa ixadeiv,

opyavajcrat rrjv fieOoSov 7reipd6r)v, dp^(i/jipo<i d(f

wv

crvi'iaTrjKe

rd Trpdy/jiaTa
eVeiS?) iMrjTTW

Oefxekicov, v7roar7]aai Tt)v iv Tol<i


Laa)<i

dpi6fioL<;

<pvaiv

re Kol hvvafJiLV.

fiev

ovv hoKel to Trpdyfjba Sva-^^^epearepov,

yvwptyiov iari, hvaekinaTOL yap et? KaropOuxxLV


-v^up^ai,

elaiv al

rwv

dp'^^ofjiiicov

o/iw?

8'

evKardXTjTrrov aoc jevt]-

aerat Btd
fydp
et9

rrjv arjv

irpodvp.Cav koI Tr)v e^rjv dirohet^Lv' ra^eta

fx,d6r](rLV

eTriOufiia

irpoaXa^ovaa

ScSa^yjv.
it

The

first

expression which would seem to carry with

an indication of
is

the nature of the work as conceived by Diophantos himself


opyavwxrat
rrjv fiedoSov.

The word opyavwaat has

of itself

been

the Arithmetics were originaP.

some that the whole matter and method of Cossali and Colebrooke are of opinion that the language of the preface implies that some part But Montucla of what Diophantos is about to teach is new".
enough
to convince
1

Cf. the

view of " 1' abate Andres " as stated by Cossali: "Diofanto stesso
d' essere stata

parla in guisa, che sembra mostrare assai cLiaramente

sua iuven-

zione la dottrina da lui proposta, e spiegata nulla sua opera."


"

"A me

par troppo
il

il

dire,

che da quelle cspressioni non ne esca alcuu

lume; mi pare troppo

restingcre la novita, che annunziano, al metodo, che nell'


si

opera di Diofanto regnas

mira

ma

parmi anche troppo


of

il

dedurne essere state


is

Diofanto in assoluto sonso inventor

dell' analisi."

Cossali.

"He
Tffwj

certainly intimates that

some part

what he proposes to teach

new:

fxh oiV doKel rd irpayfia 5v<TXf p^<rTepoi'

iireiSri firiiru) yvdpi/xoi'

iari: while in

other places (Def. 10) he expects the student to be previously exercised in the

HOW FAR WAS DIOPHANTOS ORIGINAL


does not go too far us any chie.
" fabricari,"

137

when he

says that the preface does not give


is

The word

op-^avwaai

translated by Bachet as

It means " to set forth and such an expression may perfectly well apply if there were absolutely nothing new in the work, and Di(iphantos were merely writing a text-book simply giving in a compact and systematic form the sum and substance
right.

but this can hardly be

in order", to "systematise";

of previous labours.

The words

eVetS?}

/u,7;7r&)

^vwpiixov iariv

have also been made use of by advocates of Diophantos' claim to originality; but, looked at closely, they clearly imply no

more than that the methods were unknown to Dionysios. The is subjective, as is shown by the following words, SuaiXTTicTTOC yap eh Karopdcocriv eicriv al twv dp^^^ofievav ylrv^ai. The language of the definitions also has been variously understood. "L' abate Andres" concluded from their very
phrase
presence
at

the beginning of the book

that
if

Diophantos

is

minutely explaining preliminary matter as


of a

he were speaking

new

science as yet

unknown

to others.

But the
;

fact

is

that he does not minutely explain preliminary matter

he gives

an extremely curt summary of the necessary preliminaries.

Moreover he makes no stipulations as to what he


call

will choose to
8vvafii<i
is
?*.

by a certain name.

Thus a square KaXelrai


called
dpidfio'i,

the

unknown quantity
Xeiyfri^

is

and

its

sign

Again, he says
virap^iv,

iirt

Xel^jrtv
hij

TroXXaTrXaaiaadelcra
(jives j)lus^.

Troiei

Minus multiplied

minus

In the 10th
tlic

algorithm of Algebra.

The seeming

contradiction

is

reconciled by conceiving

known, but the application of thorn to a certain class of problems concerning numbers to have been new." Ci'lebrooke. I adhere to this translation of the Greek because, tiiough not quite literal, It is it serves to convey the meaning intended better than any other version.
principles to have been

not easy to translate


p. 108), says that
it

it literally.

Mr James Gow

(History of Creek Mnthemntict,

a difference makes an addition."

"A difference multiplied by This translation seems unfortunate, because Xc^jj and (1) it is difficult, if not impossible, to attach any meaning to it, (2) If vvap^is are correlatives, whereas "difference" and "addition" are not. either of these words are used at all, we shoidd surely say either "A dillerenco by multiplietl a multiplied by a diffirence makes a sum", or "A subtraction
should properly be translated
subtraction

makes an addition."

The

true

meaning

of Xer^ii

must be

" a falling-

short" or
If,

"a wanting", and

that of i-Vapfis

"a presence"

or

therefore, a literal translation is desired, I

would suggest

"a forthcoming". " A wanting multi-

138

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

how important it is that the beginner should be familiar with the operations of Addition, Subtraction, &c.; and in the 11th Definition the rules for reducing a quadratic to
Definition he says
its

simplest form are given in a dogmatic authoritative manner which would only be appropriate if the operation were generally
:

known

in fine, the definitions, in so far as they

have any bear-

ing on the present question, seem to show that Diophantos does not wish
it

to

be understood that they contain anything new.

He

gives

ciples,

them as a short but necessary resume of known prinmore for the puriDose of a reminder than as laying any
that Diophantos invented algebra
is,

new foundation. To assert, then,


the
least,

to say

an exaggeration, as we can even now see from the


it is

indications above mentioned. His notation, so far as


tion, is

a nota-

apparently

new

but, as

it
it

is

merely in the nature of

abbreviations for complete words,

cannot be said to constitute

any great advance in algebra. I may here mention a curious theory propounded by 5. Wallis, that algebra was not a late invention at all, but that it

was

in

common

use by the Greeks from the time of their earliest

discoveries in the field of geometry, that in fact they disco-

vered their geometrical theorems by algebra, but were extremely


careful to conceal the fact.

But

to believe that the gi'eat


is

Greek

geometers were capable of this sj^stematic imposition


possible\

scarcely

makes a forthcoming". But, thongb this would be correct, by obscurity more than it gains by accuracy. 1 "De Algebra, prout apud Euclideu Pappum Diophantum et scriptores habetur. Mihi quidem extra omne dubium est, veteribus cognitam fuisse et usu comprobatam istiusmodi artcm aliquam Investigaudi, qualis est ea quam nos Algebram dicinius Indequc derivatas esse quae apud cos conspiciuntur
plied by a wanting
it

loses

prolixiores et intricatae

Demonstrationcs.

Aliosque ex recentioribus

mecum

bae

in

re

sen tire comperio. ...Hanc autem artem Investigaudi Veteres occu-

luerunt sedulo: contenti, per demonstrationes Ajjagogicas (ad absurdum seu


impossibile ducentcs
si

quod assorunt negetur) asscnsum cogere; potins quam


illae

directum methodum indicare, qua fuerint inventae propositiones


aliter et

quas

ipsi

per ambages demonstrant."


is

(Wallis, Opera, Vol.

ii.)

Bossut

certainly right in bis criticism of this theory.

"Si

cette opinion

6tait vraic, elle inculperait cch

grands

hommes
Or,

d'unc charlatancrie systc^matique

et traditionolle, ce qui est invraiscmblable en soi-nieme et

ne pourrait Stre admis


telle

sans les preuves

les

plus rvidentes.

sur quoi

une

opinion cst-elle

HOW FAR WAS DIOPHANTOS ORIGINAL?


6.

139

be said may, perhaps, be best arranged under the principal of Diophantos' methods as headings and it
to
;

What remains

be advisable to take them in order, and consider in each case whether anything is anticipated by Greek authors whose works we know. For it would seem useless to speculate on
will

If we once leave the safe what they might have written. ground of positive proveable fact, such an investigation as the It is this fact which present could lead to no useful result.

makes so much of what M. Tannery has written on this stibject seem unsatisfactory. He states that Diophantos was no more
than a learned compiler, like Pappos though it may be observed that this is a comparison by no means discreditable to
:

the former
plete

he does not think it necessary to explain the comwant of any other works on the same subject previous to
;

Diophantos.

The

scarcity of information
is

respecting similar

previous labours, says M. Tannery,

easily explicable on other

grounds which do not concern us here\ The nature of the work joined to what we know of Diophantos would seem to
prove his statement, thinks M. Tannery
;

thus the work

is

very

unequal, some operations being even clumsy*.


likely to

But we

are not

is any evidence against what great genius always equalled himself? Certainly, if we cannot find any certain traces of anticipation of Diuphantos by his predecessors, he is entitled to the benefit of any doubt. Besides, given that Diophantos was not the in-

admit that inequality in a work


;

originality

for

ventor of any considerable portion of his science, the merit of


it known and arranged it scientifically is little less than that of the discoverer of the whole, and very much greater

having made

than that of the discoverer of a small fraction of


First with regard to the use of the
fondce?

it.

unknown quantity by

Sur quelques anciennes propositions, tirc^es principaleraent du treioti Ton a cru reconnaitre I'alK^bre, mais qui ne siipposont r^ellement que I'analyse gtom^trique, dans laquelle les anciens C-taient fort exerII parait certain que Ics (Jroca n'ont commcuc<5 ccs, commc je I'ai d6ja marqu6. a connaitre I'alt^ubre qu'au temps de Diophante." (Ilistoire Gin(rale tUn Math/ziiSme livre d'Euclide, viatiques par Charles Bossut, Paris, 1810.)

The

truth of the last sentence

is

not

so clear.
'

lluUrtin
Ibid.

(ipx

Srifiirfx miithi'mnl'ujnex ct dgtronomiqnt's, 1870, p. 261.

140
Diophaiitos.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
There
is

apparently no indication that


it

dpidfi6<i, in

by Diophantos, was employed by any other extant writer without an epithet to mark the use, and certainly Bvvafii<; as restricted to the square of the
the restricted sense appropriated to

unknown

is

Diophautine.

But the employment


it

of an

unknown
is,

quantity and calculations in terms of


phantos' time.

are found before Dio-

To

find a thing in general expressions


it

with

Diophantos, to find

iv dopiaro).

Cf.

the problem IV. 20.

But the same word


his

is

used in the same sense by Thymaridas in

Epanthema. We know of him only through lamblichos, but he probably belongs to the same period as Theon of Smyrna. Not only does Thymaridas distinguish between numbers which are wpiafMevoL (known) and doptaroc (unknown), but the Epanthema gives a rule
equations of the
for solving
first

a particular set of simultaneous

degree with any number of variables.


is

The

artifice

employed

the same as in

i.

16, 17, of Diophantos.

This account which lamblichos gives of the Epanthema of Thy-

maridas

is

important
is

for the history of algebra.

For the essence

of algebra

present here as

much

as in Diophantos, the " nota-

him showing only a very slight advance. Thus we have here another proof, if one were needed, that
tion" employed by

Diophantos did not invent algebra. Diophantos was acquainted with the solution of a mixed or
complete quadratic.
This solution he promises in the 11th
But, as
Definition to explain later on.

we have

before remarked,

the promised exposition never comes, at least in the part of his

work which we
in a

pos.se.ss.

He

shows, however, sufficiently plainly

number

of problems the exact rule which he followed in

the solution of such equations.

The

question therefore arises


his

Did Diophantos himself discover and formulate


or

purely

arithmetical rule for solving complete determinate quadratics,

was the method

in use before his

time

Cossali points out

that the propositions 58, 59, 84 and 85 of Euclid's BeSofieva


give in a geometrical form the solution of the equations

ax x^=
It

b,

ax
to

-i

x'

= b, and

of

" xy

A
b)

was only necessary

transform the geometry into algebra, in

HOW FAR WAS DIOPHANTOS


order to obtain Diophantos' rule
;

ORIGINAL?

141

and this might have been done by some mathematician intermediate between Euclid and Diophantos, or by Diophantos himself. It is quite possible that

it

may have been


is

in this
is

manner that the

rule arose; and, if

that
to

the case,

it

probable that the transformatii^n referred


later

was accomplished by some matliematician not much

than

Euclid himself; for Heron of Alexandria {circa 100

R.C.)

already

used a similar rule\

We

hear moreover of a work on quadratic

equations by Hipparchos (probably ciixa IGl

126

B.C.)*.

Thus

we may conclude
7.

that Diophantos' rule for solving complete

quadratics was not his discovery.

But

it is

not upon Diophantos' solution of determinate


;

equations that the supporters of his claim to originality rely


it is

rather that part of his work which forms

its

main

subject,

namely, Indeterminate or Semi-determinate Analysis.


ingly
it is

Accord-

term Diophantine analysis is applied. We should therefore look more especially for anticipations of Diophantine analysis, if we would be in a position to judge as to
to that that the

Diophantos' originality.
Pythagoras.

The foundation of semi-determinate analysis was laid by Not only did he propound the geometrical theorem
is

that in a right-angled triangle the square on the hypotenuse

equal to the
applied
it

sum

of the squares on the other two sides, but he


rule

to

numbers and gave a


true

application,

it is

of somewhat
number
if

narrow
His

for finding

an

infinite

of right-

angled triangles
rule,

whose

sides are all

rational

numbers.

expressed

in algebraical

form, asserts that

there are

three

numbers

of the form 2m'^

- 2wi

-t-

1,

2m^

2/n,

and

1m

1,

they form a right-angled triangle.


unity,

This rule applies clearly to

that particular case only in which two of the numbers differ by


i.e.

that particular case of Diophantos' general form for

a right-angled triangle (m* -^-n^ w'

n"",

2mn)

in

which in-ii = l.
a

But Pythagoras'

rule

is

an attempt
II.

to deal

with the general


f.ir

problem of Diophantos,

8, 9.

Plato gives another form


\va.><

The Cf. Cantor, pp. 341, 342. more than a matter of arithmetical making both sides complete squares.
2

solution of a quailratio
calcnlation.

Heron no He solved such e<iuationH by


for

Cf.

Cantor, p. 313.

142

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
namely (w^ + 1, m^l,
29
is
2;/i),

rational right-angled triangle,


is

which

that particular case of the form used by Diophantos in which


Euclid,
9,

71=1.
II. 8,

Book

x. prop.

the same problem as Dioph.

Diophantos improving upon Euclid's solution. In compargeometry:

ing,

however, Euclid's arithmetic with that of Diophantos we


is still

should remember that with Euclid arithmetic

a fact which accounts for his marvellously-developed doctrine of


irrational

and incommensurable numbers.


is

In Diophantos the
severed, and irrational
his work.

connection with arithmetic and geometry

numbers are studiously avoided throughout


There
is

another certain case of the solution of an indeter-

minate equation of the second degree in rational numbers before Diophantos. Theon of Smyrna, in his work Twv Kara fiaOrjfiaTLKTjv
'^(^p'rjcrl/xcov

et9 r})v

rov TI\dTcovo<i dvayvcoaLv

[sc.

expositio,

say the editors], gives a theorem Trepl irXsvpiKoov Kal Sia/xerpiKcov


dpLd/xoov.

From

this

theorem we derive immediately any number

of solutions of the equations

provided that
either.

we can find, by trial or otherwise, one solution of Theon does not make this application of his theorem he solved a somewhat important problem of the second degree There is an in indeterminate analysis without knowing it.
:

Proclus,

to the doctrine of Side- and Diagonal-numbers in Comment, on Euclid iv. p. 111. Such are the data upon which Nesselmann founded his 8. view as to the originality of our author. But M. Tannery has tried to show, by reference to a famous problem, that still more difficult questions in indeterminate analysis had been propounded

allusion

name

before the time of Diophantos. of the " Cattle-problem "

This problem
;

is

known by
is

the

it is

an epigram, and

com-

monly attributed to Archimedes. It was discovered by Lessing, and his discussion of it may be found in Zur Geschichte und
Litteratur (Braunschweig, 1773),
p.

421 seqq.

have quoted

it

below according to the text given by Lessing'.


1

The

title

does
this

have unfortunately not been able to consult


J.

llic critical

Wdik on

epigram by Dr

Struvc anil Dr K. L. Stiuvc, father and son (Altona, 1H21).

HOW FAR WAS DIOPHANTOS


two divisions into which

ORIGINAL?

143

not actually imply that Archimetles was the author.


it falls

Of the

the second leads to an induterLessinR's

My

information about

it is

derived at second-hand from Nesselmann.


it

text can hardly be perfect, but

seems better to give

it

as

it is

without emen-

dation.

nPOBAHMA
oirep

'APXIMHAH2

iv ^Trtypd/jL/j.affiv

fvpwv
t'tfTeiv

TOiS iv 'AXe^avdpeigi wepl

ravra Trpayp-aTov/idfoi^

aTricTciXtv

if TTJ TTpbs "RpaToaOivrjv rhv Kvprivaiov


eTn(7To\fj.
nXijdiii' ijeXloio (SoCoi>,
<f>povTlb' eiricrTrjcras,
iroffffij

^eive,

pArp-qffov,
ffO(pir]s,

el

/xer^x^'J

dp' iv ireStois HiKeXrjs ttot' (^6ffKeTo vrjffov

Qpivad-qs, rerpaxv (rri^ea Saffffafi^v-q

Xpo^V" oXXaaaovra'

t6 iih XevKoio yaXaKTos,

Kvav4(i> 8' irepov xpw/toTt Xa/iirdfievov,

dXXoye

/xiv

^avObf, t6 di iroiKlXoy.

'Ev 5e eKaartf)

aricpet i<rav ravpoi Tr\i}de<yL ^pidbiievoL,


av/x/jLeTpi-qs TOLTJade

TerenxoTer dpydrpixas
rjdi
rplrif),

fxiv

Kvaviuv Taupojv
Kal ^av^ots

r]/j.icrL

(T6/jLTra(Tiv

taovs,

^eive,

vb-qaov.

Avrdp Kvaviovs t^ rerpdrip


/MiKTOXpbuv Kal
ir^/XTTTif),

fiipei

?Tt ^avdo'ial re iraji.

Toys

5'

viroXeiiro/xifOis iroiKiXbxjx^o.^ adpei


p-epei,

dpyfvvCiv ravpwv ^KTip

f^So/udrtf. re

Kal ^avOoh avrous irdcriv laa^op.ivovs. OrfXeiaiai Si


r)(Tav
rtfi

j3ov<Ti

rdo' ^TrXero"

XevKorpixfS

p-fv

ffvpLirdffrjs

Kvavirfs dyeXtjs
Iffat.

TpiTdT(f re fiipei Kal TTpdT(f} drptKis


t<J)

A&rip Kvdveai
/UKTOXpowu Kal
<Ti>v

Tirpdri^j re
6/j.ov

waXiv
pJpei Iffd^ovro

irifiirrifi

TaipoLS

irda'r)%

eh

vofiov ipxop^vris.
fi^pei
rjoi

Savdorpix^^y dyeXijs W/urrT(f>

Kai

<\T<f)

iroiKiXai ia-dpiOp-of ttXtjOos Ix^"-

'^^'''P^-XTI

^avdal

o'

7]pid/xiOvTo p-ipovi rpiTov rjpxaei. laon

dpyevprjs dyiXrjs e^oonaTi^ re fxipei.

SeTve,
X^^pls

tri)

5'

ijeXioio /So'ej iroaai

drpeKh elirwv

M^f raijpuv ^aTpe(piui> dpiOp-bv, Xwpis 5' oB drjXeiai Saai Kari xpoidv iKacTai,
oiiK

d'idpb Ke Xiyoi,
pirjv

oi)5'

dpi0p.Qv dSa^i,

oil

iribye <TO<po7s iv dpiOfioiV

ctW

tdi (ppd^ev

Kal TaSe irdvra

^bwv

ijeXloio iradij,

'Apyorpixes ravpoi
Kvav^ois taravT

fiiv iirel

m^alaro
av

wXijOC'v

ffiireSov laofxerpoi

eh ^dOoi eh evpo^
^afdoi
av

re'

rd

5'

irepifxriKea

xdyryj

wl/jLirXavTO tXivOov QpivaKt-qt TreSi'o.


o' r'

eh

ff Kai Troi/nXoi

dOpoiaOimtf

144

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

minate equation of the second degree. In view of this fact it is important for us to discuss briefly the matter and probable date Struve does not admit that it can pretend to of this epigram.
that antiquity which
is

claimed for

it

in the title.

This
it

we

may

allow without going so far as Kliigel,

who makes

as late

as the introduction of the present decimal system of numeration.

Nesselmann's view
the author
(if

is

that the heterogeneous conditions, which

show that due to one author) could have had no idea how to solve it. Nesselmann is of opinion that the editors of the anthology were justified in refusing a place to this epigram, that the most one could do would be to admit the first part and condemn the latter part as corrupt, and that we might fairly regard the whole as unauthentic because even the The first first part could not belong to the age of Archimedes. part, which falls into two divisions, gives seven equations of the first degree for determining eight unknown quantities, namely the number of bulls and cows of each of four colours. The solution of the first part gives, if {X YZW) are the numbers of the
are thrown together to render the problem difficult,

the whole

is

bulls, {xyziu)

the corresponding numbers of cows,

X = 10366482 n,
Y=
Z=

x
2/

W=
where n
the
is

7460514 w, 7358060 w, 4149387 w,


If

= 7206360 n, = 4893246

?i,

2=3515820??,
<;

= 54.39213 w,
the smallest possible value

an

integer.
is

we take

number

of cattle

sufficiently

enormous.

The

Scholiast's

solution corresponds to the value 80 of n, the


" truly," as

result being
Sicily."

Lessing observes,

"

a tolerably large herd for

The same might be This w = 1 above.

said of the solution arising from putting


is

surely

a curious commentary on

M.

Tannery's theory above alluded to (pp. 6, 7), that the price of the wine in vi. 33 of Diophantos is a sufficient evidence of the
i(xravT' afx^o\aZr)v i^ ivbi apxa/J-efOi
ffxvM-o-

reXtiovvTes t6 rpiKpacnredov oUre irpoaovruu


oUt^ iTriXenro/JL^vuv.
TrpairiSfcrcriv
^^i>(,

aSXoxpouv ravpwv,

TaOra
Kal

cvvf^fvpilji' Kal ivi

ddpolaas

ir\t)Oi.o}v

diro5ous,

u)

iravra fiirpa.

^PX^o Kv5i6o}v

inKri(p6po%'

taOi Tf iravTUii

KCKpifi^fot rairrxi uinrvLO% cp ffocply.

now FAR WAS


date of the epigram.

DIOl'HANTOS OHKMNAL?

U.',

If the " Cattle-problem " of

which we arc

now speaking were really due to Archimedes, we should, supposing M. 'i'aunery's theory to hold good, scarcely have found the result in such glaring contradiction to what cannot but
have been the
ftivour of his

facts of the case,

Nesselmann further argues


(1)

in
is

view by pointing out


it is

that the problem

clearly at

an end, when

said

that

he

who

solves

the

problem must be not unskilled in numbers, i.e. where I have shown the division and the addition of two new conditions
;

with the preface


in

"And

yet he could not pretend to proficiency


could solve the
it,

wise calculations" unless he

rest,

shows

the marks of the interpolator on the face of


of a

and, moreover,

clumsy interpolator who could neither solve the complete itself, nor even conceal his patchwork. (2) The language and versification are against the authenticity. (3) The

problem

Scholiast's solution does not, as it claims, satisfy the whole

problem, but only the


solution with the

first

part.

(4)

The

impossibility of

Greek numeral notation and the absurdly large numbers show that the author, or authors, could not have seen what the effect of the many heterogeneous conditions would be. Nesselmann draws the conclusion above stated and we may safely assume, as he says, that this ej)igram is from the historical point of view worthless, and could not, even if it
;

were shown to be earlier than the date of Diophantos, be held


to prove

anything against his

originality.

M. Tannery takes the opposite view and uses the epigram


for the

express purpose of proving his assumption that Dio-

phantos was not an original writer.


attributed to

M. Tannery takes a passage


is

Geminos

in which he

describing the distinction


XoyiariKi] according to

between XoytariKi] and

apLOfirjTiKt'j.

Geminos dewpet to
l3Xi]/j.a,

/zef

KXijOki'

toOto' he

p-ifKira^i fcuL

\\pxiM^ov<i ^oIkov trpuUl the two (jjiaXLTu^i ctpiO/xovs'vtt

do not read rovs as M. Tannery does.


is

He

alters tovto, the original

reading, into rods, simply remarking that tovto is

TovTo Si

an "inadmissible reading." certainly a reading which needs no defence, being exactly what we

should expect to have.

The passage appears


(ioeiuoi'

to be taken

from the Scholia to


Otupti

Plato's Cluinnideii, where, however, Stallbaum

and Heiberg read


touto
bi

o^
10

roOro

Hkv rb K\r}6iv

i'lr"

'A/ixtM')'Joi'S

wij6ft\)ina,

li'iMrai o 0ioXirat

H. D.

146

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

kinds of problems which are here distinguished as falling within the province of Xoyca-TiK/j M. Tannery understands
the
vir

to be indeterminate problems, the type taken {kXvO^v 'Apxi-M^ovi ^o'Ckou Trpo^Xiifia) being nothing more or less He states than the very problem we have been speaking of. that Nesselmanu has not appreciated the problem properly,
first

finally that we have here an indubitable reference to an indeterminate problem of the second degree (viz. the equation

and

8Ax^ + l=if, where

yl is

a very large number) more difficult

than those of Diophantos. simply to beg the question.


refers to the

But

this statement

For, if the expression of


of,

problem which we are speaking

would seem Geminos it may even

then only refer to the first part, that is, an indeterminate problem of the first degree M. Tannery has still to show that the whole problem is one, and a genuine product of antiquity.
:

to answer Nesselmann's

have not found that M. Tannery makes any attempt arguments and, unless they are answered, the conclusion which the latter draws from them cannot

But

be said to be invalidated.

But Nesselmann's view


stiones

is

also
I

opposed by Heiberg {Quae-

Archimedeae, 1879).

do not think, however, that his


;

arguments in favour of the authenticity are conclusive and, though answering some, he does not answer all of Nesselmann's With regard to the language Heiberg observes that objections.
the dialect need not surprise us, for the use by Archimedes of

the Ionic instead of the Doric dialect for this epigram would
easily be explained

by the common use of the Ionic

dialect for
if

epic

and

elegiac poetry \

And

he further suggests that, even

dpidfiovs,

which Beems better than the reading quoted by M. Tanuery from Hultsch, Ileronis Reliquiae, and given above. ^ Heiberg admits that the language of the title is not satisfactory. He
points out that tV
iiriypd/xfxaaii'

shoukl go, not with eipuv, but with

airiffreiXe,
is

though so

far separated

from

it,

and that the use

of the plm-al
ttXtjOos

i -my pd/ifiaaLv
'''^''^po-XV
(1-

unsatisfactory.

Upon

the reading noiKlXai iaapUlixov


z

^x""

21)

he observes that by symmetry


but to
(j

should not be equal to four times


if

+ i) (W+ic)

itself,

and, even

that were the case,

(l + l){1V+w), we should require


?xo*'<^'

TerpdKis.

Hence he suggests

for this lino iroiKlXai ladpiOfiov

nX^Ooi

^<pdvrj.

(Apparently, to judge from his punctuation, Lessing understood Terpaxij in the sense of "fourthly.") Heiberg explains irXivOov (1. 36) as " quadraugulum

sohdum," by which

is

mtaut dimply

" a square," as is clearly indicated

by

1.

34.

now FAR WAS


the difficulties as to the

DlOrilANTdS OUICINAL

147

hmguagc
itself
it

arc considered too great,


to

we

may suppose
if

the problem

have been the work of


But,

Archimedes, the language of

that of some later author.

go so far as to admit that the language may be the work of a later author than Archimedes, it would be no more unnatural to suppose that the matter itself of the latter
will

Heiberg

part of the problem was also of later date.

The suggestion that

Archimedes could not have solved the whole problem (as completed by the two last conditions) Heiberg meets with arguments which appear to be extremely unsafe. He says that
Archimedes' approximations to the value of J^, although we cannot see by what process he arrived at them, show plainly
that his arithmetic was
little

behind our modern arithmetic,


little

and

that, e.g.,

he possessed means of approximation

in-

modern method by continued fractions. Heiberg further observes that Archimedes possessed machinery for dealing with very large numbers. But we are not justified in
ferior to the

assuming on these two grounds that Archimedes could solve the indeterminate equation 8Ax^+l=y^, where (Nesselmann, p. 488) A = 51285802909803, for the solution of which we
should use continued fractions.
I

do not think, therefore, that

Heiberg has made out his

case.

Hence

I should hesitate

to

assume that the problem before us is an indubitable case, }n-evious to Diophantos, of an indeterminate equation of the second degree more difficult than those treated by him.

The discussion of the " Cattle-problem " as possibly throwing some light on the present question would seem to have adiled nothing to the arguments previously stated and the (juestiou
;

of Diophantos' originality

may be

considered to be uuaftectod by

anything that has been said about the epigram. We may therefore adopt, with little or no variation, Ncsselmann's final result, that he is far from believing that Diophantos

merely worked up the materials of others.


is

On

the contrary he

convinced that the greater part of his propositions and his ingenious methods are his own. There is moreover an " ludivi-

duum" running through


this conclusion.

the whole work which strongly confirms

lU-2

CHAPTER

VIII.

DIOPHANTOS AND THE EARLY ARABIAN ALGEBRAISTS.


I

1.

propose in this chapter to examine briefly the indicaor points of contact with, Diophantos.

tions which are to be found in certain Arabian algebraists of in-

debtedness

to,

And

in

doing so I shall leave out of consideration the Arabic translations

These are, so far as and such notices ot them as we have I have given in Chapter ill. of this Essay (pp. 39 42). Our historical knowledge of the time and manner in which Diophantos became known to the Arabs is so very scanty as to amount

of his work or commentaries tiiereupou.

we know,

all lost,

almost to nothing: hence the importance of careful comparison


of the matter, methods,

and mode of expression of Diophantos


first

with those of the important representatives of early Arabian


algebra.
tion of

Now

it

has been argued that, since the

transla-

Diophantos into Arabic that we know of was made by Abu'i-Wafa, who lived A.D. 940 998, while Mohammed ibn

Musa's algebraical work belongs to the beginning of the 9th


century,

Arabian

algebra

must have been developed indeIt does not follow

pendently of that of the Greeks. not warranted by this evidence.

This conclusion, however, is from the

want

of historical

proof of

connection between

Greek and
it is

Arabian algebra that there was no such connection; and


internal evidence that

to

we must look

for the correction

of this

misconception.

shall

accordingly enumerate a

number

of

points of similarity between the Arabian algebraists and Dio-

phantos which would seem to indicate that the Arabs were


ac(|uainted with Diophantos and
of

Greek algebra before the time

Mohammed

ibn Musu, and that in Arabian algebra generally,

DIOPHANTOS AND THE EARLY AllAHIAN AMJKHUAISTS.


at least iu its beginnings, the

14;)

Greek element greatly


liere is

j.rr.lomi-

nated, though other elements were not wanting. 2.

The

first

Arabian who concerns us

Mohammed

Al-Kharizmi. He wrote a work which he callfd Aljahr wahnukUhala, and which is, so far as we know, not only the first book which bore such a title, but (if we can trust Arabian notices) was the first book which dealt with the subject indiibn
cated thereby.

Musa

Mohammed

ibn

Musa

uses the words aljahr ami

almukiihala without explanation, and, curiously enough, there is no application of the processes indicated by the words in the

must be held to show that these processes were known, to some extent at least, even before his time, and were known by those names. A mere translation of the two terras jabr and mukdbala does not of itself give us any light as to their significance. Jabr has been translated in Latin by the words restauratio and restitutio, and in German by "Wiederherstellung"; mukabala by oppusitio, or "comparison," and in German by "Gegeniiberstellung." Fortunately, however, we have explanations of the two terms given by later Arabians, who all agree as to the meaning conveyed by them\ When we have an algebraical equation in which terms
affected with a negative sign occur on either side or on both
sides, the process

theoretical part of the treatise: facts which

by which we make

all

the terms positive,

i.e.

adding to both sides of the equation such positive terms as

will

make up

the deficiencies, or absorb the negative ones,

is

jabr or

restauratio.

When,

again,

we have by jabr transformed our


all

equation into one in which


process by which
sides,

the

terms are positive, the


only one term con-

we

strike out such terms as occur on both


is,

with the result that there


gives,

finally,

The Algebra of Mohammed ben Miua, a from various authors explaining aljabr and almukabala. Itosen says " In the Kholaset iil Hisub, a I shall give only one, as an examijle. compendium of arithmetic and geometry by Baha-Eddiu Mohammed ben Al
1

Rosen

in his edition of

number

of passages

Hosain, who died A.n. 1031,

i.e.

1575

a.i>.,

the Arabic text of which, together

with a Persian commentary by Roshan Ali, was printed at Calcutta (IHTi, Svo), The side (of the e<iuation) on which bouicthe following explanation is given thing is to be subtracted, is made complete, and as much is to be added to the
:

'

other side; this

is

jebr; again those cognate (luautitiea which are equal on both

sides are removed,

and

this is

iW)kdbalah\"

150

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
tlie

taining each power of


equals,
is

unknown,

i.e.

subtracting equals from

mukdhala, oppositio or "comparison."


of the terms ja6?*
title of

meaning
due

Such was the and mukdhala) and the use of these

words together as the

Mohammed

ibn Musa's treatise

is

to the continual occurrence in the science there

expounded

of the processes so named.

It is tiTie that in the theoretical

part of

it

he assumes that the operations have been already

completed, and accordingly divides quadratic equations at once


into six classes, viz.

aa?
x^

= hx,
x^

ax^

= c,

hx

+ hx = c,

+c=

hx, x^

= c, = bx-{-c,

but the operations are nevertheless an essential preliminary.

Now what

does Diophantos say of the necessary preliminaries

in dealing with

an equation?

"If the same powers of the un-

known with positive but different coefficients occur on both sides, we must take like from like until we have one single expression equal to another.
If there are on both sides, or on either side, negative terms, the defects
sides, until

must be added on both


from like as before.

the different powers occur on both sides with posi-

tive coefficients,

when we must take


if

like

We

must contrive always,

possible, to reduce our equations so

that they

may

contain one single term equated to one other.


will explain to

But afterwards we
left

you how, when two terms are


is

equal to a third, such an equation

solved."

(Def. 11.)

Here we have an exact


said, these operations

description of the operations called by

the Arabian algebraists aljahr and almukahala.

And, as we

must have been

familiar in Arabia before

the date of Mohammed ibn Musa's treatise. This comparison would, therefore, seem to suggest that Diophantos was well

known

in Arabia at an early date. Next, with regard to the names used by Mohammed ibn Musa for the unknown quantity and its powers, we observe that

the

known quantity

is

called the

"Number"; hence

it

is

no

matter
for this

for surprise that

he has not used the word corresponding


quantity.

to npi6fx6<i for his

unknown

He

uses shai ("thing")

purpose or jidr ("root"). translation of the Indian mfda, or

This
it

last

word may be a

may

be a recollection of the

DIOPIIANTOS
pl^t]

AND THE EARLY ARAIUAN ALGEBRAISTS.


But
avg

151

of

Nikomachos.
uses

can say nothing with certainty

as to the connection of the three words.

unknown he
" Besitz,"

For the square of the by Cantor as "Vcrmogen," equivalent to "power"), which may very well be a

mal

(translated

translation of the Svvafii'i of Diophantos.

M. Bodet comments

in his article

Ualgehre (VAl-Khh'izmi

(Journal Asiatique, 1878) upon the expression used by

Mohamit is

med

ibn

Musa

for

minus, with the view of proving that

as

be a reminiscence of Diophantos as a term derived from India \


likely to

The most important


is

point, however, for us to

examine here

the solution of the complete (juadratic equation as given by

Diophantos and as given by


according to his distinction

Mohammed

ibn Miisa,

The

latter

gives rules for the solution of each of the forms of the quadratic
;

and each of these forms we

find in

Diophantos.
quadratic

After the rules for the three forms of the complete


ibn Miisa gives geometrical proofs of
it

Mohammed
in

them.

Now

Greece

was the practice


dont
il

to

work out theorems

He

says (pp. 31, 32)


'
:

"Le mot

se sert

pour dtisigner lestermcs d'une

equation affectes du signe -est naqis, qui


de, prive de
c'est

signifie,

comme on

le sait,

'

manquant

un ampute, par exemple,

est iwqis de son bras

ou de sa jambc

^wur done tres-improprement qu'Al-Kharizmi cmploie la partie eulevec'...Aussi le mot en question n'a-t-il plus c'te cmployo par ses successeurs, et Behri ed-Din qui, au moment d'cxposer la regie dcs siijncs s'il y a soustraction, on appcllo dans la multiplication algebriquc, avait dit CO dont on soustrait zaid (additif), et ce que Ton soustrait naqis (manquant les s^par^s, mis H de), ne nomme plus dans la suite les termes n^gatifs que
cette expression

designer

'

'

'

part, retranches.'

D'oti vient ce pr6fixe vi- au

mot 7iaqis? II repond, si Ton vcut, au Sanscrit moyen desquels on iudique la soustraction njekas ou
:

ii;i<M

oa au

ckoiias veut
'

dire 'dont

on a retranchc,'
'

niais I'adjectif viias se rapportc ici


et

au

ce dont on

a retranche

de

Beba ed-Din,
AXi7rr)s,

non a

la

quautito rctrancbil-e.

Or, lo groc

possede et emploie en
logue,
c'est

I'adjectif

langage algebriquc une expression tout A fait anadont Diopbant se sert, par excmplo, pour
:

definir le signe de la soustraction

tWtir^i Kdru vtvoy, ' un \f/ iiicomplct xj/ 71 L'arabe, j'en prcnds a temoin tous les arabisauts, traDans I'indication dcs operations algubriquca duirait iWinrji par en-m'iqis.
incline

vers

le

bas.'

iv6i,

de son signe -71, if \d^pu fjiowdSft /3 if \d4^u dpiOfxou "2 unites manquant d'une inconune,' pour cxprinier 2-x. Done, s'il est possible qu'Al-Kbarizmi ait emprunt6, sauf I'emploi qu'il en fait, son HtJ<//.s- au sauscrit uiias, il pourrait tout aussi bicu so fairo iju'il

Diopbant

lit,

li

la place
:

dit-il;

mot-amot

I'eAt pris

au grec

iv Xti^et."

152
concerned
witli

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

numbers by the
the

aid of geometry; even in Dio-

phantos we find
treatise

geometrical

method employed

for

the

on Polygonal Numbers and a trace of it even in the Arithmetics, although the separation between geometry and algebra On the other hand, the Indian method was is there complete.
to

employ algebra

for

working out geometrical propositions, and


it
is

algebra reached a far higher degree of development in India

than in Greece, though debted to Greece


for

probable that even India was inprinciples.

the

first

Hence we should
is

naturally consider the geometrical basis of early Arabian algebra


as a sign of obligation to Greece.

This supposition

supported

by a very remarkable piece of evidence adduced by Cantor. It is based on the letters used by Mohammed ibn Miisa to mark
the points in the geometrical figures used to prove his rules.

The very use


Indian
;

of letters in a geometrical figure


letters

is

Greek, not

which are used are chosen in what appears to be, at first sight, a strange manner. The Arabic letters here used do not follow the order of the later Arabian

and the

alphabet, an order depending on the form of the letters and the


is their order quite explained by the arrangement of the Arabian alphabet which corresponds If however we to the order in the other Semitic languages. take the Arabic letters used in the figures and change them

mode

of writing them, nor

original

respectively into those

Greek
it

letters

which have the same nu5"

merical value, the series follows the Greek order exactly, and

not only

so,

but agrees with

in excluding

and

t.

But what
None,
for

reason could an Arab have had for refusing to use the particular
letters

which denoted 6 and 10

for geometrical figures?

so far as

we can

see.

The Greek, however, had a reason


5"

omitting the two letters

and

i,

the former because

it

really no longer regarded as a letter, the latter because

it

was was a

which might have led to confusion. We can hardly refuse to admit Cantor's conclusion from this evidence that Mohammed ibn Musa's geometrical proofs of his rules for solving the different forms of the complete quadratic are Greek. And it is, moreover, a reasonable iufereuce that the Greeks

mere

stroke,

I,

themselves discovered the rules for the solution of a complete We thus have a confirmation quadratic by means of geometry.

DIOPIIANTOS

AND THE EARLY ARABIAN

ALfJEBRAlSTS.

l.'>3

of the supposition as to the origin of the rules used by Diophantos,

which was mentioned above

(pp. 140, 141),

and we may pro-

perly conclude that algebra, as


result of a continuous

we

find

it

in

Diophantos, was the

development which extended from the time of Euclid to that of Heron and of Diophantos, and was independent of external influences.
I

now

pass to the consideration of the actual rules which

Mohammed
quadratic, as

ibn Mfisii gives for the solution of the complete

compared with those of Diophantos.


-\-

We remarked
solving the

above

(p.

91) that Diophantos would appear,

when

equation ax'
so as to

bx
the

= c,

to have first multiplied

make

first

by a throughout, term a square, and that he would, with

our notation, have given the root in the form

Vi

b
.

Mohammed
"

ibn Musa, however,


is

first

divides by a throughout

The

solution

the same
;

or less, be specified
in the

when two squares or three, or more you reduce them to one single square and

same proportion you reduce also the roots and simple numbers which are connected therewith \" This discrepancy between the Greek and the Arabian algebraist is not a very
striking or important one; but
it is

worth while to observe that


;

Mohammed

ibn Musa's rule

is

not the early Indian one

for

Brahmagupta (born 598) sometimes multiplies throughout by a like Diophantos, sometimes by 4a, which was also the regular practice of (^'rldhara, who thus obtained the root in the form
.

This rule of Crldhara's


'

is

quoted and followed

2a by Bhaskara.

Another apparent discrepancy between Mohammed ibn Musa and Diophantos lies in the fact that Diophantos never shows any sign, in his book as we have it, of recognising two roots of a quadratic, even where both roots are positive and
and not only when one of them is negative: a negative or he would, of course, not recognise unless an equation has a real positive root it is for Diophantos "impossible." Negative and irrational roots appear to be tacitly ])ut aside by
real,

irrational value

'

Rosen, The

Al<jtl>r<i

of Muluimtiu-U

bfii

Miisu, p.

'..

164

DIOPHAIITOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Mohammed ibn Musa and the earliest Indian algebraists, though both Mohammed ibn Musii and the Indians recognise the existence of two
roots.

The former undoubtedly


on this subject
is

recognises two roots,

at least in the case where both are real and positive.


definite statement

His most

given in his rule for the

solution of the equation x^


in

+ c = hx,

or the case of the quadratic

which we have "Squares and Numbers equal to Roots; for instance, a square and twenty-one in numbers are equal to ten That is to say, what must be the roots of the same square.' amount of a square, which when twenty-one dirhems are added
'

becomes equal to the equivalent of ten roots of that square? Halve the number of the roots the moiety is five. Multiply this by itself; the product is twenty-five. Subtract from this the twenty-one which are connected with the square
to
it,

Solution

the remainder

is four.

Extract

its root; it is
is

two.
;

Subtract this
is

from
three.

the moiety of the roots,

which

five

the remainder

This
is

is

the root of the square which you required, and

the square

nine.

Or you may add


is

the root to the moiety

of

the roots; the

sum

seven; this

is

the root of the square which

you sought for, and the square itself is forty-nine. When you meet with an instance lohich refers you to this case, try its solution by addition, and if that do not serve, then subtraction cerFor in this case both addition and subtraction may tainly will. be employed, which will not answer in any other of the three And cases in which the number of the roots must be halved. know that, when in a question belonging to this case you have halved the number of roots and multiplied the moiety by itself, if the product be less than the number of dirhems connected
with the
s(piare,

then the instance

is

impossible; but

if

the pro-

duct be equal to the dirhems by themselves, then the root of the square is equal to the moiety of the roots alone, without
either

In every instance where you addition or subtraction. have two squares, or more or less, reduce them to one entire This defisquare, as I have explained under the first case\" nite recognition of the existence of two roots, if Diophantos could be proved not to have known of it, would seem to show
Quoted from The Algebra of Mohavimed ben Musa
Rosen), pp. 11, 12.

'

(ed.

DTOPIIANTOS
that

AND THE EARLY ARABIAN ALGEBRAISTS. 155


ibu Musii could here have been indebted to

Mohammed

Rodet, however, remarks that we are not justified in concluding from the evidence that Diophantos did not know
India only.
of the existence of two roots: in the cases where one
is

negative

we should not expect him to mention it, for a negative root is for him "impossible," and in certain cases mentioned above (p.
92) one of the positive roots
serves that
is

irrelevant.

Rudet further obin

Mohammed

ibn Musa, while recognising

theory

two roots of the equation ,v^+c = bx, uses in practice only one, and that (curiously enough) in all instances the root corresponding to the sign minus of the radical. This statement however is not quite accurate, for in some examples of the rule which we quoted above he gives two possible values \

Mohammed
on algebra, so
important

ibn Milsa, being the

first

writer of a treatise

far as

we know,

is

for obvious reasons the

most

for the

purposes of this chapter.

If the influence of

Diophantos and Greek algebra upon the


is

earliest

Arabian algebra
with our
itself,

once established,

it is

clearly unnecessary to search so carefully


for points of connection

in the

works of

later

Arabians

author.

For, his influence having once for all exerted

the later developments would naturally be the result of other and later influences, and direct reminiscences of Diophantos
only a few
brevity.
3. Abu'1-Wafa Al-Buzjani wc have already had occasion mention (pp. 40, 41) as a translator of Diophantos and a commentator on his work. As then he studied our author so thoroughly it would be only natural to expect that his works would abound in reminiscences of Diophantos. On Abu'1-Wafa

would disappear or be obscured. I shall, therefore, mention other Arabian authors, and those with greater

to

perhaps the most important authority


to refer for details to his articles '^

is

Wopcke.

It

must

suftice

An Arabic MS. bearing the date 972 is concerned with 4. the theory of numbers throughout and particularly with the formation of rational right-angled triangles. Unfortunately the

Cf.

Rosen's edition, p. 42.

Cf. in particular the articles


LS.'}")).

on MalMmntiqucs chez

let

Arabt- {Journal

Asiatique for

156
beginning of
author.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

it is lost, and with the beginning the name of the In the fragment we find the problem To find a square which, when increased or diminished by a given number, is again

a square proposed and solved. Tlie author of the fragment was undoubtedly an Arabian, and it would probably not be rash
to say that
5.

much

of

it

was based on Diopliautos.

Mohammed ibn Alhusain wrote a treatise on rational right-angled triangles at a date probably
Again,
later

Abu

Ja'far

not

much

than 992.

He

gives as the object of the whole


It
is

the investigation of the problem just mentioned.

note-

worthy (says Cantor) that a geometrical explanation of the solution of this problem makes use of similar principles to those
which we could trace in

Mohammed

ibn Musa's geometrical

proofs of the solution of the complete quadratic, and he further


definitely alludes to Euclid
II. 7. If we consider the use of means of finding solutions of this be the two sides of a right-angled triangle

right-angled triangles as a

problem, and

c^,

c^

which contain the right angle, then


hypotenuse, and
husain, c^
c'^

c^'

+ c^

is

the square of the

+ c^ +

'^c^c^ is

a square.

Hence, says Ibn Al-

-f c'^ is

a square which,
'Ic^c^, is

when

increased or diminished

by the same number

Diophantos says similarly that " in every right-angled triangle the square of the
still

a square.

hypotenuse remains a square when double the product of the (ill. 22.) other two sides is added to, or subtracted from, it."
6.

Lastly,

we must

consider in this connection the work of

Alkarkhi, already mentioned (pp. 24, 25). We possess two treatises of his, of which the second is a continuation of the The first is called Al-Kafi fll hisUb and is arithmetical, first. Cantor points the second is the Fakhrl, an algebraic treatise.
out that,

when we compare Alkarkhi's

arithmetic with that of


his,

certain Arabian contemporaries

and predecessors of

we

see

a marked contrast, in that, while others used Indian numeral signs and methods of calculation, Alkarkhi writes out all his

numbers

as words,

and draws generally from Greek sources

rather than Indian.

The advantages

of the Indian notation as

compared with Greek in securing clearness and compactness of work were so great that we might naturally be surprised to see Alkarkiii ignoring them, and might wonder that he could have

DIOPHANTOS AND THE EARLY ARABIAN ALGEBRAISTS. 157


been unaware of them
or

have undervalued them so much.


is,

Cantor, however, thinks that the true explanation

not that he

was ignorant of the Indian arithmetical methods and notation or underestimated their advantages, but that Alkarkh! was a representative of one of two mathematical schools in Arabia, the Greek and the Indian. Alkarklii was not the solitary representative of the Greek arithmetic; he was not merely an exception to an otherwise universal acceptation of the Indian method.

He was

rather, as

we

said,

a representative of one of two schools

standing in contrast to each other.


ciphers in
his arithmetic.

Another representative of
in

the Greek school was Abu'1-Wafa, who also makes no use of

Even

Alkarkhi's

arithmetical

treatise, as in the

works of Abu'1-Wafa, there are not wanting

These could hardly by any means have been avoided, at any rate as regards the matter of their
certain Indian elements.
treatises;
tically,

but the Greek element was so predominant that, prac-

the other
real

may be

neglected.
in this connection centres

But the

importance of Alkarkhi
Fakhri.

Here again he appears as an admiring pupil of the Greeks, and especially of Diophantos, whom he often mentions by name in his book. The Fakhri consists of two parts, the first of which may be said to contain
in his second
treatise, the

the theory of algebra, the second the practice


application
to

of

it,

or

the

particular

problems.

In

both parts we find


in this treatise

Diophantos largely made use of

Alkarkhi solves

not only determinate but indeterminate equations, so that he may be taken as the representative of the Arabian indeter-

minate
of the

analysi.s.

In his solutions of indeterminate ccjuations

and second degrees we find no trace of Indian methods. Diophantos is the basis upon which he builds, but he has also
first

extended the Greek algebraist.

If

we

refer

to the

account

which the Italian algebraists give of the evolution of the successive powers of the unknown quantity in the Arabian
system,

we
is

Alkarkhi

shall see (as already remarked, p. 71, n. 1) that an exception to the adoption of the Indian .system

of generation of powers by the vviltiplicution of indices.

He

uses the additive .system, like Diophantos.

The square

of the un-

ku.iwu bein^ mal, and the cube ka'b, the succeeding powers are

158

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
null ha'h, ka'b ka'h, iiuil

mal mrd,
ka'b, &c.

mal ha'h,

rncil

ka'h

Jca'b,

ka.h ka'b

Alkarklii speaks of the six forms of the quadratic which

Mohammed ibn MusJi distinguished and explains at the same time what he understands hy jab?' and mukabala. He appears to include both processes under jabr, understanding rather by mukdbala the resulting equation written in one of the six
forms.

Among

the examples given by Alkarkhi are .r^+10a;=39,

and 0;'^+ 21 = 10a;, both of which occur in Mohammed ibn Miisa. Alkarkhi has two solutions of both, the first geometrical, the second (as he expresses it) "after Diophantos' manner." The second of the two equations which we have mentioned he reduces to x^ 10a; + 25 = 4, and then, remarking that the first member may be either (x 5f or (5 xf, he gives the two The remarkable point about his solutions x = 7, and x = 2.
treatment of this equation
is

his use of the expression


it.

" after

Diophantos' manner" applied to

We

spoke above

(p.

92)

of the doubt as to whether Diophantos

knew

or did not

know

of the existence of two roots of a quadratic.

But Alkarkhi's

expression

" after

Diophantos' manner " would seem to settle

beyond the possibility of a doubt; and perhaps would not be going too far to take his words quite literally and to suppose that the two examples of the quadratic of which we are speaking were taken directly from Diophantos. If so, we should have still more du'ect proof of the Greek origin of
this question
it

Mohammed
it

ibn Miisa's algebra.


of

On

the other hand, however,

must be mentioned that


a;'^

the equation

+ 10^=39
;

two geometrical explanations of which Alkarkhi gives one cannot

be Greek. In the first of the two he derives the solution directly and this method is therefore solely Greek. from Euclid, ii. 6 But in the second geometrical solution he employs one line to represent x'^, another to represent 10j7, and a third to represent This confusion of dimensions is alien from the Greek 100.

manner
solution

we
is

must therefore suppose that

this

geometrical

an Arabian product, and probably a discovery of


instance
of an indeterminate ecpiation

Alkarkhi himself

As an

treated by

Alkarkhi we

may

give the equation mx^

+ nx + p =

y\

He
])o

gives as a cuudition for the solution that either

or

p must

DIOPHANTOS AND THE EARLY ARABIAN ALGEBRAISTS. 150


a square.

He
is

then puts for y a binomial expression, of which

one term

either Jlna? or JJ). exactly Diophantos' procedure.

This

is,

as

we have

seen,

With regard

to the collection of problems, whicli forms the

second part of the Fakhrl, we observe that Alkarklii only admits rational and positive solutions, excluding even the value
0.

In other cases the solution

is for

Alkarkhi as

for

Diophantos

" impossible."

Many

of the problems in indeterminate analysis

are taken directly from Diophantos,


in

and are placed

in the order

which they are there found.

Of a marginal note by

Alsiraj

at the end of the fourth section of the second part of the treatise

we have already spoken

(p. 25).

ADDENDUM.
Mr James Gow
In the note beginning on p. 6i I discussed three objections urged by in his History of Greek Mathematics against my suggestion The second of these objections as to the origin of the symbol <>) for dpi0/x6s. asserted that it is of very rare occurrence, and is not found in the >iss. of

Nikomachos and Pappos, where it might most naturally be expected. In reply to this, I pointed out that it was not in the least necessary for my theory that and accordingly I did not it should occur anywhere except in Diophantos raise the question whether the symbol was found in mss. so rarely as Mr Gow appears to suppose. Since then I have thought that it would be interesting to
;

inquire into this point a


\;\liile

little

further, without, however, going too far afield.

reading Heiberg's Quaestiones Archimeikae in connection with the Cattleproblem discussed in chapter viii. it occurred to me that the symbol for apiOnos

would be
it

likely to be found, if

Ubclhts of Archimedes,

which Heiberg gives

anywhere, in the mss. of the De areiiae mimero at the end of the book, and that, if

did so occur, Heiberg's textual criticisms would i^lace the matter beyond doubt, without the necessity of actually collating the mss. My expectation proved to be fully justified for it is quite clear that the symbol occun-cd in the
;

MSS. of this work of Archimedes rather frequently,


rise to exactly the will

and that its form had given same confusion and doubt as in the case of Diophantos. I here give references to the places where it undoubtedly occurred. See the

following pages in Heiberg's book,


p. 172.
p. 174.

Heiberg reads dpL6fwv, with the remark


similarity of the signs for api6fi6s

could hardly be anything else

But the "/cat omnes." and Kai is well known, and it than this similarity which could

cause such a difference of readings.


p. 187.

Heiberg's remark "

apiOfxiov

om. codd. Bas.

excidit ante
si

(Kai)"

speaks for
p. 188.
p. 191.
js

itself.

Also on the same page "dpiOnwu]

FBC."

three times for dpiBixuv.

Here there

is a confusion between 5" (six) and dpiOfxis, where Heiberg remarks, "Error ortus est ex compendio illo uevhi dpiOfios,
I,

de quo dixi ad
p. 192.

3."

iXaTTuv and dpid/xos given as alternative readings, with the observation, " Confusa sunt compendia."
clear that the

Thus

it is

of another arithmetical treatise,


in this connection
:

a fact

symbol in question occurs tolerably often in the mss. and that the only one which I have investigated whicli certainly does not support Mr Gow's statement

that

it is

veiy rarely found.

APPENDIX.

ABSTRACT OF THE ARITHMETICS AND THE TRACT ON POLYGONAL NUMBERS.

H. D.

DIOPHANTOS.

ARITHMETICS.

BOOK

I.

Introduction addressed
Definitions.
1.

to

Dionjjsios.

"Square" and
" Power."

"side," "cube," "square-square,"


8",
k",

etc.

2.

Notation

88",

Sk",

kk", /a",

c^.
;

Corresponding fractions, the reciprocals of the foi-mer 3. used corresponding to the " nimibers."
4.

names

"]S'umber"x"Number"=
"

square.

Square x square = "squarc-

squai-e," &c.
5.
6.
*

Number "

x corresponding fraction

= unit

(/xoi-ds).

"Species" not changed by multiplication with monads.


I

Reciprocal x reciprocal - reciprocal scpiare,

etc.

9.

Minus

multiplied by

minus

gives j^lus.

Notation for minus,

/p.

10.
11.

Division.

Remark on

familiarity with processes.

Simplification of equations.
Frohlenis.

1.

Divide a given number into two having a given difference.

Given nund)er 100, given


Lesser

difference 10.

number required
2.+

x.

Therefore

40-100,
X
-

30.

The required numbers


2.

an- 70, 30.


a given nitio.

To

divide a given

number

into
."3

two having
:

1. Given number GO, given ratio Two numbers x, 2>x. Therefore ./j- ir. Till" numbers arc 45, 15.

112

164
3.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA,
To
'.

divide a given

number

into

two having a given

ratio

and

diffei-ence

Given number 80 ; ratio 3:1; diflference 4. Smaller number x. Therefore the larger is 3x +

4,

x=

1 9.

The numbers are


4.

61, 19.

Find two numbers in a given

ratio, their difference also

being

given.

Given

ratio

5:1.

Diffei'ence 20.

Numbers
5.

5x, x.

Therefore

x-6, and
into
is

the numbers are 25,

5.

To

divide a given

number

given fractions (not the same) of each

two such tliat the sum of a given number.

Necessary condition.
the numbers arising

The

latter given

number must

lie

between
first

when

the given fractions are taken of the

given number.
First given
sura 30.

number

100,

given

fractions

;^

and -, given

Second part
Therefore

5a-.

Therefore

first

part = 3 (30

- x).

90 +

2a;

= 100,

x=

5.

The required parts


6.

are 75, 25.

To
of

divide a given

number

into

two

parts, such that a given

fraction

one exceeds a given fraction of the other by a given

difierence.

Necessary condition.

The

latter

which

arises

when

that fraction of the

number must be less than that first number is taken which

exceeds the other fraction.

Given number 100


Second part Gx
parts are 88, 12.
7.

fractions 4

and -respectively
G

excess 20.
2,

Therefore 10.v+80=100, x =

and the

From

the same (rcqiiired)

number

to take
ratio.

away two given

numbers, so that the remainders are in a given

Given numbers 100, 20; ratio X required number. Therefore


a;- 100
8.
:

3:1.
3,
.;^

a- 20 = 1

140. so

To two given numbers to add that the sums ai-e in a given ratio.
1

tlie

same (required) number,

By

thiH Diojihantos

means

" such that one

is

so

many

times the other

ylm

a given number."

ARITHMETICS.
Cotulilion.

BOOK

I.

165

This ratio must bo

less

tlmu that of the greater given

number

to tlie smaller.

Given numbers 100, 20, given ratio 3:1. X required number. Therefore 3a; + 60 = a: +100, and x=20,
9.

From two given numbers


two remainders are

to subtract the

same (required) one

so that the

in a given ratio.

Condition.

This ratio must be greater than that uf the greater

given number to the smallei'.

Given numbers 20, 100, ratio 6 X required number. Therefore


1

1.

20 -

6x-

= 100 -

X,

and

a;

4.

Given two numbers, to add the same (required) number the smaller, and subtract it from the lai-ger, so that the sum
10.

to

in

the

first

case

may have

to

the

difference in the second a given

ratio.

Given numbers

20, 100, given ratio

4:1.
a;

X required number. Therefore 20 + x100-cc = 4


:
:

1,

and

76.

11.

Of two given numbers


a given ratio.
20,

to

add the

first to,

and subtract the

second from, the same (required) number, so that the numbers which
arise

may have

Given numbers

100 respectively, ratio

3:1.

X required number. Therefore 3a; - 300 = a; + 20, and x =


12.

160.

To

divide a given

number twice

into

two

parts, such that

the

fii-st

of the first pair

may have

to the first of the second a given

ratio,

and

also the second of the first pnir to the second of the second
ratio.

another given

Given number 100,


second
first

ratio of greater of

fii-st

parts to less of

2:1, 3:1.

ratio of greater of second parts to less of

X smaller

of second parts.

The

parts then are

J"" 100,

. 1 2a; j

'int^

^^^ ~ ^" [ X J

Therefore 300

5x-

00,

x-

40,

and the parts are


13.

(80, 20), (60, 40).

To

divide a given

number

thrice into

two

parts, such that

one

of the first parts

and one

of the second pai-ts, the other of the second

166

DIOPUANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

parts and one of the third parts, the other of the tliird parts and the

remaining one of the


second 3

first parts,

are respectively in given ratios.

Given number 100,


:

ratio of gi-eater of first parts to less of

1,

of greater of second to less of third

2:1,
2x,
Gx.

and
less

of greater of third to less of first of third parts.

4:1.
first

X smaller

Therefore greater of second


of

= 100 - 2x, greater Therefore less of first = Gx- 200. Hence greater of third = 2ix - 800. Therefore 25^-800 = 100, a; =36,
of second

= = 300 -

and the respective divisions are


li.

(84, 16), (72, 28), (64, 36).

two numbers such that their product has to sum a given ratio. [One is arbitrarily assumed subject to the]

To

find

their

Condition.

The assumed value

of one of the two

must be greater
1].

than the numerator of the ratio [the denominator being Ratio 3:1. x one number, the other 12 ( > 3).
12a;

Therefore

3a;

+30,
4, 12.

a;

4,

and the numbers are


15.

two numbers such that each after receiving from the other a given number may bear to the remainder a given ratio.

To

find

Let the

first receive 30 from the second, ratio being then and the second 50 from the first, ratio being then Therefore the first = 2x - 30, cc 4- 30 the second.

2:1, 3:1.

and
Therefore x
16.

a;

2a;- 80=3 + 80 1. 64, and the numbers arc


:
:

98, 94.

To

find three

numbers such that the sums of each pair are

given numbers.
Condition. Half the

sum

of all

must be greater than any one

singly.

Let

(1)

(2)

20,

(2)

(3)

30,

(3)

(l)

40.

x the sum of the three.

Therefore the numbers are


40,

X - 30, X Hence the sum x = 3x' - 90. and the numbers ai-e 15, 5,
17.

X - 20.
a;

Therefore
25.

45,

To

find four

numbers such that the sums

of all sets of three

are given.

Condition.

One

third of the

sum

of all

must be greater than

any one

singly.

Sums

of threes 22, 24, 27, 20.

ARITHMETICS.
X the sum of
Therefore
4x-

HOOK
-27,

I.

107

all four.
a;

Therefore the mimhera uro

.T-22,

-24,

a;

a;

-20.

- 93 = x, .r = and the numbers are 9, 7,


18.

31
4, 11.

numbers such that the sum exceeds the third by a given number. Given excesses 20, 30, 40. 2x sum of all, x = 45. The numbers arc 25, 35,
find

To

three

of any puir

30.

19.

[A
To

different solution of the foregoing problem.]


find four

20.

numbers such that the sum of any three exceeds


must be

the fourth by a given number.


Condition.

Half the sum of the four given

dilterences

greater than any one of them.

Given differences
2a;

20, 30, 40, 50.


Tlierefoi-c the

the

sum

of the four required numbers.

numbers are
a;- 10,

a;- 15,
2.f,

x-20, x-2b.
and
.^=

Therefore

4x- 70 =

35.

Therefore the numbers are 25, 20, 15, 10.


21. 22.

[Another solution

of the foregoing.]

To

divide a given

number

into three, such that the

sum

of each
ratio.

extreme and the mean has to the remaining extreme a given

Given number 100 X the


third.
4a;

(1)

(2)

=3

(3),

fore

Hence the sum =100.

of first

4.(1). (2) + (3) and second = 3a-. There-

X=

25,

and the sum of the


'.

first

two =

75.

y the

first

y=
23.

20.

Therefore by = 100, Therefore (2) + (3) = 4v/. The required parts are 20, 55, 25.

To

find three

numbers such that the greatest exceeds the


least,

middle number by a given fraction of the

the middle exceeds

the least by the same given fraction of the greatest, but the least

exceeds the same given fraction of the middle number by a given

number.
1

syllable for the


for the
lirtit.

As already remarked on pp. 80, 81, Diophantos docs not uso a second uuknowu, but uses dpiO/xos for the second oiHiratiou as well ob

168
Condition.

TJlOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

The middle number must exceed the

least

by such a
is gi-eater

fraction of the greatest, that if its denomiuator be multiplied into

the excess of the middle

number over the

least,

the result

than the middle number.


Greatest exceeds middle by ^ of least, middle exceeds least by o
of greatest, least exceeds ^ of middle by 10.
aj

+ 10 the

least.

Therefore middle
12^,
45, 37^, 22|^.

3aj,

greatest

6a;

-30.

Therefore

x-

and the numbers are


24. 25.

[Another solution of the foregoing.]

To

find three

numbers such
itself,

that, if each give to the

next

following a given fraction of

in order, the results after each has

given and taken

may be

equal.

Let

first

give ^ of itself to second, second

of itself to third,

third

of itself to

first.

Assume the second to be a number divisible by The numbers are 6, 4, 3a; the first, and x = '2.
26.

4,

say

4.

5.

Find four numbers such


itself,

that,

if

each give to the next

following a given fraction of

the results
-

may

all

be equal.
other

Let

first

give ^ of itself to second,

-, ^ being the

fractions.

Assume the second to be a multiple of 4, say 4. 3a; the first. The second after giving and taking becomes
Therefore
fourth
first

a;

+ 3.
of

after giving
3.

to second

and receiving

= a; +

Therefore fourth
to first

=18- 6a;.
r^

And

fourth after giving 3

- a;

and receiving
60.

of third

= a; +

3.

Therefore third

=
1

30a;

Lastly the third after giving

6.x-

2 to fourth

and receiving

from second =
24a;

a;

3.

Therefore
a;

- 47 -

3,

a;

50
^o

ARITHMETICS.

]J0OK

I.

100

m, Therefore *i the numbers


I-

are

1^0
^
,

4,

-^

120
*

111 ~ok

'

or,

multiplying by the
find three

common

denominator, 150, 92, 120, 114.


that, if each receives a given

27.

To

numbers such

fraction of the

sum

of the other two, the results are all equal.


-r,

The

fractions being
is

the

sum

of the second and third


first.

assiimed to be

3,

and x put

for the

The numbers
28.

are, after

multiplying by a

common denominator,

13, 17, 19.

To

find four

numbers such

that, if each receives a given

fraction of the
eqiial.

sum

of the remaining three, the four results are

The e;iven

fractions being

77 3

;r

we

a^suvie the

sum

of

the last three numbers to be

3.

Putting X for the

first,

Diophantos finds in

like

manner

that

numbers are

47, 77, 92, 101.

Given two numbers, to find a third which, when multiplied 29. by each successively, makes one product a square and the other the
side of that square.

Given numbers 200, 5. X required number, 200a; = (oxY,


30.

a;

8.

To find two numbers

ivhose

sum and whose product


sum
7nust exceed
'.

are

given.

Condition.

The square of ludf

the

tlie

product

by a square number, Iuti

Se tovto irXaaixaTiKov

Given sum 20, product 9G. 2x the difierence of the required numbers. Therefore numbers are 10 + x, 10 -x.

Hence 100-aj'=96.
Therefore x ^
are 12,
1

2,

and the difierence =

4.

The required numbei-s

8.

There has been much controversy as


all

to

the

moaninR

of

this diflicult

phrase.

Xylancler, the author of the Schoha, Bachct, Cossali, Schulz, NcbhoI-

mann,
it

discuss

it.

As

do not profess here

to

text I shall uot criticise their respective views, hut ouly remark
is best

bo commcntinR on the tliat I think


this condition can

to take TrXaff/xariKov in a passive sense.


i.e.

"And

(easily)

be formed,"

can be investigated (and shown

to

bo tnu), or

</i..

covered.

170
31.
2^0

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
find two numbers, luiving given their

sum and

the sian

of their squares.
Condition.

Double the

sum of

the squares

must exceed

the

square

of their sum by a

sqxiare, Icrri Se KaX tovto irXaa-fxaiLKov.

Sum

20,

sum

of squares 208.

2x the

difference.

Therefore the numbers arc 10 + .r, 10 - cc. Thus 200 + 2x- = 208. Hence x = 2, and the numbers are 12, 8.
32.

To

find

two numbers, having given their sum and the

difference of their squares.

Sum

20, difference of squares 80.

2x difference of the numbers,

and we
33.

find the

numbers

12, 8.

I'ofind two munbcrs whose difference

and product

are given.
differ-

Condition.

Four times

the 2)roduct together


Icttl Se

with square of

ence must produce

a complete square,
4,

koI tovto TrXao-ynariKo'v.

Difference

product 96.
Therefore the numbers are found to bo
12, 8.

2x the sum.
31.

Find two numbers in a given


is

ratio sucli that the

sum

of

their squares

to their
:

sum
5
:

also in a given ratio.


1

Ratios 3

and

respectively.

X
35.

lesser

number,

x1]

the numbers are

2, 6.

Find two numbers in a given


is

ratio such that the

sum

of

their squares

to then- difference in a given ratio,


:

Ratios being 3
36.

1,

10

1,

the numbers are

2, 6.

Find two numbers


Ratios being 3
1

in a given ratio such that the difference

of their squares is to their


:

sum
and

in a given

i*atio.

6:1,

the numbers arc

3, 9.

37.

Find two numbers


is

in a given i\atio such that the difference

of their squares

to their difference in a given ratio.


:

Ratios being 3

and 12

1,

the numbers are 3,

9.

Similarly by this method can be found two


ratio (1) such tliat their product is to their
(2)

numbers

in a given

sum

in a given ratio, or

such that their product


38.

is

to their diflerence in a given ratio. in a given ratio such that the square

To

find

two numbers
1

of the smaller is to the larger in a given ratio.

Ratios 3

and

6:1.

Numbers

54, 18.

ARITHMETICS.
39.

BOOK

I.

171
tliu

To

find
is

two numbers
1

in a given ratio such that

square

of the smaller

to the smaller itself in a given ratio.


:

Ratios 3
40.

and G

1.

Numbers

18, 6.

To

find

two numbers

in a given ratio such that the sf^uaro

of the less has a given ratio to the

Ratios
41.

3:1,2:1.

sum Numbers

of both.
24, 8.

To

find

two numbers
1

in a given ratio such that the square

of the smaller has a given ratio to their diUcrcncc.

Ratios 3
42.

and G

1.

Numbers

36, 12.

Similarly can be found two numbei-s in a given ratio,


(1)

such that square of larger has a given ratio to the smaller.

(2)

such that square of larger has to larger

itself

a given

i-atio,

(3) such that squai'e of larger has a given ratio to the

sum

or

difference of the two.


43.

Given two numbers,


paii's
p.

to find a tliird such that the

sums

of

the several

multiplied by the corresponding third give three

numbers

in A.

Given numbers 3, 5. X the required number.


3a;

Therefore the three expressions are


of the

Now

5a; +15, 8a;. + 15 must be either the middle or the least three, 5a; + 15 cither the greatest or the middle.

+15,

3a;

(1) 5a;+ 15 greatest,

3x+

lo least.

15 Therefore x=- -^
Therefore

(2)

5x+

15 greatest, 3a;+ 15 middle.

x^

15

(3) 8a; greatest, 3a;

+ 15

least.

Therefore x = 15.

"

172

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

BOOK
[The
first five

11.

questions of this

Book
1.

arc identical with questions in


to the

Book
other

I.

In each case the ratio of one required number

is

assumed to be 2

The enunciations only

are here

given.]

1.

To

find

two numbers whose sum

is

to the

sum

of

their

squares in a given ratio.


2.

Find two numbers whose difference

is

to the difference of

their squares in a given ratio.


3.

Find two numbers whose product

is

to their

sum

or difference

in a given ratio.
4.

Find two numbers such that the sum

of their squares is to

the diffei'ence of the numbers in a given ratio.


5.

Find two numbers such that the difference of their squares

is

to the
6.

sum

of the

numbers in a given

ratio.

Find two numbers having a given

difference,

and such that

the difference of their squares exceeds the difference of the numbers

themselves by a given number.


Condition.

The square

of their difference

must be

less

than the

sum

of the

two given

differences.

Difference of numbers 2, the other given number 20. Therefore x + is the larger and X the smaller number. 4a; + 4 = 22.
'2

a;

= 4|, and

the numbers

ai*e

4|, 6 J.

7.

may be

Find two numbers such that the diflTerence of their squares greater than their diflTerence by a given number and in a
it)'.

given ratio (to


Coiulition.

[Difference asswned.]

of the

ratio being 3:1, the square of tlie difference numbers must be < sum of three times that difference and the
ui.

The

given number.
'

By

this

Diophautos mcaiiK

"may

exceed a given proportion or fractio

it

by a given number.

ARITHMETICS.
Given number

BOOK

II.

17:^

10, difference of nunibei-s required 2.

X the smaller number. Therefore the and 4a; + 4 = 3 2+10.


.

hirger

x+

2,

Therefore

a;

3, 3, 5.

and the niimbei-s are


8.

To divide a square mnnber into two Let the square number be IG.
x^

squares.

one of the required squares.


equal to a square.
of the form' {nix

Therefore IG-.r* must be

Take a square
i.e.

- 4)-,
it

4 being taken as the


1 G.

absolute term because the square of 4 =

take (say)

(2a;

-4)* and equate


4.'c-

to 16 -a;'.

Therefore

- 1 Gx = - x'.
a^

Therefore

"5"

, '

^.v 'A are and the squares required


9.

-^ -^
,

256

144
.

[Another solution of the foregoing, practically equivalent.]


I'o

10.

divide a

number which

is the

sum of two

squares into two

other squares.

Given number 13 = 3'+2^

As

the roots of these squares are

2, 3,

take [x +

2)*

a.<?

the

first
3)*.

square and {mx Therefore


(x

3)" as tlie
)^'

second required, say


3)^'

(2x-

(2a;

324
Therefore the required squares are -^^
11.
>

05

"

To find two square numbers diflWing by a


Given difference
Side of one
GO.
x,

t/iven ntimber.

number
(x-

side of the other


3.
a;'

x phis any number

whose square < GO, say


Therefore

3)^'

= 60,
j.

and the required

.squares are 72], 132

Diophantos' words are:

"I form the

s(iuare

from any number of apiBnol

minus as

many

units as are contained in the side of U)."

The

prt-eftution
tli-ii tli.
r.

imsuli

plied throuRhout in the choice of

is

that we
i.e.

may

be rational in Diophantos' sense,

must assume it so rational and positive.

174
12.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
To add such a number
Given numbers x+
2) o)

to

each of two given numbers that

the results shall both be squares.


(1)
2, 3,

required

number

x.

Therefore

x+

^M^^^^st each be squares. ^

This

is called
it,

a double-equation.

To

solve

take the difference between them,


:

and
.

resolve it into

tioo factors^

in this case say 4

and

-.

Then

take either

(a) the

square of half the difference bettveen these factors


equate
it to the

and

smaller expression,

or (b) the sqriare of half the

sum and

equate

it to tlie larger.

In this case

(a) the

square of half the diflference

= -^

225
.

m r Iheretorc
...
^.

^= x+ o

225 yrr o4 225

>

^^^ ^ wr,
d4

97

289
,

Avhilc the squares are -rr-

-ttt

(2)

In order to avoid a double-equation,

First find a

number which added

to 2 gives a square, say x^

2.

Therefore, since the same

number added to x' + 1= square = {x- 4y say,

3 gives a square,

the absolute term (in this case 4) being so chosen that the
solution

may

give x^>2.

Therefore

x=-^
is

15
,

and the required number


13.

97

as before.

Fro77i two given

numbers

to take the

same (required) number

so tluit both the remainders are squares.

Given numbers 9, 21. Assuming 9 - x^ as the required number we satisfy one condition, and it remains that 12 + a;" = a square. Assume as the side of this square x minus some number whose
square

> 12,

say

4.

Wc

tioual" result.

must, as usual, choose suitable factors, This must always be premised.

i.e.

such as

will give

a "ra-

'

ARITHMETICS.
Therefore
(x

HOOK
1

II.

175

4)^

+ x\

^ = 2'
and the required number
14.
is

8|.
to subtract sui-cessiv:/;/

Fro7n the same {required) number

two

given munbers so that the remainders


6,

may

both be squares.

7 the given numbers.


cc

Tlien

(1) let

be required number.
cb

Tlierefore

G~|

are both squares.

The
and,

difference
l)y

1,

which

is

the product of 2 and

.^

the rule for solving a double-equation,

121

(2)

To avoid a double-equation seek


a square by
6,

number which exceeds

i.

e.

let

a;"

G be the required number.


1
:

Therefore also x- -

square = {x-

2)' say.

Hence

^~I

and the number required = tr


15.

number
number.

tohich

To divide a given number into when added to either of


20.

tioo ])arts,

and tojind a square

the

two parts gives a square

Given number
squares

< 20,

"We then have

and

if

are respectively

Take two numbci-s the sum of whose Add x to each and square. 2, 3. x^ + 4a; + 41 X' + Gx + 'd) 4.x- + 4]^ 6a; + 9j subtracted the remaindei-s are the same s<|uiire.
say
'

Let then x- be the square required,

and therefore

4a;

4"|

Gx + Oj
the required parts of 20.

Then
and

10X-+13-20,
X^
iV,
.

'

176

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
(68
iTi
'

132\
~i7r
)

49

and the required square


16.

rrrrr

To

divide a given

number

into

two parts and

find a square

which exceeds either part by a square.

Given number 20. Take (x + rtif for the required square, where m' < 20, i.e. let (x + 2Y be the required sqi;are (say). if either 4a; + 4) This leaves a square ^ ^ ^ ? 1*5 subtracted, or 2.r + 3J
.

Let these be the parts of 20,

and

x=-7,

b
>

/76 44\ Therefore the parts required are (-w, /. )

and the required square


17.

.625
is

-^^
ob
ratio such that cither together

Find two numbers in a given

with an assigned square produces a square.

Assigned square
If

9, ratio

3:1.
is

we take a
it,

square whose side

mx +

and subtract 9 from

the remainder will be one of the numbers required.


(x

Take

e. g.

Therefore

3a;*

and 3x* +
Therefore

18a;

3)^ - 9 = cc^ + 6a; for the smaller number. + 18a; = the larger number, + 9 must be made a square - (2.x-- 3)" say.

x = 30, and the required numbers are 1080, 3240.

18.

To

find three

numbers such

that, if each give to the

next

following a given fraction of itself and a given


results after each has given

number

besides, the

and taken may be

equal.
itself

First gives to second - of itself


i>

6,

second to third ^ of b
8.

7, third to first

= of

itself

Assume
,.,.

that the
-,

first

two are
,

5x,
,

Gx [equivalent
^
-

to one con,

ditionj, aiul

we

,.

find the numbei"s to be

,,

90
,

108

-=-

105
.

ARITHMETICS.
19.

BOOK

H.
.sati-sfyinfj tlio

177
conditions

Divide a number into throe parts


preceding problem.

of

tlie

Given number 80.

First gives to second p of itself + G

ic,

and

results are equal.


for tlie first
,

[Diophantos a.ssumes 5x, 12


result
,^
.

two

nunilM-rs,

and

his

170
-y^,

228

IS

217
;

but the solution does not cor(See


p.
2.5.)

respond to the question.]


20.
est

To

find three squares such that the difference of the greatis

and the second Given


ratio

to the diffei-ence of the .second

and the

lea.st in

a given ratio.

3:1.
^- .r^,

Assume

the least square

the middle =

.r*

-I-

2x

-f 1.

Therefore the greatest = x + 8x + 4 = square = {x + SYsay. Therefore

^ '

and the squares are 30|, 12^,


21.

6;^.

To
X, 2a;

find

two numbers such that the square


is

of either

added

to the other

number
-1-

a square.

are assumed, which by their form satisfy one con-

dition.

4x-

The other condition gives + 5x + \ ^ square = (2.c - 2)"


,-

say.

Therefore

3 --,

and the numbers are :^


Id
22.

19
,

^^ lo

the other
a;

To find two numbers such number is a square.


-f-

that the square of

eitlier utitntu

2.r

-f-

are assumed, satisfying one condition.


4.7;^
-i-

Therefore
Therefore

3x - square -^

9,r*

say.

3
?
>

and the numbers are


23.

To

find

two numbers such that the sum


is

of the square of

either

and the sum of both

a square.

Assume
H. D.

x,

x+l

for the

numbers.

These

satisfy

one condi-

tion.

12

178
Also
a;*

DIOPnANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
+ ix + 2 must be a square = x=
1
-,
.

{x

2)* say.

Therefore

4
5

Hence the numbers


24.

are

^ 4

of either

find two numbers such that the clifTerence of the square and the sum of both is a square. Assume x + 1, x for the numbers, and we must have a;^ - 2a; - 1 a square = {x- 3)- say.

To

Therefore

x=^,
2^.

and the nvimbei's are 3|,


25.

To

find

two numbers such that the sum


is
03"

of either

and the

square of their sura


Since
let

a square.

3x^, x^

+ 8x' are

squares,

the numbers be 3x-, Sx- and their


1 Icc^

sum

x.

Therefore

= a; and

a;

= yy
8
,

Therefore the numbers are


26.

y^

ynT

of the

To find two nunibers such that the difference of the square sum of both and either number is a square. If we subtract 7, 12 from 16 we get squares. Assume then 12a;', 7x^ for the numbers, 1 6a;" = square of sum.
Therefore
Idoif

ix,

x=
112

4
^1)
f

and the numbers are ^^


27.

192
,

^r^^

obi

obi

To
is

find

product

a square, and the

two numbers such that the sum of either and their sum of the sides of the two squan s
number, 6 suppose.
let
a;,

so arising equal to a given

Since x

(4a;

1)

+ a; = square,
3a;

4a;

be the numbers.
is

Therefore

4a;*

1 is

a square, whose side

2a;.

Therefore

37 x = --,
1

in the numbers are and


28.

37
-

121
,
.

^1

til

To

duct and either


squares so

two numbers sndi that tlu; difference of their prois a square, and the sum of the sides of the two arising equal to a number, 5.
find

ARITIIMKTICS.

ROOK

II.

17!

Assume

4a;

1,

for tlie nuinheis, wliicli tlicit.'foie satisfy on*-

condition.

Also

4.V*

3x-

{')

2,<f

Thoivforc

"''
.r
:

17'

26 and the numbers are 29.

121
,

To find two square numhrrs such that the sum of the product
a square.
'

and

either is

Let the numbers


Therefore
o

be

x", y".

a;V + .r-j

..\

are both snuares. '

To make

the
x^

first

a square we
1)-.

make

x"

+
4

a square, putting

= (x to

Therefore x =

'-.

We
Put

have now
different

make y
x\.

(_j/^

1)

a square

[and y must be

from

9/

+ 9 = (3^ - 4)' sav.


y=-^-:.
9

Therefore

Therefore the numbers are . lb


30.

0/b
their

^^

49

pi*oduct

To find two square numbers such that the difference of and either is a square.
a;',

Let

y'

be the numbers.
aJ*2/^

Therefore

'/)

X2y 2 X zf )

^^^

,, ^^<^Vi\
,

squares.
,

2;")

solution of x?

-\

^ square

is re

.^

and a solution
m,
,

of y-

= square
25
,

is _?/=

. Therefore the numbers are


1

289
,

lb

-^ .

04
their product

31.

To

find

two numbers such that

their

sum

gives a square.
to bo 1 DIophantos docs not use two unknowns, but assumes the numl)crs wliat be and 1 until ho has found x. Then he uses the same unknown to find to tho had first called unity, as explained above, p. 81. The same remark applies
x"-

next problem.

12-2

180
a'

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
+
^=

2ab

is

a square.

Put

2,

3 for a,

b,

and
2

2-

Assume then product = the numbers being x, 1 3x, and the sum
is

a square.

(2'
.

+ 3' 2 2 3 = 13a;", + 3")


.
.

.x*^

3aj

or

1 2x-.

Thei-efore

14a;

1 2x^,

and

x=
91 -^
b
.

^.

Therefore the numbers

7 are ^

32. To find two numbers whose sum is a square and ha\dng the same property as the numbers in the preceding problem.

2m

m = square,

and 2m\^ + i|^ 2

2m.
4.

in

= square.
20a;'
2a;,

Ifw-2,
their
.

4'+2'2.4.2 = 36or
.

Let then the product of numbers be (4' + 2') x^ or sum 2 4 2x- or 16a;*, and let the numbers be
Therefore
1 2a;

and

lOx.

1 Qx',

x = -,

and the numbers are ^ 4


33.

30 -t-. 4
of

To

find three

numbers such that the sum of the square


1)

any one and the succeeding number is a square. Let the first be x, the second 2a; + 1, the third 2 (2a'+ or 4a; + 3, so that two conditions are satisfied.
Lastly
(4a;

3)'

+ x = square =
a;

(4a;

4)" say.

Therefore

- ^^ 57
71
, ,

and the numbers are _^

199 ^ -^

of

To find three numbers such that the difieronce of the square 34. any one and the succeeding number is a square. Assume first a; + l, second 2a: +1, third 4a; + 1. Therefore two conditions are satisfied, and the third gives
1 Ga;'

+7x = square =
"^

25a;* say.

Therefore

7 n

>

and the numbers are n


35.

16
,

23
-q,

37
-q

To

find three

numbers such
the result
is

that, if the square of

any one be

added to the sum of


/7>i-n\

all,

a square.

^^^^

.^

^ square.

Take

number

soparublo into

ARITHMETICS.
two

BOOK

111.

IM
is tlio

factors (m, u) in three ways, say 12, whicli


(1, 12), (2, 6), (3, 4).

pro

duct of

The values then of


Let now o\x,
Therefore
2x,

^ are

5.\,

2,

^x
So;

be the numbers.

Their sum

is 12.r'.

1 2.t*,

a:

!^

and the numbei-s are


30.

^ ij

q
<J

To

find three

tracted from the square of

numbers such that, if the sum of auy one, the result is a square.
a square.

all

be sub-

^r
J

mn

is

Take 12

as before,

and

let G.^x,

Ax,

Zlx be the numbers, their sum being

\'2x*.

Therefore
, ,

x=

91 28 ,, and the numbers are vt, 12' 6


,

49
, '

,^^

12

BOOK
1.

III.

To

find three

numbers such
of
all,

that,

if

the square of any one be


is

subtracted from the

sum

the remainder

a square.

Take two squares

whose sum = 5x". Let the sum of all three numbers be 5.*;^, and two of the numbers These assumptions satisfy two couditions. X, 2x.
af, 4a;*

Next

divide 5 into the

sum

of two squares

4
[ii.

121

10] ^-^,

-^,

and assume that the third nuuiber


Therefore

is

2 t x.

x+2x+ ^x = 5x^
17

Therefore

a;

17
,,

and the numbers are


2.

34
,

34 ^-^

To

find three

numbers such

that, if the scjuare of the


is

sum be

added to any one of them, the suui

a s(|uan'.

L^^

ARITHMETICS.
Let the sum be
a;*

BOOK

III.

183

+ 2.+l, sum of fh-st and sccoml x*, and therefore the third 2a; + 1 ; let second + third = (x- 1)*. Therefore the first is 4a:, and therefore the secontl x* - 4x. But first + third = square, or G.t- + 1 = square -Vl\ say.
Therefore
s;

20,

and
8.

t]ie

numbers are

(80, 320, 41).

[The same otherwise.]

9.

To

find three

numbers

in A.

p.

such that the sum of any pair

is

a square.
First find three square

numbers
Let
is a;*

in A.
x^,

together

>

the third.

{x

therefore the tliird


Therefoi-e

4a;

+2

any two of which are 1 )* be two of these ; = (a; - 8)* say.


p.

x-

31
...,

or

we may take

as the squares 961, 1G81, 2401.

We

have now to find three numbers, the sum.s of pairs being these numbers.

Suin of the three =

^-^ =

252 U-,

and we have

all

the three numbers.

10. Given one number, to find three others such that the sura of any pair of them and the given number is a square, and also the sura of the three and the given number is a square.
first + second = x* + 4a; + 1, second + 6, sum of all three = x* + 8x + 13. Therefore third = 4. + 1 2, second = x- + 2x - 6, first = 2x + 7. Also third + first + 3 = square, or 6x+22 = squai-e=K)0sui)i)Ose. o: = 1 Therefore 3,

Given number

3.

Suppose

third - x"

G.f

and the numbers are


11.

33, 189,

64

Given one number,

to find three othci-s such that, if the

given

number be subtracted from


all

the

sum

of

any pair of them or

from the sum, the results are

squares.

Given number 3. Sum of first two x* + 3, of next pair Therefore x' + 2x + 4, and sum of the three x* + 4x + 7. third = 4x + 4, second = x* - 2x, first = 2x + 3. Therefore, Therefore x=10, and lastly, 6x + 4 = square -- 64 say.
(23, 80, 44) is a solution.

184

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

12. To find three numbers such that the sum of the product of any two and a given nmnher is a square. Let the given number be 12. Take a square (say 25) and subTake the difference (13) for the product of the tract 12.
first

and second numbers, and


1

let

these

numbers be
1 6,

ISrc, -

Again, subtract
diffei-ence

from another square, say

and

let the

4 be the product of the second and third

numbers.

Therefore the third number = ix.


condition
is

Hence the 52 = 4.

third
13,

gives

52.7;^+

12

square,

but

and 13
find

not a square, therefore this equato replace 13

tion cannot be solved by our method.

Thus we must
product
is

two numbers
is

and 4 whose
square.

a square, and such that either a square


if

+12 =
=

Now

the product
find

both are squares.


either + 12

Hence
square.

we must

two squares such that

The squares 4 and ^


Retracing our steps

satisfy this condition.

we put

4.r,

- for

the numbers, and

we

have to solve the equation


X'

+12 = square =

(as

+
,

3)^ say.

Therefore

=
a solution.

and
13.

(2, 2, ^) is

To

find three

numbers
10.
first

sui;h that, if

a given
is

number

is

sub-

tracted from the product of any pair, the result

a square.

Given number

Put product
and

of

and second
second

=a
.

square +

10=4 +

10 say,

let first

14.r,

Also let product of second

andthird=19. Therefore third = 19a;. Whence 2G6x-'- 10 must be a square; but 266 is not a square.
Hence, as in the preceding problem, we must find two squares
each of which exceeds a square by 10.

Now

-10-[--^-],
If
vi'

therefore

30|

is

one

sucli

square.

be another, ta'-XO must be a square

= (m -

2)" say, therefore in

3^.

AUITHMETICS.
Thus, putting 30 jr, -,

BOOK

III.

185

12;iu;

for the uumbei-s,


1

we

have, from
2)* say.

the third coudition, [)929x-^-

GO ^square =^(7 7a;-

Therefore

x=
,

^r=
1

and the numbers arc


1

,1

1240]
77
,

77
., '41'
,

5021

77
of

U.
added

To

find three

numbers such that the product

any two

to tlie third gives a square.

Take a square and subtract part of it for Let x^ +6x+d be one of the sums, and
be
9.

tlie tliinl

number.

let

the third

Therefore product of
fii'st

fii-st

and second =

number x* + 6x.

Let the

x,

therefore the second

= a; +

G.

From

the two remaining conditions


10a:

10a;

+ 54) + 6/

are both squares.


differing l)y 48, wliich

Therefore

we have

to find

two squares

are found to be IG, G4.

and
15.

(1, 7, 9) is

a solution.

To

tind

three

numbers such that the product


x+
product

of

any two

exceeds the third by a square.


First X, second
4, therefoi-e their
4a;.

is

x-

Ix,

and

we suppose

the third to be

Therefore by the other conditions


4x-

15a;

-2
The
and
Therefore
IG.
^''

^,
**^

a\
(4a;

^^'^

squares.

difference

=
f

IGa;

+4=4
)

1),

/ 4.r

+5

-^-TT

Y =

4 a;'

15a;.

= ^,^,

25

'ind the

numbers are found.


tlie

To
Let

find throe

numbers such that


second 4x +
third

product of any two

added to the square of the third gives a square.


first

be

x,

4,

1.

Two

conditions arc

thus
a;

satisfied,

(4a;

and the remaining one gives + 4)^ ^ a square - (4a; - 5)' say.
a^

Tlierefore

9
;r:t
>

and the numbers are

9,

328, 73.

186
17.

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

To

find three

numbers such that the product

of

any two

added to the sum of those two gives a square.


Leimna.

The squares

of

two consecutive numbers


third.
,

liave this

property.

Let

4,

9 be

two of the numbers, x the


10a;
5a;

Therefore

and

tlie

difference

5a;
ii.,

I must both be squares, ^ +4 + 5 = 5 (a; + 1).


,

+ 9)

Therefore by Book

i^^)'and
18.
(4, 9,

10a:

and

a;

=28,

28)

is

a solution.

\_Another solution of the foo'egoinff problem.]

Assume

the

first to

be

x,

the second
2-5

3.

Therefore

4a;

+ 3 = square =
one condition.
first

say,

whence

a;

= 5^, and
a;,

5^, 3

satisfy

Let the third be

5^ and 3

being the
Therefore

two.

4a; -,

+3
_,

)
>

C^a;

+ 5iJ

must both be squares, ^

.,

bid, since the copfficients in one expression are both greater

than those in the other, but neither of the ratios of corre-

sponding ones

is that

of a square

to

a square, our method

will not solve them.

Hence

(to replace 51, 3)

their product

their

we must find two numbers such that sum = square, and the ratio of the
1 is

numbers each increased by


a square.

the ratio of a square to

Let them be y and


dition
;

4?/

3,

which
3)'',

satisfy

the

latter

con-

and

so that product

+ sum = square we must have


say.

4y^

81/

+ 3 - square = (2^ 3 y = -3
^tt, 45,
a;

Therefore

Assume now
Therefore

for the numbers.

oja;

+
"^

4M
3
\-

13x

ave both squares.

To"
or

10)
,
.

130a; +1051 -- 1-^1-^"--^' 130X+ 30J

ARITHMETICS.
the ditlerence

BOOK

III.

187
2"),

75,

-wliicli

has two factors 3 ami

and

X-

7
:^A

gives a solution,
7
.

the numbers being


19.

3
,

4J,

To
Put

fniil

three numbers
of those

siu-li

tliat

the iiroduct of any two

exceeds the

sum
first

two by
in

a square.
fall

into the same have to find two numbers such that their product minus their sum = square, and when each is diminished by one they have
difficulty as

X,

second any number, and we


the preceding.

We

the ratio of squares.


condition, and
it/-

4?/+l,
5
c
:>

y+l

satisfy
say.

the latter

- square -{2i/ 2)'


=

Therefore

!/

Assume then
Therefore

as the

numbers

13
-^,

~,
b

28

x.

2}^x-3U
5
,
''*''

8
or

_ ~ 8

are both squares,

lOx-U]
10a;-2Gj
"'"^

^.

'l"'^'"^^'

the difterence

12

=
o

2 .G, 3h,

and x
3.

=^

is

a solution.

The numbers are -^


20.

13
,

To

find

two numbers such that

their product

added

to both

or to cither gives a square.

Assume
since

x,

x{ix-

1)
4a,-'

ix - 1 + x = ix^ = square.

Therefore also

3.x-

1 )
,

4x^ +

ix-l)

>

^, squares, arc both


,

the diflference

= x = 4a;

7 4

and
21.

X = ,j^ gives a
find

solution.

To

two numbers such that the product exceeds tho


V)y

sum

of both, and also cither severally,

stjuare.

Assume
since
4a; (x-

x+
+
1 )

1,

ix,

4a;

= scpiare.

188

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Therefore also
4a;*
2

3.

~)

'j-

are both squares,

the difference

= ix = 4x.

1.

Therefore

a;=l],

and
22.

(2|, 5) is a solution.
that, if

To find four numbers such

we

take the square of the

sum any

one singly, all the resulting numbers are squares.

Since in a rational right-angled triangle square on hypotenuse

= squares on
of sides

sides,

square on hypotenuse

=*=

twice product

square.
will

Therefore
into

we must find a square which two squares in four ways.


first

admit of division

Take the right-angled


the sides of the
vice versa.

triangles (3, 4, 5), (5, 12, 13).

Multiply

by the hypotenuse

of the second

and

Therefore

we have

the triangles (39, 52, 65), (25, 60, 65).

Thus 65^
Also
Therefore 65^

is split

up

into
4'
.

two squares in two ways.

G5

= 7' +

= 8^-hP.
4"

= {T - ^J + 4 7^

= (8^ =
33''

1')^

+4

8M*

+ 56^= 63* +16',

which gives two more ways.

Thus 65*

is split

into

two squares in four ways.


of the

Assume now
first

as the

sum
.

numbers

65a;,

number = 2 .39

52a;*

=
=

4056a;*^

second
third

=2

25

60x*
56a;*

3000a;*

=2.33.

and the sum = 12768x*


i

3696a;*

fourth

=2.16.63.*=2016a;*j
65

Therefore 12768x-* = 65a; and x=i21Q9>'

and the numbers arc found,


17136600 163021824'
23.
sijuare

viz.

12675000 163021824'

15615600 163021824'
into

8517600 163021824"
j)arts,

To

divide a given

number

two

and

to find a

which exceeds either of the parts by a

scpiare.
1.

Let the given number be 10, and the square x" + 1x +

Put one

of the parts 2.'b+1, the other


if
fix-I-

4a;.

Therefore

the

conditions are satisfied

10.

ARITHMETICS.
3

HOOK

IV.

189

Tlierefore

X6, 4,

and the parts are


24.

the square 6].


into

To

divide a given

number

two

parts,

and

to find

ii

square which added to either of the parts produces a square.

Given number
Tliis is

20.
if

Let the square be

x^

+ 2x+\.
8.
.satisfied

a square

we add
ai'e

2a;

+ 3 or

4a;

Therefore, if these

the parts, the conditions are


or
a;

when

6a;

11

= 20,

~ H.
is

Therefore the numbers into which 20

divided an-

(6,

14)

and the required square

is

6^.

BOOK
1.

IV.

To

divide a given
is

number

into

two

cubes, such that the

sum

of their sides

a given number.

Sides of cubes 5

Given number 370, sum of sides 10. + x,5-x. Therefore 30x' 4 250 = 370, x =
7^, 3^.

2,

and the cubes are


2.

To

find

two numbers whose

difference

is

given,

and

also the

difference of their cubes.

Difference
a;

6.
a;

Difference of cubes 504.

Let the numbcra

be-

3,

3.

Therefore
a;

1 8a;*

+ 54 = 504.

Tlierefore

a;'

25,

5,
2.

and the
3.

sides of the cubes are 8,

number

multiplied into a square and

its side
is

makes the

latter

product a cube of which the foi-mer product

the side; to find

the square.

Let the square be


Q

a;".

Therefore

its

side

is

x,

and

let

tho

number be

Hence the products


rr,,

are

8a;, 8,

and {Sxy =

Therefore

. a;

^ = 7-

190

DIOPnANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

4. To add the same number to a square and its side and make them the same, [i.e. make the first product a square of which the

second product

is side]'.
cc^,

Square

whose

side

is x.

Let the number added


3a;".

to x'

be

such as to make a square, say


Therefore Zx" + x

= side

of 4x

= 2x and x = ^.
is

The square

is

3 and the number

and
its

To add the same number 5. them the opposite.


Square
x^,

to a square

side

and make

the

number
of

ix
4a;"

- x.
=
2.r,

Hence

5a;^

-x = side

and x--=.
to a square

6. To add make them the

the same square

number

and a cube and

same.
o;^

Let the cube be


say
at
Ox--.

and the square any square number of


to the square 16a;^
9,

x^'s,,

Add

(The 16
1

is

arrived

by taking two factors of

say

and

9,

subtracting

them, halving the remainder and squaring.)


Therefore x^ +
16."

= cube = S.c'' suppose and

a;

make them

Whence
7.

the numbers are known.

Add

to

a cube and a square the same square and

the opposite.
[Call the cube (1), first square (2),

and the added square

(3)].

Now Now

suppose
a'

(2)

(3)

= (1)

[since (2)

(3)

=a

cube\.

+ y^2ah is a square. Suppose then {\) =a- + 1/, = 2ah. But (3) must be a square. Therefoi-e 2ab must be a square hence we put = 1, & = 2. Now (1) is a cube. Tlius suppose (1) = 5x^, (3) = 4,r-, (2) = x^. Therefore a? - 5, and (1)- 125, (2) = 25, (3) = 100.
(3)
;

'

111

this

aud the following enunciations


gained thereby.
the

have kept closely to the Greek,

partly for the purpose of showing Diophautos'


for the brevity

mode

of expression,

and partly

"To make them


brackets; "to

same" means
the opposite"
is

in the case of

-1

what
first

have put in

make them

means

to

make

the

product a side

of which the second product

the square.

ARITHMETICS.
8.

BOOK

IV.

191

[Another solution of the foregoing.]


Since (2) + (3) =
to find
(l), a cube, and (1) + (3) = .square, two squares whose .sum + one of thoni - a and whose sum = (l). Let the fii-st square be
I

havn
the

S(iuan',
ar*,

second

4.

Therefore 2.r + 4 = a square =

(2^;

2)' say.

Therefore x

= i,

and the squares are

IG, 4.

Assume now
Therefore

(2)

= ix\

(3)

IGx'.

20a;'

= a cube, and x =
is

20,

thus (8000, 1600, 6400)


9.

a solution.
to

To add

the

same number
cube

cidje

and

its side,

and make

them the same.

Added number
and
this

x,

8x-^,

say.

Therefore second

must be the
a;.

side of cube Sx^

x, or 8a;^

sum = 3a;, a; = 27x'.

Therefore 19x' =

But 19

is

not a square.
it.

Hence we must
3a;

find a square to

replace

Kow

the side

comes

fx-om the

assumed

2j;.

Hence we must
differ

find two consecutive

numbers whose cubes


and
y=
l.

by a square.
3v/"

Therefore

3v/

Let them he y, y+\. =square = (l 2?/)* say,

Thus instead of 2 and 3 we must take 7 and 8. Assuming now added number = x, side of cul)e = Ix, new cube 8a;, we find 343.<;' + x = 512x''\
Therefore
a;^

side of

=
^J^,
7

a;

l.

(343
10.

1 \

2197'T3'13;^'^'"^"^^""-

To add
Suppose

the

same number

to

a cube and

its sid'!

and

i/uikc

them

the opjwsite.
tlie

cube

8x-^, its

side 2x, the

number

27x-'

2a;.

Therefore 35x'
'^

2a;

= side

of cube 27j;', therefore 3r)x*-5

0.

This gives no rational value.


Therefore
bears to the
to a square.

Now

35 = 27 +

8,

3 +

2.

we must find two numbers the sum of sum of the numbers tlie ratio
say,

wlioso cubes

of a square

Let sum of sides = anything, 2


Therefore 8 12^3

and

side of first cul>c

:.

= twice a square. Therefore i-(jz + 3z^ = a .square = (2 - 45)*


+
6s'

sjiy,

and

= on-

192

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
of the sides

=
^

and the other

side

= j^

Take

for

them

and

8.

Assuming now
5 1 2^'
,

as

the cube

\'25x^,

and as
a;

the

number

5x,

we
.

get 637a;^

-5x = 8x, and

=-

/125

267\

11.

To

find

two cubes whose sum equals the sum


Sx.

of their sides.

Let the sides be 2x,

This gives

35a;'

5x.

This equation

gives no rational result.

Finding as in the preceding


it,

problem an equation to replace


1.1 and the cubes are
1

637a;'

1 Sx,

a;

==

125

512
,

^^

-^^^

12.

To

find

two cubes whose

difference equals the difference of

their sides.

Assume

as sides 2x, 3x.


to find

This gives Idx^ =

x.

Irrational;

and

we have

two cubes such that


Let them be
(z

their difference difference of sides

ratio of squares.
3;^

1)*,

z\

Therefore Sz' + Therefore z =


7.

= square = (1 -

2z)- say.

Now

assume as

sides

7a;,

Sx.

Therefore 169a;* =

a;,

and .'c=t^.
1

Therefore the two cubes


13.
less

(i^>

a
of the greater

To

find

two numbers such that the cube +

+ the

the cube of the less + the greater.

Assume

2a;,

3a;.

Therefore

27a;'

2a;

Sa;'

3a;.

Therefore

19.x'

= a;, which

gives an irrational result.


7a;, 8a;,

Hence,

as in 12th problem,

we must assume
7
v:^
,

and the numbers are as there


1 4.

^g

To

find

difference increased

two numbers such that by 1 gives a square.

either, or their

sum, or their

Take unity from any square say, 9a;" + 6.r.

for the first

number

let it be,

ARITHMETICS.

BOOK

IV.

19:^

But the second + 1 =a square.


factors of
9j;*

Therefore wc must Cnd a squar.-

such that the square found + 9x* + 6x = a square.

Taku

6.r,

nz, (9x+6,

x).

Square of half dif


+

ference

-16xf +

24a;

9.

Therefore, if

we put

the second

number

IG.c"

24.C

8,

threo

conditions are satisfied, and the remaining condition gives

+ 1 = square. + 1 Sx + 9 = square = (3 Therefore x = 18, and (3024, 5624) is a solution.


difference
7a;*

Hence

3x-)-

say.

15.

To

find three square

numbers such that

their

sum

equals

the

sum

of their differences.

8umo{diSerences=A-B+B-C+A-C = 2{A-C) = A+B+C,


by the question.
Let
least (C)

1,

greatest

three

squares

2x^

= a;' + 2.x- + 1. Therefore sum of the + ix = x^ + 2a; + 2 + the middle one.


(JB)

Therefore the middle one


square,

= a;' +
a;

2a;

2.

This

is

(x

4)" say.

Therefore

= -

and the squares are (s^,


16.

~nr

'^''

(196, 121, 25).

To find
Let
(fii-st

three
is

plied by the third

numbers such a given number.


.

that the

sum of any two

multi-

(third

+ second) third = 35, (second + third) first = + first) second = 32, and let the third = x.
.

27,

and

3.3

Therefore

first

194
17.
the

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
To
fiiid three

numbers whose sum

is

a square, and such

th<(t

sum 0/ the

square of each

and

the succeeding
4a;.

number

is

a square.

Let the middle number be


product
square.
is ix,

Therefore I must find what

square + ^x gives a square.


say
2ic

Take two numbers whose


2.

and

Therefore

{x-\y

is

the

Thus the first number = c- 1. Again 16x-* + third = square. Therefore third = a square - 1 6a;* = (4a; + VfYQtx?

say,

8a;+

Now

the three together = square, therefore 13a;=square=1697/say.

Therefore

x=\ 3^.
=
square.

Hence

the

numbers are

ISy^'-l, 52/,
Lastly, (third)*

104/ +1.
or

first

Therefore

10816/ + 221/ = a square

10816/ + 221= a

square
,

= (104y/ +1)
157300

say.

220 Therefore y = -".

55

/36621

317304\

18.

To

find three

numbers whose sum

is

a square, and such that

the difference of the square of any one and the succeeding

number

is

a square.

The

solution

is

exactly similar to the

last,

the numbers being

in this case

equation

is

The resulting 13/ +1, 52/, 104/ -1. 10816/ - 221 = square = (104^ - 1)-,

whence
,

2/

=-^^-^,

/170989

640692
'

^^^
19.

(T08I6-' T0816

1270568\ 10816 ;

^^

" ^^^"*^'^-

To find two numbers such


Let the
first

that the cube

of

the first

thr

second - a cube, the square of the second

the first

=a
= x.

square.

be

x,

the second
8)* say,

8-a;'',

therefore a;''-16.r''+64 + a' =


32a;^

a square

= (x* +

whence
is

This gives an

32 = 4. 8. we must put in our assumptions 4 64 insteail. Then the second number is 64 -a;^, and we get, as an
irrational result since

32

not a square.

Now
.

Therefore

equation for
256a;

x,

Therefore x =
1

lb

and

tlu.

numbers are jg, ^^gg

262143
.

ARITHMETICS.
20.

UOOK

IV.

10.",

To jlud

three

numbers

imfffinite/i/^ s?/<7(

(/uU the ]>ro<liict /

ani/ two increased by

1 is

a square.
first

Let the product of


condition

and second be x* + 2x, whence oni second = x, first = x + 2. Now th product of second and third + 1 =a square let this prois satisfied, if
;

duct be Ox* +
a square.

6a;,

so that third
first

number =^x +
i.e.

G.

Also

lh(?
^

product of third and

= square,

9x* + 24j; + 13
tfie

Nov.\ if 13 ivere a square,

and

coefficient

of

v}ere 6 times the side

of

this square, the

problem icoubl

be solved indefinitelij as required.

Now

13 comes from 6.2 + 2.1.


Therefore
it

1,

the 6 from 2

3,

and the
.

from

that four times

we want a number to replace 3 1 such + 1 = a square therefore we need only


;

take two numbers whose difierence [and 4.

is

1,

say

and

2.1+ (2

1)-

we put product of first x+2, pi'oduct [Then third = ix + 4.

= square]. Then, beginning again, first and second = x-* + 2a-, second x, of second and third = 4x* + 4.r, and
first x

third

= 4- + 1 2x +

0.
]

And
21.

(x

2, X,

4x +

4) is a solution.
sicch that

To find four numbers


1,

the

product of ani/ two,

ina'eased by

becomes a square.
that the product of
2,

Assume
but

first

and second = a;* +

'2x, fii-st

= x,

second = x +
(4a;

and similarly third = 4x + 4, fourth =9a:+ G, + 4)(9a; + 6) + 1 = square = 36a;- + 60x + 2;3. and fourth, 1 3 = square =
(O.v-

Also

for second
9x-'

+ 24x +
lb

24..-

6), say.

Therefore x

= -r-^.
now
i

All the conditions are

satisfied*,

^ /J^ the solution bein^ ^t, ^


22.

33 68 t^ V16' 16'
>

105\
>

>

-i

if.

Find three

the difference

numbers which are proportional and such of any two is a square.


a;

that

Assume

to be the least,
if

x + 4 the midiUe, x +

3 the greatoist.
indefi-

therefore

13 were a square we shoidd have an

nite solution satisfying three of the conditions.


1

We muHt
+ 9. ^hidi
i

I.e. in

general expressions.
1

Product of second and third +

= (a: +

2) (ix

4)

i-c'

l'^-^

a square.

1.12

196

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
therefore replace 13
squares.
l)y a squai-e

wliich

is tlie

sura of two

Thus

if

\vc

satisfied,

assume x, x + 9, x+ 25, three conditions are and the fourth gives x (x + 25) = {x + 9)", there-;^
I

fore
. I

x=

[j
i

,81 /i IT

144
, '

256\ ZDt)\
.

'

r,7')

IS

a solution.

^.

To find three numhers such 23. and any one of them is a square.
Let the product be
x'

that the

sum of their solid content^


number
.

2x,

and the

first

1,

the second

ix + 9

therefore the third

C*+
:,

2x -^

This cannot be
:

divided out generally unless x^: 4:X=2x 9 or

a;"

2.^'=4a;

9,

and

it

could be done
(jx

if

4 were half of

9.

Now

ix comes from
to find a

2x,

and

from

3^,

therefore

we have

number

to replace 3 such that

2i-2 = -^,

therefore

m^ = 4w - 4 or

m = 2.

We

put therefore for the second number 2x + 4, and the third Therefore also [third condition] then becomes Ix.
x^

+ 2x + \x - square = ix^
1\\
.

say,

whence

x=

5
,

(. 34

solution.

24.

content

To find three numbers such that and any one of them is a square.
Fii'st x, solid

tJie

difference

of their solid

content x^.+ x; therefore the product of second


1
;

and third = 03 +

let the

second

Therefore the two remaining conditions give


a

both squares [Double equation.]


aay
therefore

Difference

= cc =
-
)

2a;,

(.t

+ :^)' = vX-*+k-1, x8

..(^;,i,
I.e.

is

a .solution.

the continued product of

all three.

Observe the solution of a mixed quadratic.

X-

198

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Hence we assume
for the

numbers
8

9
5'^''

3^'

3^' by
15.

or (25x, 27a;, -iOx), multiplying throughout

Therefore the

sum = d2x=

4,

and

'k

= oo

and

-^

are the three parts required.


o

[N.B.

The condition ^
is

<m+l

is

ignored in the work,

and
27

incidentally satisfied.]
to either gives a

To

find

two numbers whose product added


first

cube.

Suppose the

Second
also 8a;'

a;^

1, (so

8a;

number equals a cube number that 8a;^ - 8a; + 8a; = cube); + a;^ - 1 must be a cube = (2a; 1)^
1 2>x*

of

a;'s,

say

8a;.

say.

Therefore

4,x-,

x = yoi 1 o
i

14

^"^
28.

(13-' res)
find

^ soi^^ti^"difference

To

two numbers such that the


is

between the

product and either

a cube.
8a;,

Let the

first

be

the second

a;^

(since 8a;'+8a;

8a;= cube)

must be a cube, which is "impossible " [for to get rid of the third power and the absolute term we can only put this equal to (2a;- 1)^ which gives an " irrational " result]. Assume then the first = 8a; + 1, the second = a;* (since 8a;^ + a;^ - x^ = cube).
also
8if^

8a;

- a;* -

Therefore
Therefore

8a;'

a;"

8.r

= a cube = {2x - If
14
,

say.

x = y^
125
^
,

wi the nunilx'rs are and


29.
cube.

196
.

Id

169
=t

To find two numbers such


Let the
first

that their product

their

sum - a

cube be G4, the second

8.

Therefore twice the

sum

of the

numbers = 64 - 8 =
28,

56,

and the sum of the

numbers =

but

thi-ii-

product + their

sum =

64.

Therefore their product - 36.

ARITHMETICS.
Therefore

BOOK

IV.

199

two numbers whose sum - 28, and whose product = 36. Assuming 14 +a;, 14 -x for these numbers, 196 -x':::^ 36 and x* = 160, and if 160 were a
to tind

we have

a square

we

could solve

it

rationally.

Now
=

160

arises

from

4''

-36, and

14=

J. 28

--.56
4

2
T (diflference

of cubes) to find

36 = ^ sum of cubes.
sucli that

Therefore
(

we have

two cubes

of their difiereuce )

^^

their
s

sum = a
1
1

square.

Let the sides of these cubes be


1

s +

Therefore - of their difference

3
~'
r>

;j> '^^^^

the square of this

=r
Hence
(

9,3,1 ^2^'^4)

differer cc

.^

sum =

t ~

='
;>

+ a~~) v"^

"*"

"')

Therefore
dz'

Gz'

4^'

- 1 2s = a square =

(3;:'

6c) say,

whence

32s^

36s*,

and

9
o

Therefore sides of cubes are

200

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Hence
,

500 x = ^512
/1728

""'"^

V^12
30.

'

728\ 512 j

''

^ '"^"*'''their

To

find

two

numbers

such

that

product

their

sum =

a cube [same problem as the foregoing].

Every square divided into two parts, one of tohich is its makes the 2)roduct of these ])arts + their sum a cube. [i.e. x(x^ - x) + x' x + x= a cube.]
Let the square be x^ ; the parts are x, x^ and fi-om the second part of the condition
x^
x,

side,

-x^ -X- =

x^

2x^

a cube = [7,] say.

Therefore

5 *^

= 2a;'', x = -^
<

and

/16
(

144\
,

-^

-jq

IS

a solution.

31. 7'o find four square numbers such that their of their sides - a yiven number.

sum +

the su?n

Given number
Therefore the

1 2.

Now

x*

+ a; + j = a

square.

sum

of four squares

+ the sum
and

of their sides

13.

Thus we have

to divide 13 into 4 squares,

if

from

eacli of

their sides

we

subtract ^

we

shall

have the sides

of

the

required squares.

Now
and the

10 l3

. n = 44-9 =

--f25+-25+05'

G4

36

144

81

sides of the required squares are

11

^
lO'

19

10'
32.

10'

13 10"

To

find four squares

such that their

sum

ininus the

sum

of

their sides equals a given

number.

Given number
5

4,

Then

similarly
9
^-^

side of first

- -j +

...

5.

-,.,..,-. and is divided into

IG
,

G4
,

36
.

^rz

2y

25

25
-

^^

?,2;)

>

and the sides of the squares arc

13
( .

21
'

17^
'

10

10

lOy

ARITHMETICS.
33.
be

BOOK

IV.

201
if given

To divide unity into two parts snch


to each,

that,

numbers
be

added

the j)roduct

of

the resulting expressions

may

square.

Let

3,

5 be the
(a;

numbers
3) (6

to be added,

aud
a;'

let

the parts be

-xj
say.

Therefore

a;)

= 18 + 3x

- a square =

l.c*

Hence 18 +

3a;

= 5a;*; but

5 comes from a S([uare+1,

and

the roots cannot be rational unless


(this

square

+l)18 +

[7jj

=a

square.

Put
or

(m-

+l)18 + f^j =a

square,
(8ni

72/?r

+ 81 = a square =
i

9)* say.

Therefore

1 8.

Hence we must put (x + 3) (6 - a;) = 18 +


Therefore
Therefore
325x''

3a;

3a; - a;' - 18 = 0.

324a;^

78

sohition.

31.

[Another solution of

the foregoing.]

Suppose the

first
a;

a;

(9
9a;,

- 3, the second i -x; - a;) = square = 4a;* say,


9

therefore

and 9

5a;-

whence a;=p, but I cannot


4.

take 2

from

and X must be > 3 <


a;

Now

the value of
a;

comes from

9
r
1
.

Therefore, since
2.

a square +

>

3,

this S(piare

<

3,

therefore the square <

It is

also

>

5
-.
.

Therefore I mustfind a square between

-and

2,

or

^^

and

And

-TT-r-

or

64

will satisfy the conditions. ^ 16

Put now

x(9-x)-

j^,

.c.

202
Therefore

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

U4 IT
/21 21
20^ 20\
, .
1 .

and
35.

.,-

IS

a solution,

^.

To divide a given number

into three j)arts such that the pro-

duct of the first

and

second, with the third

added or subtracted,

may

be

a square.

Given number
less

G,

tlie 2,

third part x, the second

any niimher

than

G,

say

Therefore the

first

x.
it

Hence
of

2x'

a; =

a square. \^Doid)le-equation.^

And

cannot

be solved by

our method since the ratio of


ratio of squares.

tlie coefficients

X is not a number y to

Therefore

we must

find a

replace 2, such that


squai-e

?/ + 1 r = a 2/-1

= 4
,

say.

Therefore

2/

-iy

5 o

4,

and y =

5
q

Put now the second part = - therefore the


,

first

13

~ x. o

G5
Therefore
-^

-^x^x^^s. square.

Thus
or ^

are both squares,

~
i^

2G0-24:x)

.^l-

are both squares

difference

=195 = 15.
a;

13.

Hence

(^^^

~ Y = 65 - 24a;,
/5
5
,

and

24a;

64,

=|

8\
,

Therefore the parts arc

^j

To find two numbers such that the first with a ce^-tain fraction 36. of the second is to the remainder of the second, and the second with the same fraction of the first is to the remainder of the first, each in given
ratios.

Let the first with the fraction of the second = 3 times the remainder of the second, and the second with the same fraction of tlie first = 5 times the remainder of the first. Let the second = x +
be
1.

1,

and

let

the part of

it

received by the

first

Therefore the

first

3.c

[for 3.f

3.c].

. .

ARITHMETICS.
Also
fii-st

1U)0K

IV.

203
tlie

+ second -

ix, uiul first

+ second = sum of

numbers

after interchange, therefore

J^I$^^S^l_
remainder of
tiret

^q

Therefore the remainder of the first


receives from the first 3.0

= ^x, and

hence the second

- ^ x- = r a; o o

Hence

l^^^^,

6x-\

x+\

r, tlierefore r,x^

tx~\ = 3.c 3

and x = ^
Therefore the
first

number =

8
-;; ,

and the second =

-''t

12
:

and

is

<

rr-

of the second.

Multiply by 7 and the numbers are

8,

12; and the fraction


3,

is

^
and

but 8

is

not divisible by 12, so multijily by

(24, 36) is a solution.

To find two numbers 37. sum = a given number.


Given number
Therefore
3a;
8.

indefinitely such their product + their

Assume
3

the

first

to be x, the second 3,
8.

+ a; +

= given number =

Therefore x-'j, and the numbers are

Now

4
1

8 3
arises

from
1

-.

3+1
1

!r

Therefore
1
1

we may put mx + n ^
"^

for

the second number, and

tiie

nrst

z'

=8~

("**-'

'"
)

mx + n+l

r-

38.

To

find three

numbers such that

(the product

+ the sum) of

any two equals a given number.


Condition.

Each number must be


first

1 less

than some

squai-o.

Let product + sum of

and second =

8,

of second and tbinl

Thi-n

15, of third

and

first

24.

second +

= the

first: let

the second

= x-

1.

Therefore ^-"^-

first

--1.
X

Similarly third

-1.
'-

204
Therefore

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
(^^

V^ - l) + ^ = -.
.

= 24, and ^.^ -

24,

12
o
,

therefore
,

aj

and
39.

/33
I

7 ^

68\
, 1

IS

, a solution,

^.

To

find

exceeds their

sum by
first

two numbei-s indefinitely such that a given number.

their product

Let the

number be

x,

the second
3

3.

Therefore product

- sum =
Thus the

3.V - a; -

3 = 2a; -

=8

(say).

Therefore x

= -.

first

tlie

second

=
+
1

3.

But
the

=
=
x+
d
.

:r

Hence, putting the second =


40.

a;

first

To

find three

numbers such that the product

of

any two

exceeds their

sum by a given number.


1 less

Condition.

Each of the given numbers must be some square. Let them be 8, 15, 24.
Therefore
first

than

number =
9 -

second -

:;

=-

=
a;

say.

Therefore

the

first

=
+

X
1

the second

= a; +

and the third =

IG + X

Therefore

('^

V^ + l) - ^ Ij', 5
.

24.

Orl4i-ll24,
X-

md

/57
(

17

(l2'

q-s

is a ,,.,,_) 5'12;^^^

9Z\

solution.

41. To find two numbers sum a given ratio.

indefinitely

whose product has

to their

Let the ratio be 3


Therefore 5x

li

the

first

number
15
.

x,

the second

5.

=3
,

(5

+ x), and x =

r,ut -^

r~~:^

and, putting x for

5,

the indefinite solution

is: first

Xo

-^_

second =x.

ARITUMETICS.
42.

BOOK
for

IV.

205

To
_

find three

numbers such that

any two their product

bears to

theii-

sum

a given ratio.

first

Let

and second multiplied 5 = nrst + st^cond

6,

and

let

the other ratios be

4 and
4a;

5,

the second

number

.r.

Therefore

first

X3

third

~
Also

x-i'
3x
-.

x-Z

Therefore x
,

3x 4a; \ . ix ^ , 5+ r) or ,12xj = 5 { x -/ a;\a;-3 \a; o a;-4 4/ 120


-^,
,

35.0-'

20.r.

/360

120

""n^'
43.
to the

23'
three

480\ 28;"''^'''"^^'^"".

To find

numbers such
a given
ratio.

that the

product of any two hs

sum of the

three

Let the ratios be

3, 4, 5.

First seek three

numbers such that

the product of any two has to an arbitrary the given ratio.

number

(say 5)

Of

these, let the product of the first

and the second =15.


Therefore
if

x = the second, the

first

15

X
20.

But

the second multiplied by the third

Therefore the third -

20

and

20 15
"^^^

= 25.
is

or

Therefore

25.v'=20.15.
.

And,

if

20 15 were a square, what

required would be done.


is

Now

15 = 3.5 and 20
3
;

5,

and 15

made up

of the ratio

and the arhilrary number

5.

Therefore

we must

find a

number m such

12r
that

= ratio of
m=
15.

a square to a square.

Thus

2/?r

5i

= GOm'

- square

900/', say.

Tliereforo

Let then the sum of the three =15, and the product of the first and sccon<l =
first

15, therefore

tli

X
tlio

Simihirlv

third

GO X

,
;

45. GO

_. ^
<

therefore

>

and x ^

(.

G.

206

DIOPUANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Therefore the
first

number =-

45
,

the third

10,

and the sum

of the three

= 23| =

47
.

Now, if

this loere 15,

the j)rohlevi loould he solved.

Put therefore 15a; for the sum of the numbers l^x, Qx, \0x.
Therefore

tlirce,

and

for the

2^x =

15a;-,

47 and x=---,

whence

/705

282

470\
is

fgQ-,3Q,3QJ
three

a sohition.

44.

To find

numbers such

that the product of their


their sn7n

sum and
a

the first is

a triangular number, that of


that of their su7h

and

the secoml

square,

and

and

the third

cube.

Let the sum be

x',

and the

first ,

the second

-,

the third

.r

which will
1

satisfy the three conditions.

But the sum =3 =


X
Therefore
loe

.r*

or 18

= x\

must

rejilace

IS by a fourth iiower.

But 18 = sum

of a triangular number, a square and a cube;

let the fourth power be x^, which must be made up in the same way, and let the square be x* -1o? + 1. Therefore the triangular number + the cube = 2a;* 1; let the cube But 8 be 8, therefore the triangular number = 2a;^ - 9. limes a triangular number + 1 = a square.

Therefore

IG.x'^ - 71 = a square = (4a;- 1)^ say; therefore x = 9, and the triangular number = 153, the square =6400 and the cube = 8.

Assume

tlien as the first

number -^-,
x'
'

as the second

a'

as the third -3

Therefore

- =
a;

a;*

and x =

9.

,,,,

/153

6400

8\

^.

ARITHMETICS.
45.

BOOK

IV.

207

and

the

To find three numbers such that the dijj'crence of the greatest middle has to tlie difference of the middle and the least a given
also the sinn of
3.

ratio,

and

any pair

is

a square.
square, let

Ratio

Since middle
;

number + lea.st = a
let it

them =

l.

Therefore middle > 2

be x +

2,

so that least

= 2 - x.
6a-,

Therefore the interval of the greatest and the middle =

whence the greatest = Tx +


Therefore
'

2.

>

are both squares [Donble equation]

take

two numbers Avhose product =


ceed by the rule.
Therefore

2x,

say - and
112,
biit

4,

and

pro-

I cannot take \\2 from 2; therefore x must be found to be < 2, so that 6.f+4<lG.
to be three squai-es 8a;

x=

Thus there are


middle and
Therefore

difference of greatest
least.

+ 4, Gx + 4, 4 ami and middle = ^ of difference between


;

we must

find three squares having this proi)erty,

such that the least

= 4 and
s

the middle one

<

1 6.

Let side of middle one be

+
2

2,

wlience the gi'eatest

is

equal to

+ 42 + _32^

.^

+ 4. +

16, 4 4^-+ -3-c--.4.


,

Therefore this

is

a square, or 3^* +

1 2s;

+ 9 = a square; but the


1 6,

middle of the required squares <

therefore z <'2.
(jmz

Put now

3i' +

2s

Therefore z

=
4.5
;

9
"

= {mz - 3) = mV ,

9.

m o

which must be <


6,

2.

Hence 6m + 12 < 2m- and 18 2 +


.

or 2m

> 6m +

18,

3-

therefore

we may put in-'- +


- bz)'.

^.

Thus we have

3;:-

+ 12^ + 9 =

(3

Hence

yi

-'^'i^l

the side of the middle square

--

...

aiil

the square

itselr

Turning

to the original problem,

wo

i>ut

y^j'^

^'-"

Therefore x

' ,

which

is

<

2.

<26

208
Hence

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
the greatest of the required

numbers

= 7x +

--

11007
726
'

and the second of them = as + 2 =


and the
46.
thii'd

2817
,

lab

87 = 2-x = ^^z

the f/reatcst

To find three numbers such that the and the middle numbers has to
a given
ratio,

difference

the difference

of the squares of of the middle

and

the least

and

the

sums of

all 2}airs are severally

squares.

Ratio

3.

greatest

Let greatest + middle = the square 1 (Sx^. Therefore Hence middle = Bx* - 2, is > 8a;^, say 8a;" + 2,

and greatest + middle > greatest + least, therefore greatest + least < 1 6a;* > Sx^ = 9a;-, say; therefore the least

number = a; - 2.

Now
Now

difference of squares of greatest


difference of middle

and middle =
but 64 ^ 21.
find a
.

64a;*,

and

and
2,

least

7a;",

64 comes from 32
such that

so that I

must
.

number

32m =
that
,

21.

Therefore
gi'eatest
8a;

21

Assume now

the

of

the
,

numbers

sought

8a;*

+ -^ =

21

the middle =

,21 -

the least

a;

21

[Therefore difference of squares of greatest and middle

21a;*

3.

7a;*.]

The only condition


8a;*

left is

21

p+

a;*

21
-gT,

a square

9.1;

= a square =
597 x = yr:^ 5/6
.

{S.r

6)" say.

r,.,

Therefore

"^'"^^

2633544 (331776' 331776


/3069000

138681\
'

^.

331776;^^''^

^^^^^^'^"-

AIUTILMETICS.

BOOK

V.

BOOK
To find three numbers 1. number by a square.
Given number
square [by
the third
12.
ii.

V.

in c.

p.

such that each exceeds a given

11],

Find a square which exceeds 12 by a say 42^. Let the first number be 42^,

x^,

so that the middle one


12")

6i.r.

a;2_

Therefore .

,_> are both squai-es

their diflference

therefore as usual

we

find the value of x, viz.

^^

(^21,^^,

A^,

2346 i

130321\
-10816

j-^
.

solution.

2. To find three numbers in g. same given number equals a square.

p.

such that each together

icith the

Given number

20.

square, say 36, so that IG

Take a square whicli exceeds 20 by a + 20 - 3G = a square.


16, the other x*, so that the

Put then one of the extremes


middle term = \x.
Therefore

+ 20 ^^> are both squares \x + 20j


"i

their difference

y?

-ix^x{x4a;

4),

whence we have
result,

+ 20 =

4,

which gives an irrational

but the 4^1(16), and we should have in i)lace of 4 some number > 20. Therefore to replace 16 we must find some square > 4 20, and such that with the addition of
.

20

it

becomes a square.
therefore,

Now 81>80;
{m +
9)-, (4
.i, "

putting for the

nijuired square

m=
H.D.

+ 20 = square -{m-U)' .siiy. Therefore OOj. and the square = (9A)'' "

9)'

1*

, ,

210

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Assuming now
9^a;+20j
^^
>

for

the

numbers 90^, O^x,


:

a?,

we

have,

are both squares

and the difference =a;(a;-9i),

whence we derive

x=

-r-

152

, '

^^
3.

/nm
V
^^'

389.1

1681 \
'

T52

23I04J

^^

'^^^^^"^-

Givoi one numhei;


the

them or

to find three others such that any one of product of any two, when added to the given number, pro-

duces a square.

Given number
the two

5.

Porism.

pi'oduct together with the

numbers
{x

arise

two numbers each and their same number make squares, from two consecutive squares.
If of

Assume then a;^+6cc +


Therefore

+ 3)-, {x + 4)-, and put for the first number 4, and for the second a; + 8x+ll, and let the third equal twice their sum minus 1, or ix^ + 28a; + 29.
4a;'

28a;

+ 34 = a square = (2x a;

6)^ say.

Hence
and
4.

^r^;

26
/2861
I

7645
,

20336\
.

-;r=-;r

-sv^/T

V676

'

676

'

Wr,,^

IS

a solution.

,.

676 /

the product of any two exceed the given

Given one number, to find three others such that each, and number by some square.
a;* a;*

Given number 6. Take two consecutive squares x", add 6 to each, and let the first number =
second number
the

+ 2a; + 1, + 6, the
+
25.

= a;^ +

2a;

7,

the third being equal to twice


1,

sum

of first

and second mhiics


4a;

or

4a;^

4a;

Therefore third minus 6 =4a;' +


Therefore
a;

+ 19 = square =(2a; -6)* say.

17
:

*^^

22660\ /4993 6729 (-784' T84' -78r)-^-'^<^l"*^^^.

[Observe in this problem the assumption of the Porism numbered


(1)

above
5.

(pp. 122, 123).]

To find
Porism.

three sqiiares such thai the procbict of

any

tivo,

added

to the

sum of those

two, or to the remaining one, gives

a square.

If any

two consecutive squares be taken, and a third


their

number which exceeds twice

sum by

2, tliese

three

ARITHMETICS.

BOOK

V.

211
numbers
recpiired

numbers have the property


the problem.

of the

by

Assume

as the

first

a;^

'2a;

and as the second

x"

+ 4x +

4.

Therefore the third

Ax^

1 2x-

1 2.

Hence
c

x-

3.v

+ 3 = a square -{x/25
(

'df say,

and

a;

= ^

m iherefore
C.

>

64 'K

196\
>

~q~

^^

'^

solution.

To

find three

numbers such that each exceeds

by a square,

and the product


one

of

any two minus both, or minus the remaining

a square.

Add

2 to x^
all

2,

numbers found as in 5th problem. Let the first be the second x^ +'2x+ 3, the third ^if + -ix + 6, and

the conditions are satisfied, except

4x^

4a;

+ 6 - 2 = a square = 4

(a;

2)* say.

Therefore

x=
/59
(,25'

3
-^

o
.

^^^
7.

114

246\
25

25'

''

^'

'^"^^""-

To

find

two numbers such that the sum of


is

their product

and

the squares of both


First

a square.

[^Lemma

to the following j)roblem.^


1.

number
a;'

x,

second any number {m), say

Hence

a;

= a square = {x
1]
is

2)- say,

and

-c

3
r
.

Therefore

a sokitiou, or

(3, 5).

8.

To find

three right-angled triangles

'

whose areas are equal.

First find

two numbers such that

their product

+ sum

of their

squares

a square,
[15

i.e.

3, 5, as in

the preceding problem

3'

5^'=

7'].

Now

form three right-angled triangles from


(7, 3),
i,e.

(7,

5),

(7,

3 +

5),

respectively,
(7

the triangles
3',

+ 3S 7*-

2.7.3),
Ax
<tll

Ac.

I.e.

rational right-angled triangles.

the triangles ichich Diophantos

treats of are of this kind,

I shall

sometime.'^ use

mimphj the tcord "triannU" to

represent "rational right-angled triangle," for the purposes of brevity,

where

the latter expression

is

of very frequent occurrence.

14-2

212

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
and we have the triangles
(40,

42, 58), (24, 70, 74), (15, 112, 113)

and the area of each = 840. [7^ - 3=) 7 3 - (7' - 5^) 7 5 =


.

(8=

7')

7].

['For

if

ah + 0?-^ 1)^=0%
a')

(c-

ca

{c'

since each
9.

- 6=) cb = {{a + bf - c'] = abc (a + 6)].

(a

b)

c,

To

find three

numbers such that the square of any one


square.

=t

the

sum

of the three

= a

Since, in a right-angled triangle, (hypotenuse)^

of sides = a square, we

twice product make the three numbers hypotenuses,


area.
i.e.

and the sum of the three four times the


as in the preceding problem,
(40, 42, 58),
(24,

Therefore I must find three triangles having the same area,

70, 74),

(15, 112, 113).

Therefore, putting for the

245a;

numbers 5 803, 74a;, 113C, their sum = four times the area of any one of the triangles

= 33G0a;^anda; = Qg.
Therefore
10.

[-^

W WJ
it is

^'

^ '^^^^^"-

Given three squares,

possible to find three

numbers

such that the products of the three pairs are respectively equal to
those squares.

Squares

4, 9, IG.

One number

x,

4 the second a;

9
,

the third -

and
1

-^=16, and
x^
'

a;

li. ^

the triangles formed from (n m),


therefore n (m^ 11^)

Ncsselmann suggests that Diophantos discovered this as follows. (q in), (r m) have their areas equal,

Let

=q

{vi^

q'')

(r"

//(-),

therefore m-n

Jt-'

m-q

q^,

m^=Again, given
[q

n-q

i =,r-

+ nq + q^.

m
q

?i).

to find r;
q'^)

[m"-

= r(r- - m"),

and
n^

in- -q''

n- + nq

from above, therefore


or

q (nq
{n'^

+ nq) = r (;- -

- nq - q"),

+ nr) + q'^(n + r) = r{r^-}i-).


qn + q- = r^ {q

Dividing by
therefore

+ n,

rn,
q-,

+ r)n = r-r=q

and

+ n.

ARITHMETICS.
Therefore the niuiibers are

BOOK

V.

213

(l.l,

, 6).

We

observe that
4

'C

= -, where

= product

of

2,

3,

and

= side
rule.

of

1 G.

Hence

Take the product

of the sides, 2, 3, divide by tlio

side of the third square,


result. 11.

and divide

4,

9 again by the

To

find three

the

sum

of the three

numbers such = a square.

that

tlie

product of any two

As

in 9th problem, find three riglit-anglcd triangles having

equal areas

the squares of the hypotenuses are 3364,

5476, 127G9.

Now

find as in 10th

problem three num-

bers, the products of paii-s of

which equal these squares, which we take because each (4. area) or 3360 = a square;
the three numbers then are

4292
"113
'^'

3277
37
""'

4181

^'

It only remains that the

sum =

3360a;".

f Therefore

32824806 ._. , -^t^t-^-t?^ x- 3360x". 121249


32824806 407396640'

^, , Therefore

whence the numbers are known.


12.

To divide unity
he

into two parts such

tJvat

if the same given

number

added

to eitlier

part the result will be a square.


[the text of

Condition.

this condition is discussed

The added number must not be odd on p. 129 and note.]


6.
6. 1,

Given number

Therefore 13 must be divided into two

two squares so that each > squares whose difference <

Thus

if

I divide

13 into

this condition is satistied.

Take -^ =
will
or,

13

6|,

and I wish
it

to

add to 6i a small fraction which

make

a square,
4,

multiplying by
26x*

wish to make ;, + 2G a square, or


Siiy,

=a

square = {5x+\ )'

whence

x=

10.

214

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Therefore to

make 2G

into a square I

must add

y^,

or to

make 6^

into a square I
1

must add
/51\'

400^

^^^
Tlierefore

13

4o-o-'-2=Uo;I must divide


1

3 into two squares such

tluit

their sides

Tnay be as nearly as possible equal


dywyrj,

above described, pp. 117


3^

^ 120.]
to
first

51

[TrapicronjTos

Now

13
3

= 2^ +

Therefore I seek two numbers such that


first

minus the

51

or

the

=
11

and 2 plus

the second
I

51

so that the second

write

accordingly

(11a +2), (3

9a;)

for

the

required

squares

substituting x for

Therefore the

sum =
5
,

202a;-

lO-i;

+ 13 =

13.

Hence

x = y^

and the

,^,

sides are y^.

.,

257
'

258
Tni

and, subtracting 6 from the squares of each,


pai-ts of

we

find as the

unity
/

4843
'

^35810201,

V10201
13.

To divide unity

into two jyarts such that, if

we add given

numbers

to each, the results

are both squares.


2, G,

Let the numbers be


figure.

and

let

them be represented

in the

Suppose

so chosen

DA = 2, AB = l, BE=G, G a point in Now that DG, GE may both be squares.

Tlierefore

I have
lies

to divide

9 into
3.

tioo

squares such that one of

them Let the

between 2

and
be

hitter square

x^.
3. tlie

Therefore the second square

= 9 - a;',
Take two

wliere

x-"

> 2< >


2,

squares, one

other <

3,

[the former square

ARITHMETICS.
being the smaller], say ^

BOOK
,

V.

21')

-^^

Therefore,

if

we can

make

x" lie

between

these,

what

wtis required is

done

We must

have

^^^,<\l
17

Hence, in making 9 - x^ a square, we must find


19

67)1

^?Tl
17

19

>12"I2Thus 72w>17m'' +
'^

17,
is :}

and

36*-

17. 17

= 1007
is
-j;

which'

is

Sl,

hence

x=

Similarly ?

tt;

Let

m = 3i

Therefore 9 -x' =

h - '-x\

and
TT Hence

53
1371\
' "

=Ti

ar

7056 ^ ^^^^

/1438 , ^ and the segments of 1 are


,^, (^^gog
into three pm-ts such that, if
severally/, the results

2809J
the

14.

To divide unity
to the three

we add

same

number

parts

are all squares.

Comlition.

Given number must not be 2

[Condition remarked

upon above, pp. 130, 131.] Given number 3. Thus 10


such that each

is

to be divided into three squares

>

3.

Take ^ of

10, or 3^,

and

find

x so that ^^7,+ 3J may be a square,

or 30x

= a square = {6x
a;

+\f

say.

Therefore
1

2,
s^^''^^"^-

121
'*'

and
Therefore

36

^^ " "36" " ^

we have

to divide 10 into three squares each near to

00
I.e.

[7rapio-OT7;T09 aywyr;'].

the integral part of the root

is

^31.

The

limits taken arc

.1

fortiori

limits as explained on p. 93, n. 3

and

4.

Strictly speaking,
is

wc could only

say,

taking integral limits, that x/Iu07<32, but this limit


secure a correct result in the work which follows.

not narrow enough to

21

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Now

10 =

3^

1'

= the sum
3

9
of the three squares 9,

^,

16

Comparing the
90, 18,

sides 3, -, p

with -^, or (multiplying by 30)

11

24 with 55, we must make each side approach 55.

Put

therefore for the sides

3-35CC, 31a; + g, S7x+-^


[35

= 90-55, 31 = 55-24, 37 = 55-18],


the

we have

sum of the squares = 35550;^- 116rK+ 10 =


x = ^rv^3555
,

10.

Therefore

and

this solves the problem.


if

To divide unity into three parts such that, 15. numbers be added, each to one of the parts, tlie
squares.

three given

results are all

Given numbers

2, 3, 4.

Then
first

have to divide 10 into three


2,

squares such that the

>

the second

>

3,

the third

>

4.

Let us add - unity to each, and


is

find three squares


2,

whose sum

10,

the

first

lying between

2^,

the

and the third between 4, 4|. Divide 10 into two squares, one of which lies between 2 and
second between
3, 3i,

2^.

Then this square minus 1 will give one of the parts of unity. Next divide the other square into two, one lying between
3,

3J

this gives the second part,

and therefore the

third.

16.

To

divide a given

number

into three parts such that the

sums of all

pairs are squares.

Number 10. Then since the greatest + the middle jmrt = a square, &c., the sum of any pair is a square < 10, but There/ore 20 is to he twice the sum of the three = 20,
divided into
three squares

each of lohich < 10.


divide

Now
two

20=16 +

4.

Therefore

we must

16

into

and 10; we then have three squares each of which is < 10, and whose sum = 20, and by subtracting each of these squares from 10
squares, one of which lies between 6

we

get the parts required;


v.

[16 must be divided into the two squares by

13.]

ARITHMETICS.
17.

ROOK

V.

217

To divide a given number


is

into four parts such that the

sum

of any three

a square.
10.

Number

Then three times

the

sum =

the

sum

of four

squai'es.

Hence 30 must be divided into four squares, eacli of wliich < 10. If we use the method of Tra^icro'-nj? and make each
near 7|, and then subtract each square found from 10, wc have the required i)arts.
But, observing that

30-1G + 9 + 4+1,

take

i,

and divide

17 into two squares each of which < 10 >


tract each of the four squares

7.

Then

sub-

from 10 and we have the

required parts.
18.
to the

To find

three

numbers

S2ich that, if
is

we add any one of them


G3x^.

cube of their sum, the result

cube.
26a;',

Let the sum be


fore it

x,

the numbers 7x^,

Hence,

for the

last condition, 9Ga;^

= x.

But 9G

is

not a square.

ThereG3.

must be

replaced.

Now

it

arises

from 7 + 2G +
1 less

Therefore I have to find three numbers, each

than a cube,

whose sum is a square. Let the sides of the cubes be wi+ 1, 2-m, 2, whence the numbers are m^ + 3'w' + 3m, 7- 12ni+ Gnr-m'', 7, aud the sum = ^m" - dm + 14 = a square = (3? - 4)-.
Therefore
7n

2
-r-.

15

and the numbers are


Therefore, putting the

1538
qq^t>

18577

^
'

qqtF

'

sum -

x,

and the numbers of the problem


'"'''*''

3375^' 3375

we
1

find

X=

15

54

therefore,

fec.

9.
t/ie

To find tloree numbers such


cube of the sum, the result
x,

t/uif,

if we subtract
cube.
x',

any one of them

from

is

Let the sum be


r Therefore
rr.

the numbex"8 -

"

x',

x'.

4877

^r^;-- x"

^x

/
;

|(

.io

4877
but
irz^TT-,

1728

^ 3 - the sum of three cubes.

218

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Therefore we must find three cubes, each < 1, such that (3 -their sum) = a square =2,^ say. Tlierefore we liavetofind three
cuhes whose

sum

is

3 162 -=^,

or

we have

to divide

162

into three cubes.

But 162 = 125 + 64 -

27.

Now

(Porism) the difference of two cuhes can be transformed Having then found the three into the sum, of two cuhes.
cubes

we

start again,

and x = 1\x^,

so that

x = -^, which, with the three

cubes,

determines the result.


20.
tlieir

To find

three

numbers such

that,

if we subtract the cube of

sum from any


39 x^

one of them, the result


let

is

cube.
9a;^, 28a;^.

Sum =x, and

the numbers be 2x',

Therefore
three

= 1, and we must replace 39, which = sum of cubes + 3. Therefore we must find three cubes whose sum +
square.

Let their sides be m, 3 -m, and any number, say


Therefore

1.

9m^ + 31 ,

277/2-

= square = (3m ^.1


,

7)"

say,

so

that

m-

and

6 the sides of the cubes are =


,

..

9
,

1.

Starting again, let the

sum be
3

x,

and the numbers


250
3

341

854

Wb^'
so that
1445a;'
=^

125*' 125*'
25 ^''=289' ^

125,

"

17

thus the numbers are known.


21.

To

find three

numbers, whose sum

is

a square, such that the

cube of their sum added to any one of them gives a square.

Let the sum be


26a;*

x^,

the numbers
if

303',

Bx",

IS.'c".

Therefore

and,

26 were a fourth power, this would

give the result.

To

replace it

by a fourth power, wc must find three squares whose sum diminished by 3 = a fourth power, or thi-ee numbers such that each increased by 1 - a square, and Let these he the sum of the three - a fourth power.

'

ARITHMETICS.

ROOK
[sura

V.

219
;

m* -

2ni^,

m^ + 2m, m^ - 2m
3,

^ m*]

then

if

we put

anything, say
the numbers are

63,

15, 3.

Thus, putting for the


GSx",
a;

sum

x^,

and for the numbers


is

3j;',

15x',

and the problem

solved.

22.

that

tlie

To find three numbei-s whose sum equals a square, and such cube of the sum exceeds any one of them by a square.
[Incomplete in the text.]

23.

To

divide a given fraction into three parts, such that each

exceeds the cube of the

sum by a
.

square.

Given fraction
the

Therefore each =
the
three

of

+ a square.
three

Therefore
3

sum

of

= sum

squares +

Therefore

we have simply

to divide

into three squares.


13

24.

added

to

To find three squares such that any one of them gives a square.

tJieir

contimced product

Let the "solid content" = x", and we want three squares such that each increased by 1 gives a square. They can be got

from right-angled triangles by dividing the square of


one of the sides about the right angle by the square of Let the squares then be the other.
9
,

_25

16

'^'

144*' 225
14400

'*^-

Therefore the solid content =

x".

This =

x'.

Olo'iUU
^

120
Therefore
" oq

**

120

but

_g,

IS

not a square.
triangle.s
tlieir

Thus we must
if

find three right-angled

such

that,

6's

are

their
==

bases,

;/s

arc

p<'q)endicular8,

H/9^6,6, 6^

square, or assuming one tnangle arbitrarily


to

(3, 4, 5),

we have

make

or l2pj)J>J'j ^ square,

3,6,

220

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
a square. " This
is

easy" (Diophantos
(9, 40,

')

and the triangles

(3, 4, 5),

(8, 15, 17),

41),

satisfy the condition,

and
.1

03

= -^
25 /25
(

then are the squares .1

256
,

9\
,

-7-

-5,

Vr

To find three squares such 25. any one of them hy a square.


Let the " solid content " =

that their continued product exceeds

a;*,

and

let

the numbers be got fx'om

right-angled triangles, being namely

16 25^^' 169

_64

'^'

289^'
, a;

r Therefore

4.5.8
first side

r^

1,

and the

ought to be a square.

As

before, find three triangles,

assuming one
[letters

(3, 4, 5)

such that

hjiji^2^^pj>^=

Q.

square^,

denoting hypotenuses

and

bases], or

such that 20 v^-^ a square.


is

[For the rest the text

in a very unsatisfactory state.]

Diophantos does not give the work here, but merely the
is

results.

Moreover
is

there

a mistake in the text of

(5, 12, 13) for (H, 15, 17),

and the problem

not

finished.

Schulz works out this part of the problem thus Find two right-angled triangles whoso areas are in the ratio vi 1. Let the Bides of the first be formed from {2m + 1, m - 1), and of the second from (m 2, 7K-1), BO that two sides of the first are Am" -2m -2, ^m- + (im and the area
:

-f-

=6m' + 9Hi3-9,/i2-6m. Two sides of the second are

2m'^

+ 2m-i,
jft

G?;!

+ 3, and m times
the
first

the area

= Cm'* + 9m' - 9m- - Om.


formed from
2

Now

jmt e.g.
,'53)
;

= 3,

therefore
5,
(/,
'2,

k-ianglc is

7, 2, viz. (28, 4,5,

second from

viz. (20, 21, 29).


[i

Cossali remarks: "Construct the triangles

h,p)

= ipotenusa],

[-b
/ib^'

'

b
'

'

ir=^^j'
b

+ iip^

bAbp-p(b^-ip^)
b

^""^

[^b'

p Abp + b {b^ - ip-)

^^)'

,,\

ARITHMETICS.
26.

HOOK

V.

221

To

find three squares such that each exceeds tlicir continued


" = a;', and the squares have to be found by means of the same triangles as before. We put 25x*,

product by a square.

Let the "solid content

625a;-, 1 4784a;- for

them, ic.

[Text again corrupt.]


27.

To

find three
1 is

squares such that the product of any two

increased by

a square.
fii-st

Product of

and second +

= a

square, and the third

is

a square.
Therefore solid content + each = a square
reduces to the 24th above.
28.
;

and the pnjblem

To

find three squares such


1 is

that the product of any two

diminished by

a square.

[Same as 25th problem.]


or the solid content of the three hypotenuses has to that of the three perpendiculars the ratio of a square to a square.

It is in his

note on this imperfect problem that Fermat makes the error


above.

which

I referred to

He

says on the problem of finding

tico triiuujks

such

and one t<ide of each have a given ratio "This question troubled me for a long time, and any one on trying it will find it very difficult but I have at last discovered a general method of sohing it. "Let e.g. ratio be 2. Form triangles from (ab) and (a d). The rectangles under the hypotenuses and the perpendiculars are respectively 2ba^ + 2lPa,
that the products of hij2)otcnuse
:

2da^ + d^a, therefore since the ratio


transposition 2<P

is 2,

ba^ + b^a

= 2(da' + d^a),
Ij3

therefore

by
tho

-P = ba^ - 2da^

therefore, if -

2(P _

y-

be

made a

square,

problem

will be solved. Therefore I have to find two cubes <P, IP such that 2(P-h^ divided or multiplied by b-2d-a. square. Let x + 1, 1 be the sides,

therefore

2d3-63 = 2x3 + Cx= + Cx + l, 2b-d^l-x^


therefore

(l-a;)(l

+ 6a; + 6x' + 2x3) = l + 5x-4x3-2r-square=^|x + l-^V)


2d,

and everything is clear." [Now Fermat makes the mistake of taking 2b - d instead o{ hhe
fails to solve

and thus

tho problem.

Brassinnc (author of a
(1

Pr<Jci3 of

DiophantoH and

Fermat) thinks to mend the matter by milking


square, whereas, the quantity to be

made

a square

is (1

+Gx + 6x + 2r>)(l +2x) a + 6x + Ox' + 2x^1 { - 1 - 2x).

The solution is thus incurably wTong.] Fermat seems afterwards to have discovered
the solution
is

that his solution did not help to

solve this particular problem of Diophantos, but docs not

seem

to have seen that

inconsistent with his

own problem

itself.

222
29.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
To
find three squares such that unity diminished

by the

product of any two = a square,

[Same

as (26).]

Given a number, find three squares such that the 30. two together with the given number jyroduces a square.

sum of any
squares =9.

Given number

15.

Let one of

the

required

Therefore I must find two other squares, such that each

Take + 24 = a square, and their sum + 15 = a square. two pairs of numbers whose product = 24, and let them
be the sides of a right-angled triangle' which contain 4
the right angle, say ,

Gx

let the side of

one square be

2 half the difierence, or -

3a;.

X
8x,

Again, take other

factoi'S

and

half

the

difierence

3
4:X

= side
\^
4ccj

of the other square, say.

2x
/ 3

Therefore (^
or

g ^
,

+(

/2

\"
3a; j

+15 = a

square,

-f

+ 25a;^ - 9 = a square =
and the problem
to

25a;^ say.

Therefore x =
31.

is solved.

Given a number,
exceeds the given

find

three squares such that the

sum of

any pair

number by a

square.

Given number 13. Let one of the squares be 25. Therefore we must seek two more such that each + 12 = a square, and (sum of both) - 13 ^ a square. Divide 12 into products
(3a;,

-) and

(4a;,

-J,

and

let

the squares be

/3 Therefore (^

a;

- -j +
a;"

2\"

/
(

2a;

- .^ j - 13 =
'^

3 \"

a square,

or
Therefore x
1

^ + 61
a;"

- 25 = a square = -|
XT
is

say.

2,

and the problem

solved.
G.r,

I.

c. corrcspoudiug factors in the

two pairs, in this case

Sj.

AllITHMETICS.
32.

BOOK

V.

223
squares
is

To find

three squares such that the

sum of thdr
9.

mare.

Let one be

x",
a;*

the second

4,

the third
(x'
^^

Therefore

+ 97 = a square =

10)* say.

Therefore

^''

2o>

^"*

*^--^

^^ot

a square and must be

replaced.

Hence I have
square.

to

find

p*,

q*

and

such that
;:'

"^~ ^ ^^ = a 2m

Let ;r = s-,
(*

m''-;/-5' =
^ave,
,

q' = \, and //t = + 4. Therefore + 4)*-s--16 = 8c'. Hence we must

8'

ggT^g = ^
s'

square, or

4;:^

=a

square.

Put

+ 4 = (;s+l)say.
,

Therefore s =

and the squares are

i^"

=t
(7'

q^

4,

and
25.

m=
third

25
-Y,
or,

taking 4 times each, ^r =


first

9,

= IG,

7?i =:

Starting again, put the

square

= :<r,

the second
=-

^
x*

9,

the

{x'

= 16, whence - 25)^

the

sum

of the squares

+ 337

Therefore

12
\

and
33.

'144 /144
f

-^

,9, 16

j is

a sol ution.

[Fpigra7n-problem].

'OKTaSpd^ov;

Koi.

TrevraSpa^ovs ^oeas

tis ffii^f.

Toi? TrpoTToXolcn ttuIv XPV^"^' a^rora^a/xcvos. Kat Tifxrjv airihoiKcv vwlp iravruiv jiTpaymvov,

Tas

iTTLTaxOeLcra^ Be^d/Jievov /iovaSas,


(re

Kat

TToiovvTa ttuXiv erepoV


KT7]adfj.evov

(f)ipiiv

TtTpdywvov
;(0'a)v.

nkivpdv

crvvdeixa

twv

'flare StacrreiXov toOs OKTaSpd^fiov^ ttoVoi ^crav,

Kai

TrdXc tovs Irepovs irai kiye irevTiSpaxfiovi.


{iinTaxOela-ai. fiovaScs)

Let the given number


:

be 60.
of

The
;^dc?

meaning is A man buys a certain number wine, some at 8 draclnnas, the rest at 5 eacli. And for them a square number of drachmas. 60 to this number the result is a stjuare whose

of

He
if

pays

we add
= the

side

224

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
whole number of
at each price.
xo'es.

Required how many ho bought


a"

Let X = the whole number of xo'es. Therefore


paid, wliich
is

- 60 = the
-

price

a square, (x

- m)"

say.

Now

of the price

of the five-drachma xoes

o of the price of the eight-

drachma
unless

xo'es

X.

We
GO)

cannot have a rational solution

ic

>

Q (x"

<g

{x^

60).

Therefore

+ 60 < 8x + 60. x" = 5a; + a number > 60, or x is' -^ 11. Hence 8a; + 60. a;Also Therefore a; is 12, so that x must lie between 11 and a;'-60=(a;-^)^ But
a;'

>

5a;

-f:

:|

12.

therefore

a;=

which > 11, <

12,

whence

vf + 60 > 22m < 24??t. From these we find, m is not > 21, and not < x' - 60 = {x - 20)', Hence we put a; = 11^. and Thus a;^-132i, a;^- 60 = 721,
and 72^ has
the
first

19.

to be divided into

two numbers such that

of

Q of the second

11 A.

Let the

first

z.

Therefore

'

225

BOOK

VI.

1. To find a rational right-anfjkd triamjle such that nuse exceeds each side by a cube.

the hypote-

Suppose a triangle formed from


Therefore hypotenuse
=.x--+ 9,

tlie

two numbei-s

x, 3.

perpendicular = G.r, base=x'-9.

Therefore by the question x^ + 9 - (x*

9)

should

l)e

culx?,

or
3*,

18 should be a cube, which


therefore

it is not.

Now

18 = 2.

we must
; i.

replace the

number 3 by m, where
+
4, \x, x^

2r = a cube

e.

m = 2,
.r,

Thus, forming the triangle from

2, viz. (x"

4),

we must have a;" - 4a; + 4 a cube. Therefore {x - 2)- = a cube, or x-2 x =10, Hence
and the triangle
2.

a cube

-8

say.

is (40, 96, 104).

To

find a right-angled triangle such that the


is

sum

of the

hypotenuse and either side

a cube.

a triangle as before from two numbers, and one of them must be a number twice whose square - a cube, i.e. 2. Therefore, forming a triangle from x, 2, or (x' + 4, 4x, 4 - x*) we must have a;* + 4x + 4 a cube, and x^ < 4.
"

Form

Hence

a;

=a

cube, which

must be < 4 > 2

27
-^

say.

Therefore
.

^
,
.

"^

"s"

and the triangle

/135

is

(^_

-^ -

352
,

377\

To find a right-angled triangle such 3. and a given number is a square.


Let 5 be the given number,
Therefore
6 1*

that the

sum of the area

(3a;, 4a;, o.^)

the triangle.

+ 5 = square = 9x'
5
is

say.

Hence

3x-^

5,

and ^
find

not a square ratio.

Hence

must

a triangle

difference of the square of the

and a iuiml)er such that the number and the area of


e.

the triangle has to 5 a square ratio, L


..

- ^ of a square.
13

..

226

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

Form

from a triangle
1

x,
'

= ' then the area a;*


:

5,

and

let

the

a;'
-

number =x-i
or,

2.5
,

^.

so that i

.
.

-\

101
j-

= -

of a square,

2o +

15- = a

square

= (10 + j

Whence
The
triangle

cc

= -^
o

24
.

must therefore bo formed from -^


is
-7:7;
.

24
j

5
ni
>

and the number

oU
(Jix,

Put now

for the original triangle

2>x,

bx),

24

pbx'

where (hj^b) 170569

is
,

and we have the


4.

solution.

To find a right-angled given number by a square.

triangle such that its area exceeds a

Number

6,

triangle {3x, ix, 5x).


Gx^

Therefore

= square =

4aj* say.

Hence, as before, we must find a triangle and a number such


that the area of the triangle

- (number)^ =

-^

of a square.

Form

from the triangle


its

?,

7)1
fi

Therefore

area

= ju'
1)1,

:,,

and

let the

number he m--^.
z

Hence
or,

G (G \
36;>i"

s m.

- GO = a square =

(6i

2)*.

Therefore vi
the

.. ,

and the triangle must be formed from

(-^,

-A,

number being

5.

To

find a riglit-anglcd tri;nigle


S(juare.

such that a given number

exceeds the area by a

Number

10,

triangle

(3x',

ix,

5x).

Therefore

lO-Gx-'-a

square,

ARITHMETICS.
and a
triangle

BOOK

VI.

227
tli:it

and a number must be found sudi


-- of a square.

(nund.fr)*

+ area of triangle =
m,

Form a

triangle frum

- and
,

let

the

Dt

number be - + 5m.

Therefore
or
65i*

260i'

+ 25

^-

+ 100 = a square, a square = (8ni + 5)^

say.

Therefore

m - 80.
obvious.
triangle such that
is
th''

The
6.

rest

is

To find a right-angled
side*

sum of

the area

and one

about the right angle


7.

a given number.

Given number
therefore

Triangle {3x, 4x, 5x),

6x"+3c=7.

^j

+6.7

not being a square, is not possible.

Hence we must
,
,

siibstitute for (3, 4, 5) a right-angled triangle

/onesideX*
(

sucli that

^
I

times the area


1.

=a

square.

Let

one side be
Therefore
or

x, the other

^x + j =
is

a.

square,

lix +
rational,

= a square)
'

Also, since the triangle

x'+l = a squarei
14).

Now

the difference
7^

x^

lix = x(x~
24
-=-.

Therefore, putting
is

14a;

1,

we have xor

Therefore the triangle

/24
(-^
,

25\
1,
-;^ ),

we may make

it

(24, 7, 25).

Going back, we take as the triangle


Therefore
84a;"

(24.c, 7x, 25x).

+ lx-l, and
.

x^
25
,
.

Hence the
7.

/
(

7
6,

triangle is

To

find a right-angled triangle sucii that its area exceeds

ouo

of

its sides

by a given number.

1 N.B. For brevity and distinctness I slmll in future call llic flidcs about the riht angle simply "sides," and not apply the term to the hyiwUjnuMC. which

will

always be called "hypotenuse."


1

.;

228

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Given number
7.

Therefore, as before,
(

we have
)

to find a

right-angled triangle such that

^ times area

a square,

i.e.

the triangle

(7, 24, 25).


(7a;, 24a;, 25a;).

Let the triangle of the problem be


Therefore
8.

84a;^

7a;

7,

and

x=

^.

To find a right-angled triangle such that the sum of its area and both sides = a given number. Number 6. Again I have to find a right-angled triangle such /sum of sidesX' ~ times area = a square. that -f Let i,
(

p be the sides; therefore


1

.1

-1

..1

fm+l\-
j

= ^ +-^ +3m

m"

7m

square, and

m"

-f-

= a square.
1

Therefore

vi'

im +
m- +

1)
,

are both squares, ' ^

and the difierence = 2i


Therefore

7.

"''

^ 28

45

'

(45

53\

Assume now
Therefore

for the triangle of the


G30a;'

problem

(45a;, 28a;, 53a;).

73a;

6,

and X
9.

is

rational,
its

To find a right-angled triangle such that the sum of both sides by a given number.

area exceeds

Number
find

6.

As

before

we

find subsidiary triangle (28, 45, 53).


(28a;, 45a;, 53a;),

Therefore, taking for the required triangle

we

6S0x- - 73a;

6,

and
10.

x= ^

65
that the sian

To find a right-angled triangle such hypotenuse, and one side is a given number.

of

its

area,

Given number
and

4.

Assuming

hx, px, bx,

,-,

+ hx ^-bx=i,

in order that this equation

may have

a rational solu-

tion I

must

find a triangle such that


-f

/hypotenuse

one sideV
-f-

4 times area = a square.

AlUl'lI MIOTICS.

BOOK
;,

VI.

229
1.

^[ake a right- angled triangle from


/hyiJOtenuse

m+
+

Therefore
1

+ one

sicle\

/2t*

2//i

+
2

'2m

+ 1\*
4//t

=v

and 4 times area = im {/a which = Sm^ + 12/- + im.


Therefore

= Hi* + im' + + 1) (2m + 1)

Gin'

) +

m* + I2iu^ + ISm- +

Sm + 1 ^ a

square =

(7/4-

Gm -

1)^ say.

Hence

m=,,
4
(
,

and the triangle must be formed from

j,

or

(5, 9).

Thus we must assume

for the triangle of the


~^3.c),

problem the
4.

similar triangle {2Sx, 45.f,

and

G30.C*

+ 81a-=

Therefore
11.

x=

lOo

To

find a right-angled triangle such that its area exceeds the

sum

of the

hypotenuse and one side by a given number.


before,
Vjy

Number 4. As we get
Therefore
12.
its

G30a;"

means of the 81.'; = 4.


6
^
.

triangle (28, 45, 53)

x=

To

find a right-angled triangle such that the difference of

sides is a square,
-1-

and

also the greater alone

is

a square, and,

thirdly, its area

the less side - a square.

Let the triangle be formed from two numbei-s, the gi-eater side Hence I must find two being twice their product.

numbers such Uiat twice their product

is

a square and also

exceeds the difference of their squares by a square. This twice is true for any two numbers of which the gi-eater
-

the

less.

Form then
or 6x^

the triangle from x, 2x, and two conditions are

fulfilled.
-I-

The third condition gives Gx* + = a square. Therefore we must


its

3x* - a wjuarc,

seek a

number

such that six times


i.e.

square with 3 produces a square,


of others.
1, 2.

1,

and an

infinite

number
is

Hence the

triangle required

formed from
is

Lemma. number of squares can be found which by

Given two numbers whose sum

s(iuai-o,

an

infinite

multiplication with one of


230

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.

the given ones and the addition of the other to this product give
squares.

Given numbers
which
3 (x^

3, G.

Let

x"

2a;

be the square required,

will satisfy

2a;

1)

=a

square, or

2>x-

G.r

+ 9 = a square.

This

indeterminate
solutions.

equation

has

an

infinite

number

of

1 3.

and

either

To find a right-angled triangle such of its sides = a square.


(5a;, 12a;,

that the

sum of

its

area

Let the triangle be


Therefore
30.'

13x).

1 2a;
6a;

=a
12,

square

= =

36a;^ say.
2.

Therefore

and

a;

But SOx^ + 5x
12

is

not a square

when x = 2.

Therefoi'e I

must

find a square m^a;^ to replace 36a;" such that the value

- 30

:ryr

of X

IS

veol
.

and
-,

satisfies 30a;-

5a;

=a

square,

rru-

1 .-. 1 This gives by *' ^ substitution

60m^+2520
z^^
,, . .

m* - 60m +
square.
to

1)00

a square. ^

Therefore 60??r +

2520=a

If then [by Lemma'] we

had 60 m' + 2520 equal


solved.

a square, the equation could he

Now

60 arises from
of (5,
area,
12,

5,

12,

i.e.

from the product of the

sides

13);

2520

is

the continued product of the


sides

the greater side

and the difference of the

[30.

12.1235].
find a subsidiary triangle such that the proside,

Hence we must

duct of the sides + the continued product of greater


difierence of sides

and area - a square.


a square, we must have [dividing
difference of sides

Or, if we

make

the greater side

by

it],

less side

+ product of
side),

and area

=a

square.

Therefore

(area

and
it

less

we must, given two numbers find some square such that if we


less side, the result is

multiply

by the area and add the


2'his is

a square.
triangle
1

done hy the Lemmas^ and the auxiliary

is (3, 4, 5).

Diophantos has expressed this rather curtly.

If (h

b)

bo the triangle

(b>p), we have to
a Kquarc, or
if

make

hp + ^bp
2'

(b

-p) b

b is a square,

+i

^'P

U'-p) must be a square.

ARITHMETICS.
Thus,
if

I50<)K

VI.

liSl

the original triangle


Gx-*

is {Zx, ix', 5x),


4a;)
,
.

we have
4
a

Let

!=

be the solution of the

first

equation.

q-^; Therefore the second gives Trr. + " 7Ji'-12//i' + 30


;
7.

9G

^ m'-G
.

12 "

=a

S(iuarc. '

Hence
and we must
Therefore

12 m^ + 24

=a

square,
it

find a square such that twelve times

+ 24 = a

square [as in Lemma],

m^ =
a;

25,

and
^.
.
,
.

Tj-jT

Therefore the triangle required

isLq,

/12

16 jq,

20\
-.q)-

14.

To

find a right-angled triangle such that its area exceeds

either side

by a square.
triangle found as before to
(3a;,
l)c

The

similar to

(3,

1,

0), i.e.

ix, 5x).

Therefore

6.r

4a;

= square ^ m" {<

G).

Hence

x=

232
15.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
To
find a right-angled triangle

such that

its

area exceeds

either the liypotenuse or one side

by a square.

Let the triangle be


Therefore

(3a;,

ix, 5x).
V

6a;*

-5a;)

\)X

are both squai-es.

^,

ox\

Making the
Therefore
15wt*

latter a square,

we
,^

find

x=
^, -

3
;,

Cm?

< 6).
square,

from

the

first

(G

- m)-

t,

=a

or

- 36 =

a square.
is

This equation we cannot solve, since 15


squares.

not the

sum

of

two
the

Now

15??i^=the product of a squai-e less than the


hy})0teuuse,
;

ai-ea,

the area,

and one side 36 = the continued product of one side, and the difference between the hypoteside.

nuse and that

Hence we must find a right-angled triangle and a square such that tlie square is < 6, a^id the continued pi'oduct of the
square, the hyj)otenuse of the triangle,

and one

side

of

it

exceeds the continued product of the area, the said side

and

the difference hetioeen the

hypotenuse and that side by

a square. [Lacuna and coiTuption in text']. Foi*m the triangle from two "similar plane numbers" [numbers
of the form ah, oir], say 4,
ditions,
1.

This will

satisfy the con-

and
is

let the

square be 36.
17a;).

(< area.)

The

triangle

then (8*, \bx,


GO.r-

Therefore

8a;

360;^^

say.

Thus
and the triangle
^^

x=
^'

1
y^,

(3'

1 Schulz works out the subsidiary part of this problem thus, or rather only proves the result given by Diophantos that the triangle must be formed from two "similar plane numbers'' a, aU- [i.e. a. 1 and ah. h.] and hyp. h = a-h^^-a-.
;

greater side

ij

= a-b* - -,

less side k

= 2a-b'\

area /= ^ kg.

Now

h-k = a^b* - 2a-b'^ + a" = {ab"^ - ay,


square and hkz'^ - Jcfih - ft) is a square i{ z-=k (h - k) k, for, if we then divide by the square h - k and twice by the square kk, we get 2 (k-(i)^ia\ which is a
ft
;

square.

AUlTilMETlCS.
16.

I'.uolv

VI.

233
multiplictl

Given two numbers,

if

some square be

by one of

them, and the other be subtracted, the result being u square, then
another square can be found greater than the
the same property.
tii-st

square wliich han

[Leitwia to the following problem.]


11, side of square 5, so that 3.

Numbei-s

3,

25
5)*.

-11= 64

=a

square.

Let the required square be

(.

Therefore
3
(a;

5)-

1 1

3.v"

+ 30x + 64 =
x=
62. 67,

a square = (8

2.r)

say.

Hence The side


17.

of the square

and the square

it.self

= 4489.
the area

2h find a riyht-amjled

triamjle such that the

sum vf

ami

either the hypotenuse or one side

=a

square.
{h, k,
(j)

We

must

first

seek a triangle
{h

and a square
z'

s'

such

that hkz-

- ka

-k) = a,

squai-e,
4, 1,

and

>

the area.

Let the triangle be formed from


the triangle being

and the square be 36, but,


is

(8, 15, 17),

the square

not

>

area.

Therefore
the

we must

find

another square to replace 36 by

Lemma
.

in the preceding.
i)

But
.

hk = 136, ka {h -

= 480

= 4320.

Thus 36 136 - 4320 = a square, and we want to find a larger square {m') than 36 such that 136?' - 4320 - a square.
Putting
or,

m = z+ 6,
136^'

(s-

+ 122 + 36) 136 - 4320 = square,

+ 16322 + 576 = a square = (z - 24)* say. This equation has any number of solutions, of which one gives 676 for the value of {z + 6)' [putting n = 16].
Hence, putting
for the triangle (8x,
15.i-,

17x),

we

get

60x* +

8a;

= 676x-*,
"

Therefore

^ ^ 77

18.

To find a right-anfied triangle such


is

that the

Hue

hiscctiw/ nti

acute angle

rational.

Let the bisector (A D) = 5a; and one .section of \x. so that the perpendicular

tlu- has,-

Itli) .ij,

234

DIOPIIANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Let the whole base be some multiple of
3,

say

3.

Then

CD = 3-3x.
But, since

AD

bisects the i

BAC,

the hypotenuse

- (3

3a;),

therefoi-e the

hypotenuse = 4

- 4a;.
+
9,

Hence

IGa;'

32a;

+ 16 =

16a;=

and

a;

Multiplying throughout by 32, the perpendicular

28, the base

96, the

hypotenuse = 100, the bisector =: 35.

To find a right-angled triangle such that the sum of its area 19. and hypotenuse = a square, and its perimeter = a cube. Let the area = x, the hypotenuse = some square minus x, say Therefore, if one 16 -a;; the product of the sides = 2x. of the sides be 2, the other is x, and the perimeter = 18,
which
Therefore
is

not a cube.
find

we must

a square which by the addition of 2

becomes a cube.
Let the side of the square be {x+
(a:-l).
Thei-efore
a;^

1),

and the

side of the cube

3a;^

3a;

= a;^ +

2a;

3,

from which

a;

= 4.
find that
2).

Hence

the side of the square

is 5,

and of the cube

3.

x, hypotenuse = 25 - a?, we = a cube (sides of triangle being x, But (hypotenuse)'' = sum of squares of sides. of - 50a; + 625 = a;- + 4, Therefore

Again, assuming area =


the perimeter

and
20.

x=-^.

621

and

hg2>otenuse

To find a right-angled triangle such that the sum of its area = a cube, and the perimeter = a square. Area x, hypotenuse some cube mimis x, sides x, 2. Therefore we have to find a cube which by the addition of 2
becomes a square.

Let the

side of the

cube =
'

m-1.
\*
say.

^m + lj (3
Thus
wi

= -J-, and the cube

21

<)'
2,

Put then the area a;, the sides x and


(4913
rrr

the hypotenuse

4913

^y^ -x.

\*

xj

= a;^ +

4 gives

a;.

AlUTIIMETICS.
21.

ROOK

VI.

235
its

and one

side is

To find a right-angled triancjle mch that thf sum of a square and its perimeter is a cube.
a riglit-angk'il triangle from
.r,

area

Make

x+

1.

Therefore the i)erpendicular

-2x+\,
1
(-

the base = 2x* + 2x, the

hypotenuse = 2x* +
First, Ax-

2x*

Ga; all

+2=a
tlie

cube, or (4a;

2) {x

1 )

=
to

a cube.

divide

sides by

x+

we have
square.

If wo make 4x + 2

a cube.
Secondly, area
^, Ihereiore

+ perpendicular = a
r-r^

= + +3xVx + 2x+l X+
2x^
;

-^
1

(x

1)*

a square. ^

Hence

2x'

^39"
=a

5x*

+ 4x+l
i

"

^ 2x+

=a

square.
find a

But 4x+

cube.

Therefore

we must
3 -

cuU- which

is

double of a square.
Tlierefore

2x +
1

4,

x=

and .1 the . triangle


22.

/8
(^g,

15
^
,

IS

-j
such that
is

17\

To

find a right-angled triangle


is

tlie

sum

of

its

area and one side

a cube, while

its

perimeter

a square.

Proceeding as before, we have to make

4x + 2 a squarej 2x + 1 a cube /
Therefore the cube

'

8,

the square = IG,

.,,

and the
23.

/16

63

65\

triani

square,

and

To fiml a right-angled triangle such that its perimeter the sum of its perimet^ and area is a cube.
a right-angled triangle from
2.7;,

is

Form

x, 1.

Therefore the sides are

and the hypotenuse x* + 1. Hence 2x* + 2x should be a square, and x' 2x* -f x a cul>c. let it ^ 7V. It is easy to make 2x'' + 2x a square
x-*1,
-I:

Therefore

x-

^"'

m*
8

^ -2

and from the second condition


8

_2^
"^

{m' - 2)'

"^

{m' rr-3

2)'

m' - 2
culto.

must be a cube,

i.e.

7-^

(w -J)

= a

236
Therefox'e

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
2m* = a cube, or
4,
.X'

2m = a
*"

cube = 8 say.
I

Thus

??i

2 r7

14

^^^

^ 7a 49

But

foi*

one side of the triangle we have to subtract

from

this,

which

is

impossible.
a;

Therefore I must find another value of

>

so that

m" > 2 <

4. it

And
Let

must
be

find a

cube such that \ of the square of

>
it

< 4.
1 G,
3

n^, so

that
,

?i"

>

8 <

This 27

is satisfied

by

729

-"=G4''^==TTherefore

m=^^,
16

97

nr =

729
.

25G

512 x = ^^^ and the square of


,

this

21/

>
24.

1.

Thus the

triangle

is

known.
2)erimeter is

7'o Jiiid

cube

and

the

a right-angled triangle such that its sum of its perimeter and area = a square.

(1)

We
may

must

first

see how, given

two numbers, a triangle

be formed whose perimeter = one of the numbers,


other.

and whose area - the


Let
12, 7 be the

numbers, 12 being the perimeter, 7 the area.

Therefore the product of the sides

= 14 = -

14.u

Thus the hypotenuse = 12

1 4x'.

Therefore from the right-angled triangle


1

172 +
or, '

4+
a;-

19Ga;''

- 336x -

24

= -^ + 196a;^ X X
1

172 - 336a;- ^- =

0.

This equation gives no rational solution, unless 86"- 24. 336


IS

a square.
:^

But 172

(perimeter)-

+ 4 times

area,

24 336 = 8 times area


.

multiplied by (perimeter)".
(2)

is

Let now the area = x, the perimeter = any number which both a square and a cube, say 64.
(

Therefore
or,

64"

a;

must be a square,

4a;'

2 4 5 7 6a;

+ 4 1 9 4 3 4 ^ a square.

AUITMMETICS.

I500K VI.
is is

li.ST

Therefore x' - GlU.c + 1048570

a square.)

Also

X + 04 by such a square as
as in the
first.

a square./

To

solve this double equation, multiply the second equation


will

make

the absolute

t<.'rm

the same

Then, taking the difference and factors,

itc, the equations are solved.

[In the text

we

find i$i(Tw(r$o} aoi ol

dpiO/JLoi,

which, besides

being ungrammatical, would seem to be wrong, in that


dpiOfjiOL is

used in an unprecedented manner for

/loraoe?.]

25.

To

find a right-angled triangle such that the square of its


its

hypotenuse = the sum of a square and


the

side,

<and

the quotient

obtained by dividing the (hypotenuse)^ by one side of the triangle =

sum

of a

cube and

its side.

Let one of the sides be

x,

the other

x'.

Therefore (hypotenuse)"

= the sum
+ its
side,

of a square and

its side,

and
Lastly, X*

=
X
+
x'

a cube

must be a square.
1

Therefore of +
Therefore
a;

=
,

a square

{x

2)' say.

= -j and the

triangle

is

found.

26.

the other

To find a right-angled triangle such = the diflerence between a cube and


of a cube

that one side


its side,

is

a cube,

the hypotenuse

= the sum

and

its side.
a;'

Let the hypotenuse =

x,

one side = x^-x.

Therefore the other side Therefore

2x*
2,

=a

cube.

x=

and the triangle

is (6, 8, 10).

TRACT ON TOLYGONAL NUMBERS.


All numbers, from 3 onwards in order, are polygonal, con-

1.

taining as
"

many

sides as units, e.g. 3, 4, 5, &c.


is

As

a square

formed from the multiplication of a number

by itself, so it was proved that any polygonal multiplied by a number in proportion to the number of its sides,
with the addition to the product of a square also in proportion to the

number

of the sides, became a square.

This
ber

we may

shall prove, first

be found from

its side

showing how a polygonal numor the side from a given

polygonal number."
2.

If

there are three


2>i'odicct

numbers equally distant from each

other,

then 8 times the


the least

of the greatest and the middle + tlie square of = a square whose side is (greatest + twice middle number).
to prove

Let the numbei-s be AB, BG, BD (in fig.) we have 8 {AB){BG) + {BDy- = [AB + 2BGy.

B..D...G

Now
Therefore
.

AB = BG+GI).
. .
.

SAB BG - 8 (BG' + BG GD) = iAB BG + iBG' + 4BG GD. and iBG GD +DB'^ AB' [for AB=BG + GD, DB = BG-GD\
.

and we have

to seek

how AB" + iAB.

BG

-\-

iBG^ can be made

a square.

Take
Therefore
.

AE^ BG.
iAB BG = iAB AE.
.

This together
together
3.

ABG' or iAE' makes iBE.EA, and with AB' = [BE+EA)- = (AB + 2BGy.
witli
A. p.

this

If there are any numbers in

the difference

of the greatest
the

and

the least

>

the

common
1.

difference in the ratio

of

number of

terms dimiuiahcd by

POLYGONAL NUMBERS.
Let AB, BG, BD, BE... he in
a. p.

239

B.A..G..D.. E
Therefore

we must have, AB, BG) X (number

difference of

AB,

BE^ (difference
=

of

of

terms-

1).

AG, GD,

DE arc
1).

all

equal.

Therefore

EA
x

AG

>i

(number
term.s in

of the terms

AG, GD, DE) ^

AG

(number of

series-

Therefore
4.

(kc.

If

there are

terms

double the

sum of all.
number

any numbers in a.p. {greatest + [2s = 7i{l + a).]


2^,

least) x

number of

Let the numbers be ^,


(A

C, D, E, F.
shall be twice the

+F)

X the

of

them

sum.

A.B.C.D.E.F
H.L.M.K...G
The number of terms is either even or odd number be the number of units in IIG.
First, let the
;

and

let their

number be
A'.
i^,

even.

Divide IIG into two equal

parts at

Now

the difference of

Z)

the difference of C, A.

Therefore

Hence
Therefore

F+ A =C + I),h\it F + A = {F+ A) HL. C + D = {F+A)LM, E+B = {F+A)MK.


A + B + ... = (F+A) UK. {F + A) IIG ^twice (A +B +...).
number of terms be
units in odd, A, B, C, D, E,
J:c.

And
5.

Secondly, let the

and

let there

be as

many

FU as there are terms,

A.B.C.D.E
F.G.K.II
6.

If titer e are a
A. p.,

series

of numbers beginning

loilh

and

increas-

ing in

then the sicm of all x eight times the


difference

common

difference

ished by

+ the square of {common 2^ the common


1 is

2)

=a

square, whose side dimin-

difference multijilied

by a number, which

increased by

double of the

number of terms.
a,
...

[Let the

a.p.

be

1,

+n-

a.

Therefore

i,

e.

we have to prove s.8a + {a-2y = {a{2n-\) + - 4 (a - 2) na, 8as = 4a

2y,

or

2 - an'

(o - 2)

= n (2 +

n-

la)].

240
Proof.

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Let AB, GD,

EZ be

numbers in

A. p. starting

from

1.

A.K..N...B
Let

D E.L

Z
\.

H.M XT HT contain as many units as there are terms including

Difference between
X a number Put AK, EL,

EZ and

(difference
3].

between

-4

5 and

1)

1 less

than IIT [Prop.

HM each equal to unity.


LZ=MT.KB.

Therefore

Take

KN = 2
KB
by 2 =

and inquire whether the sum of all x eight times + square on NB makes a square whose side diminished

KB X sura
I
product

of

HT, TM.

Sum
and

of all

{ZE + EL) .IIT=\ {LZ + 2EL) HT,


.

LZ= AIT KB
\
.

from above.
.

Therefore the sum =


or, bisecting

(KB iVT
the

TH+ 2TH),
KB TH TX+ HT.
. .

MT at X,

sum =

Thus we inquire
is

lohether
.

KB. TH. TX. SKB + 8KB


a square.

HT + square
. .

on

KB

Now
and
Therefore

SHT TX KB' = iHT TM


.

KB',

SKB

HT = AHM. KB + i (HT + TM) KB.


must
see lohether

toe

i.HT. TM. KB' + iHM. KB + 4 (HT + TM) KB + NB"is

a square.
4/7.1/ KB = 2KB NK, 2KB.NK+NB-=KB- + KN% /JA'^ = HM' BK\ HM\BK"- + UlT TM BK'= {HT+ TMf BK\
. . . . .

But and and again


and

Hence our expression becomes

{HT+ TMf Bid + 4 {HT + TM) KB + A'iV^^


R A.K..N ...B A' T H.M
or,

putting

{HT + TM) BK= NR, NR' + iNR + KN'


4.NR ^

and and and

2NR NK.
.

Therefore the given expression

is

a square whose side

is

RK,

RK -2 = NR, which is KB {HT + TM), HT+ TM+ 1 = twice the number of terms.
th(!

Thus

proposition

is

proved.

POLYGONAL NUMBERS.
7.

241

Let

HT+TM^A, KB=B.

1j

Therefore square on

.1 x

square on

B = square
line.

ou G, where

G = {HT+TM)KB.
Let

DE = A, EZ

=^

B, in a straight

Complete squares DT, EL, and complete TZ.

Then

DE

EZ^DT

TZ, and

TE

EK=TZ

EL.

Therefore

TZ is a mean
-h

proportional between the two squares.

Hence the product of

the squares

the square of TZ, and

DT^ {IIT TMf, ZK = square


Thus the product

on KB.

(HT +

T2If.

KB' = NB^.

8.

If
is

the

svm

difference

there are any number of terms heginning from 1 in a. p. a jiolygonal number, for it has as many angles as the common increased by 2 contains units, ami its side = the number
1.

of terms

inclibding the term

The numbers being represented


multiplied by

in the figure, (sum of series

^KB) + NB- - RK\

O.A.K..N...B
II
.

RG-

-D

/;

L-

A'-

-T

Therefore, taking another

unit

AO,

KO

2,

KN

--

2,

and

OB, BK,

BN are

in arithmetical progression, so that

[Prop. 2], and


or 3
of
is

S.OB.BK + BN' = {OB + 2BKy, OB + 2BK- OK - ZKB an.l 3+12.2,


one
less

than the double of the common difference


the j)rogressiou, including unity,
It;

OB, BK, BN.

Now as the sum of the terms of


H. D.

242
is

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
subject to the

and and

OB

always a polygonal (the

AB

same laws as Oi? while OB is any number first term being AO [1] the term next after it) whose side is 2, it follows
',

that the

sum

of

all

terms in the progression

is

a polygonal

equiangular to OB, and having as


are units in the
difference

many

angles as there

number which exceeds by OK, or 2, the KB, and the side of it is HT which = number
1.

of terms, including

And thus is demonstrated what is


If
there are

said in Hypsikles^ definition.

any numbers increasing from unity by equal intervals, when the interval is 1, the sum of all is a triangular number : wlien 2, a square: when 3, aj)entagon and so on. And the number of angles = 2 + common difference, the side = number of terms including 1.

So

that, since

we have

triangles

when

the diffei'ence

1,

the

sides of

them
1

will be the greatest

term in each

case,

and

the product of the greatest term and the greatest term


increased by

- twice the

triangle.

And,

since
units,

OB

is

a polygonal and has as

many
(itself

angles as

and when multiplied by 8 times

2)

and

increased after multiplication by the square of (itself


[i.e.

4)

NB-] it becomes a square, the numbers will be


:

definition of polygonal

Every polygonal multiplied 8 times into (number

of angles

2)

+ square

of (number of angles

4) = a

squax'e.

The Hypsiklean

definition being proved, it remains to


sides,

show

how, given the

we may

find the

numbers.

Now

having the side

HT

and the number of angles we know

KB, Hence KR
also
*

therefore
is

we

have

{IIT +

TM) KB = NR.

given

[NK^1\
Take the aiithmetical progression

1, 6

+ 1,

This result Nesselmann exhibits thus. 2& + l...(K-l)t + l.


Qsh +
(l)

If s is the sum, If

- 2)'^=[h (2k -

1)

+ 2p,
a. p.,

now we

take the three terms

6-2,

h,

+ 2,

also in

8b(?;+2)

+ (?i-2)' = [(6 + 2) + 26]'

= (3!> + 2)2,

Now 6 + 2
Hence
s

is

the

sum

of the

first

two terms of

first series;

and

= 2.2-1,

therefore 3 corresponds to 2h -

1.

and

+ 2 are subject

to the

same

law.

POLYGONAL NUMBERS.
Therefore
it

243

we know

also the square of

the square

of

KR. Subtracting from NB, we have tlie remaining term


find the side.

which = number
Similarly given the
9.

x '^KB.

number we can
number from

Rule.

To Jhid

the

the side.

Take the side, double it, subtract 1, and multiply the remamder by (number of angles - 2). Add 2 to the product, and from the square of the number subtract the square of (number of angles 4). Dividing the remainder by 8 times (number of angles - 2), we find the required
polygonal.

To

filed the side

from

the

numher.

Multiply

it

l>y

8 times

(number of angles - 2), add to the product the square of (number of angles - 4). We thus get a square. Subtract 2 from the side of this square and divide remainder by (number of angles - 2). Add 1 to quotient and half the
result is the side required.
10.

[A fragment.]
to

Given a numher,

find in how viany loays

it

can he a polygcmal.
of angles, and

Let

AB be in BG

the given number,

BG

the

number

take
.

GD = 2, GU - 4.
B Z
E..D..G

A T

has BG angles, %AB BD + BE- = a square = ZIP say. Take in AB the length AT=\. Therefore MB BI)= iAT BD + i (AB + TB) BD.
Therefore, since the polygonal
.

H AB

Take
and
but
for

Therefore

Hence
and

DK=i{AB+TB), AAT.BD put 2BD DE. ZIP = KD BD + 1BD .DE + BE*, 2BD DE + BE' = BD' + DE\ ZU ^ KD BD + BD* + DE\
. . .

'

KD BD + BD^ - KB BD. Zir=KB.BD+DE\ Thus and, since DK = 4 {AB + TB), DK> 4 J T > 4, and half 4 - DG,
.
.

GK>GD.

244

DIOPHANTOS OF ALEXANDRIA.
Therefore, if

DK is bisected at L, L will
sqiiare
.

fall
.

between

G and K,

and the

on

A T

Z
Therefore
or

LB = LD' + KB BD. E..D..G L K H N M

ZE' = BU - LD' + DE\ ZH' + DL' = BU- + DE\


LD"-~DE' = LB'~ZH\

and Again

since

ED = DG and DG is produced
EL.LG + GD'=DL\
.

to L,

Therefore

Hence Put
Therefore
so that

DL' - DG' = DL' - DE' = EL LG. EL LG = LB' ~ ZIP. ZM = BL {BL being > ZII).
.

ZM' - ZH' = EL LG
.

but

DK

is

bisected in L,

DL = 2 (AB + BT)
GL = iB T,

and

DG = 2 AT.

Therefore

and BT-^^GL,

but also
Therefore

AT

{ov l)

= ^^6-'(or

4).

AB = 4 \ EL,

but

TB

also

GL.

Hence
or

AB.TB=^EL. LG,
EL.LG=1(JAB.BT.

Thus

UAB.BT = MZ' - ZII


IIM is
eve^i.

'

= 21H ' + 2ZH

IIM.

Therefore

Let

it

be bisected in JV
[Here the fragment ends.]

INDEX
[The references are to pages.]
Ab-kismet, 41
Abu'lfaraj,
u.

Ars
13, 41
13,

rei et census,

21

h.

2, 3, 12,

Auria, Joseph, 51, 56

Abu'l-Waffi

Al-Biizjfmi,

2520,

Autolykos, 5

4042,

148, 155, 157

Abu

Ja'far

Mohammed

ibn AUiusain,

156
Addition,

Bacchios

y^pwv, 14, 15, 16

how expressed by Diophantos,


for,

Bachet, 49

53 and passim

69

Bombelli's sign

45

Vieta's,

"Back-reckoning," H5

86,

114; exap-

78 .
Algebraic notation, three stages
of,

77

SO
aljabr, 40, 92,

amples of, 110, 111, and in the pendix passim Bhaskara, 153
Billy, Jacobus de, Blancauus, 3
3,

149150, 158
?;.,

54

Alkarkhi, 2425, 71

156159
ibn Mfisfi

Al-Kharizmi, see

Mohammed
ii.

Bombelli, 13, 14, 15, 23, 35, 36.


45, 52,

42

almuktibahi, 92, 149150, 158

134135;
68
n.,

his algebraic no-

Al-Nadim, 39, 40
Alsirfij,

tation, 45,

Al-Shahrastani, 41

Bossut, 32, 38, 90

138139

n.

24

u.,

159

Brahmagupta, 153
Brassinne, 221 n.

avaipopiKos of Hj-psikles, 5
6x)pl(TTu%, iv doplarcf),

140
23
Camcrarius, Joachim,
Cantor, 55
152, 156, 157
2,

ApoUonios,

4, 8, 9,

Approximations, 117120, 147

42
141
n.,

Apukius, 15 Arabian scale of powers compared with that of Diophantos, 7071, 150
151
Arabic translations, Ac, 23, 24, 25,

h., 58, 59. 67,

151.

Cardan, 43, 46, 70


Casiri, 41 n.

Cattle-problem, the,

7,

142117

3942, 148159
Archimedes,
7,

Censo, 70
Coefficient, 93 .

142, 143, 144, 146, 147

Aristoxenos, 14, 15

Colebrooke,

12,

19

n.,

33,

133. 136.

Arithmetic and Geometry, 31,

141

137 n.
Cosa, 45, 70
Cossali, 1, 3, 10, 12, 31, 36, 41 n., 43 n..
49, 51, 70, 71. 107 n.. 133. 136.

142
'ApiOfiriTLKo. of

Diophantos, 33 and pasIH,

sim
apidfiijriKri

HO.

and

XoyiaTiK-f),

136,

169

;i..

220

;i.

145
dpidfioi, 6
;

Tridhara, 153

Diophantos' technical use

of the word, 57, 150; his sj-mbol for


it,

Cubes two

transformation of a

Bom

of

cube-s into the difference of

two

57-

66,

137138, 160

others,

and

vice rer$ii,

123125

apidfiOffTov,

74

Cubic equation. 30, 9391. 114

246
Data
of Euclid, 140

Gardthausen,

60,

64

Dedication to Dionysios, 136


Definitions of Diophantos, 28, 29, 57,
67,
7-4,

Geminos, 18, 145146 Geometry and algebra, 140

141, 151
31,

137, 138, 163


:

Determinate equations
reduction
of, 29,

see

contents

153, 156, 158 Geometry and arithmetic,


142
Girard, Albert, 3
n.,

141

149150

Diagonal numbers, 142

55

Didymos,
Digby, 23

14, 15, 16

Gow

on Diophantos, 64 160
n.

66

7i.,

137

n.,

Dioi^hautos, see contents

Hankel, 8385, 129


s
,
.

35, 98

Harmonics
lemy, 15

of Diophantos, 14

of Pto-

Division,
tos,

how

represented by Diophan-

73

Harriot, 78 n.

Double-equations of the first and second


degrees, 98

Heiberg, 146147, 160

107

of higher degrees,

Heilbronner, 3

112113 Svva/jLis and


63, 66
7i.,

Herakleides Ponticus, 16
the sign for
67, 68, 140,
it,

58
;

n., 62,
dvfa/xis

Heron

of Alexandria, 141, 153


5,

151

Hipparchos,

141

and Terpaywvoi, 67 68 dwa/xoduva/jus and the sign


dvvainoOvvafJ.oa'Toi',

Hippokrates, 67
for
it,

67

68
ii.,

History of the Dynasties, see Abu'Ifaraj

74
for
it,

Holzmann, Wilhelm,
65
Hultsch, 146
n.

see

Xylander
39
n.

dvva/jMKv^os

and the sign

6768
Swa/JLOKV^offTov, 74

Hypatia,

1, 8, 9, 10, 11, 17, 38,

Hypsikles,

4, 5, 6, 135,

242

dwafioarov, 74
Z

for

tffos,

75
78, 79,

er5os

= power,

29

7i.

lambHchos,
4, 5,

140

Elements of EucUd,

142, 158

Identical formulae, 125

Epanthema
Epigrams,

of Thymaridas, 140
2, 6, 7, 9,

Indeterminate equations, 94
146, 147, 157, 158, 159
of,

113, 144,

142147, 223
76 see contents;
for,

Equality, Diophantos' expression

Irrationality, Diophantos' view of, 82

7576

Xylander's sign
of,

Isidoros, 5

Equations, classes

Italian scale of powers, 70, 71

reduction of determinate equations,


29,

149-150
4, 5,

jabr, 40, 92,


jiclr,

149150, 158

Eratosthenes, 5
Euclid, Elements,
142, 158; Data,

150

140

John of Damascus, 8 John of Jerusalem, 8


ka'b, 71 n., 157, 158

Eudemos, 67
Eunapios, 13
Fabricius,

Kitab
1, 5,

AljUtrist,

39

14
n.,

Kliigel, 11,

90

n.,

144

Fakhn,
Fermat,

the,

2425, 71

156159
124,

Kostfi ibn Luk:l, 40


KvfioKvpos
KvjBos

13, 23, 53, 54, 68, 123,

125, 126, 128, 129, 130, 131, 221 n.


Fihrist, the, 39, 40, 41, 42

and the sign for it, 6768 and the sign for it, 58 n., 62, 63,

66h.,

67 68

Fractious, representation of, 73

75

Kuster, 8

INDEX.
Lato, 70

247

Notation, algebraic: three stages, 77

Lehmann, 60
Xfr^ty,

80
for
it,

drawbacks of Diophantos' nota-

and the symbol


iirl

66

;i.,

TI-

tion,

8082

TS, 137, 163

Xei^tj

\e'i\pLv

jroWairXaffiaffOuaa
n.

TTOtet virap^LV,

13T

\i6((>avTos or Aew^aj'Tos, 14

Lessing, 142, 143, 144, 146 h.

Limits, jnethod

of,

86, 8T,

115 IIT
136, 145

Numbers which are the sum of two squares, 127130 Numbers wliich are the sum of three squares, 130131 Numbers as the sum of four squares, 131132
dpyavQaai, 136

approximation
\(yyi.<jTLKr]

to,

IIT

120
Oughtred, 78

and

apidfiy^TiKT], 18,

137
140
139
117

146

wpiafiivoi apidfjLol,
77.

Lousada, Miss Abigail, 56

Lnca

Pacioli, 43, TO n.

Lucilius, 9

Pappos, 11, 12, 17, 65


Trapio-OTTji

71.,

or

irapiffOTrrros ayoyy-ri,

" Majuskelcursive " writing, 64, T2


mal, Tin., 157, 158

71.

120
Pcletarius, James, 2, 43
Pell,

Manuscripts of Diophantos, 19, 61

John, 56

Maximus Planudes,
Meibomius, 14
Metrodoros, 10
7n(n!,

23, 38, 39, 51, 135

Perron, Cardinal, 20

Phaidros, 14, 15
TrXaffficLTiKOv,

169

n.

Diophantos' sign
Bombelli's, 45
;

for,

66

/;.,

71

Plato, 18,

141142, 145
93
71.

73

Tartaglia'6,78 h.;

TrXij^os, coefficient, 2)lus,

Mohammed
for,

ibn Miisfi's expression

Diophantos' expression
71.
;

of,

71,

151
bij

137

Bombelli's s^-mbol

for,

45

Minus vniltipUed

minus gives plus,

Vieta's, 78 n.

137, 163 " Minuskclcursive " writing, 64

Pococke,

2, 12,

41

;i.

Polygonal Numbers,
3,

{31

35

and pas-

Mohammed
40
n.,

ibn Miisa Al-Kliarizmi,


92, 134, 148,

sim
Porisms, 18,

59,

149155,

3235,

37,

121125, 210,

156, 158
fxovaSis,

218
;

69

the symbol for, 69


53, 71, 136

Poselger, 55, 120, 124

71.

Montucla,
imtfasxirln,

3, 11,

Powers,

additive
of,

40 u. mukdbala, 92, 149150, 158 vifda, 150


Multiplication,

evolution
Proclus, 142

and multiplicative 7071, 150161

Progression, arithmetical,
;i.

summation

modern

signs for, 78

of,

239240
and
xp6fi\rjfi.a,

irporacris

34

lutqis,

151

n.
5, 10,

Nessehnann,

20, 21, 22, 23, 27,

Ptolemy, Claudius, 9 Pythagoras, 141


Quadratic equation, solution
93,
of,

81, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 44 n., 49, 51 h., 54, 55, 58, 59, TT, T8, T9, 85, 8s, 91 h., 92, lOS, 110, 114, 121, 125, 129 .,

90

140141, 151155;

tbo two

133, 142, 143 n., 144, 145, 140, 147,

roots of, 92,

153155

169

n.,

212

7!.,

242

71.

Nikomachos,
135, 151

6,

14, 15, 10, 38, 05 .,

Radix, 68
Uumu-s, Peter, 10. \\, 15

248

INDEX.
Sursolides, 71

Reduction of determinate equations,


29,

149150
2,

Suter,
20, 21,

Dr Heinrich, 28
:

n., 50,

53 h.

Eegiomontanus, Joannes,
22, 23, 42, 46,

Symbols, algebraic
&c.

see plus, minus,

78

Eeimer, 32
Eelati, 71
tafsir

on Diophantos, 40
6, 7,

Res, 68
Eiccati, Vincenzo, 27 n.

Tannery, Paul,
of,

n.,

10, 13,

14,

15, 16, 133, 139,

142146

Eight-angled triangle: formation


use
115, 127, 128, 155, 156

tanto, Bombelli's use of, 45

in rational numbers, 115, 141, 142


of,
;

Ta'rlkh Hokoma, 41
Tartaglia, 43, 78 n.

ex-

amples,
VI.
pi^rj

APPENDIX,

especially

Book

Theon

of Alexandria, 8 n., 10, 11, 12,

13,38

of Nikomachos, 151
n., 59, 60, 61, 62,

Theon
7576,

of

Smyrna,

6,

135, 142

Eodet, L., 29
91

Thrasyllos, 15

n., 92, 134, 151,

155
ibn Musa,

Thymaridas, 140
Translations of Diophantos, see Chapter
III.

Rosen, editor of
q. V.

Mohammed

Salmasius, Claudius, 19 n., 224 Saunderson, Nicholas, 52 n., 133 Scholia on Diophantos, 38, 39, 135
Schulz, 55 and iwssiMi
Series,

Unknown

quantity and

its

powers in
in
150,
n.,

Diophantos, 5769, 139140;


other writers, 45, 68, 70, 71
151, 157, 158
;

Dioi^hantos' devices

arithmetical;

summation

of,

for

remedying the want of more than


for,
n.,

239240
shai, 150

one sign
ilnap^is,

8082,

89, 179

29

71, 137 n.
n.

" Side-numbers," 142

Usener, Hermann, 12
Variable,

Simultaneous equations, how treated by Diophantos, 80, 89, 113, 140 Sirmondus, Jacobus, 19 n., 20

Square

root,

how
n.

expressed by Dio-

devices for remedying the want of more than one symbol for a, 8082, 89, 179
n.,

phantos, 93
Stevin, 3, 55

Vieta, 52, 68, 78

123124

Vossius,

3,

21

71.,

56

Struve,

Dr

J.

and Dr

L., 142 n.
;

Subsidiary problems, 81, 86


of, 97,

examples

Wallis, 70 71, 138

110, 111

Wopcke, 24,
TartagUa's, 78 n.;

25, 26, 155

Subtraction, Diophantos' symbol for,

66

71.,

7173;

Xylander, 45

51 and passim

Bombelli's, 45

Suidas,

1, 8, 9,

10, 11, 12, 13, 45

Zcmus, 68
Zetetica of Victa, 52

Supersolida, 71

CAMBRIlJdK

ritlNTEI) 1)Y

,AY,

M.A.

AND SON, AT THK VNIVERSITY PRESS.

rrrrr' -psnoK I?

RETURN

jO^B^

CIRCULATION DEPARTMENT 202 Main Library


1

LOAN PERIOD HOME USE

'

V BE RECALLED AFTER 7 DAYS TO DUE DATE. -Qr.cs MAY BE MADE 4 DAYS PRIOR "'"-' 3-MONTHS. AND 1-YEAR.

"^FLOW

%.

A
27]ur':;\
^-^

fACKS

73
LD2lA-50m-4'00
(A956'2sl0)47CB

-'J

Au
.ELEY
pt OOifalr^

UniTemcy

Berkeley

GENERAL LIBRARY

U.C.

BERKPIF^

'

5:*

THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA UBRARY

Uff^Jj

Você também pode gostar